In Stock & Ready to Ship | Lead Time: 4–8 Weeks|RTO from $49/mo
RV Covers For Sale
Shop 35+ prefab steel carport sizes from $1,195. Regular, A-Frame & vertical roof styles in 12 or 14 gauge. Free delivery & professional installation on every tubular steel order across all 48 states.
648 sq ft for compact garage, RV cover, or carport
18′ x 36′14 GaugeLocal Certification Available
Pre-engineered 18×36 steel building delivers 648 sq ft of column-free space. Galvanized 14-gauge tubular frame, vertical roof, and certified wind and snow load ratings. Customize doors, windows, colors, eave height, and certifications in our free 3D builder.
18×36 Two Compact Cars Tucked Side-by-Side | Steel and Stud, From $9,550
18×36 Two Compact Cars Tucked Side-by-Side, built for daily backyard use.
Built for homeowners who want more covered space, this 18×36 two compact cars tucked side-by-side packs 648 sq ft into a code-compliant shell. Two compact sedans or a small SUV plus a sedan fit at 18 feet wide if you’re.
Starting from your selected configuration$9,550$10,900Save $1,350
or as low as $199/mo · 0% APR · No credit RTO
ℹ️This is an estimate. Final pricing is locked after our sales team reviews your complete requirements (site access, ground type, county-specific certifications, optional upgrades). You’ll receive a written all-in quote within one business day of your request, no surprises, no hidden fees.
FREE delivery & installation in all 48 states. Concrete, asphalt, or compacted gravel.
SKU:SS-18X36-TWO-COMPACT-CARSBuilt:1,847+Since: 2002Made in: 🇺🇸 USA
🛡️
A+
BBB Accredited
★
4.8/5
customer rating
⏱
Since 2004
In Business
🏠
15,000+
Buildings
🇺🇸
48
States Served
We’ve provided builds for
SPATIAL LAYOUT
See how 800 sq ft fits your two compact cars tucked side-by-side layout.
18 feet wide × 36 feet long. Built for homeowners who want more covered space, this 18×36 two compact cars tucked side-by-side packs 648 sq ft into a code-compliant shell.
Two Compact Cars Tucked Side-by-Side layout.
Built for homeowners who want more covered space, this 18×36 two compact cars tucked side-by-side packs 648 sq ft into a code-compliant shell. Two compact sedans or a small SUV plus a sedan fit at 18 feet wide if you’re careful with the doors. Most buyers pair this with a single 16-foot roll-up door for both bays. You won’t have room for storage along the walls, but you will get both cars under steel.
💡 Pro tip:Two-Car Capable, add insulation, electrical, and a main-side window for year-round use.
🎨 FREE 3D BUILDER
Build your 18×36 Two Compact Cars Tucked Side-by-Side in 3D.
Design your building yourself in our free Sensei3D Designer, drag doors and windows where you want them, swap roof + trim colors, and see your spec from every angle. Save your design and email it to yourself for later.
Drag-and-drop doors, windows, walk-ins anywhere on the building
16 colors applied live to roof, walls, and trim, mix & match
Interior + exterior views of your spec, with measurements
Save your design and share it with your contractor or family
Auto-syncs to quote, what you build is what we price
Everything in your Two Compact Cars Tucked Side-by-Side.
All variants ship with free delivery, installation, drawings, 20-year warranty.
🏗️
648 sq ft enclosed
Fully-enclosed 18×36 vertical-roof structure.
🚪
Roll-up + walk-in doors
Standard configuration door package.
🔩
14-gauge steel frame
American-rolled galvanized tubing.
🎨
1 standard color
Pick from 16 factory-baked finishes.
TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS
Two Compact Cars Tucked Side-by-Side spec sheet.
Width18′
Length36′ + 6" overhang
Side height9′ standard
Floor space648 sq ft
Doors1 × 9×8 roll-up
Walk-inOptional (+$345)
WindowsOptional
Windup to 180 mph
Snowup to 65 psf
RoofVertical 3:12
Frame14 ga (12 ga upgrade)
Sheeting29 ga (26 ga upgrade)
AnchoringConcrete · Asphalt · Ground
Lead time3 – 5 weeks
USE CASE EXAMPLES
How real buyers use Two Compact Cars Tucked Side-by-Side.
DAILY USE
Everyday two compact cars tucked side-by-side
648 sq ft is the right size for daily use of a two compact cars tucked side-by-side.
STORAGE OVERFLOW
two compact cars tucked side-by-side + seasonal storage
Park or store equipment in the front half, leave the rear for seasonal storage and overflow.
FLEX ROOM
Expansion-ready
Stud-framed interior makes it easy to add a partition, electrical, or insulation later.
FULL PRODUCT DETAILS
18×36 Two Compact Cars Tucked Side-by-Side, what makes it different.
648sq ft
Floor Space
180mph
Wind Rated
65psf
Snow Load
20yr
Rust Warranty
40yr
Paint Warranty
$199/mo
From RTO
🏗️
Engineered for your county
Every 18×36 two compact cars tucked side-by-side is fabricated from American-rolled galvanized steel and engineered against the exact wind and snow loads your jurisdiction requires.
Standard: 140 mph wind / 35 psf snow
12-ga upgrade: 180 mph / 65 psf
Permit drawings stamped and emailed free
🔩
Construction details
The same materials commercial fabricators use, not residential-grade. Hot-dip galvanized fasteners, factory-baked siliconized polyester paint, Hilti-grade anchors.
Frame: 14-ga (12-ga upgrade) galvanized tubing
Panels: 29-ga G-90 (26-ga upgrade)
Fasteners: #14 self-drilling with EPDM washer
🚚
Free delivery & install, really free
Regional-route delivery plus 1–2 day on-site installation by a certified crew, bundled into your headline price. No hidden unloading fees, fuel surcharges, or site-prep charges.
$0 deposit · pay only after walkthrough sign-off
3–5 week lead time on regional routes
All 48 states · rush option available
🛡️
Warranty & lifespan
Engineered for a 50-year service life with industry-leading warranties on every wear surface.
20-yr rust-through warranty on frame & panels
40-yr paint warranty against fading + chalking
1-yr craftsmanship on installation
💳
$0-down financing
Three financing paths to fit any credit situation. The rent-to-own option requires no credit pull at all, fastest path to a closed deal.
RTO: $199/mo, no credit check, 36–60 mo
Financing: 0% promo APR · 84 mo term
Cash discount: 4% on $10K+ orders
⚡
Why 18×36?
648 sq ft sits in the sweet spot for residential and light-commercial, fits standard quarter-acre setbacks, comfortably below the 1,000 sq ft municipal threshold that triggers extra inspections.
18′ × 36′ footprint with 648 sq ft interior
Permit-friendly in 96% of US counties
Resale ROI $5,184–$7,776 added home value
PEOPLE ALSO ASK
Common questions from Two Compact Cars Tucked Side-by-Side shoppers.
The questions our team hears every week. Click any to expand the short answer.
How thick is the steel on a Steel and Stud 18×36 metal building?
Standard frame: 14-gauge (1.5 mm) galvanized tubing. Optional 12-gauge upgrade (2.5 mm) for high-wind/snow zones. Roof and wall sheeting ships 29-gauge standard, 26-gauge upgrade available on order.
Does Steel and Stud deliver and install in my state?
Yes, free delivery and free installation in all 48 continental states, performed by certified Steel and Stud crews. Hawaii and Alaska use custom freight quotes; call 1-877-275-7048 for either.
What’s the typical lead time for a 18×36 building?
Standard: 3–5 weeks from order confirmation to install completion. Fabrication runs the first 2–3 weeks at our US plant; regional delivery and 1-2 day install close it out. Rush builds available for $345.
Can I finance a Steel and Stud building without a credit check?
Yes, Steel and Stud’s rent-to-own partner does not pull credit. Approvals typically run 8 minutes with proof of income and first month’s payment. 36–60 month terms, no early-payoff penalty.
What’s covered under the 20-year warranty?
Steel and Stud’s 20-year rust-through warranty covers the galvanized frame against perforation, plus a 20-year paint-finish warranty against fade and chalk. Workmanship on the install is warrantied for 1 year. Warranty transfers to the next owner on resale.
CUSTOMER REVIEWS
What real 18×36 Two Compact Cars Tucked Side-by-Side buyers say.
⭐
No reviews yet for the 18×36 Two Compact Cars Tucked Side-by-Side
Be the first verified buyer to share your experience. Honest reviews help other steel-building shoppers make a confident decision.
Two Compact Cars Tucked Side-by-Side questions, answered.
How much does a 18×36 two compact cars tucked side-by-side cost?
A 18×36 two compact cars tucked side-by-side from Steel and Stud starts at $9,550 with free delivery and free installation across all 48 states. Most buyers pick the rent-to-own option at about $199/month with $0 down and no credit check. Call 1-877-275-7048 for a same-day price lock.
Is delivery and installation included in the 18×36 two compact cars tucked side-by-side price?
Yes, every Steel and Stud two compact cars tucked side-by-side ships with free delivery + free installation by a certified crew, included in the listed price. Anchored to a concrete pad, asphalt, or compacted gravel, your building is fully erected in 1–2 days after the truck arrives.
Do I need a permit for a 18×36 two compact cars tucked side-by-side?
Almost always for 648+ sq ft enclosed buildings. Steel and Stud emails engineered drawings stamped for your wind zone (up to 180 mph) and snow zone (up to 65 psf) at no charge, so your local building department has everything it needs. Permit timing typically runs 2–6 weeks by jurisdiction.
How is a Steel and Stud two compact cars tucked side-by-side different from a wood-frame build?
Steel solves the problems wood creates, no rotting, no termites, no warping, no painting every 3 years. Our 14-gauge galvanized frame carries a 20-year rust warranty and ships with a 180 mph wind / 65 psf snow rating already engineered in. A comparable wood build typically costs 2–3× more and needs ongoing maintenance.
What foundation does a 18×36 two compact cars tucked side-by-side need?
A 4-inch concrete pad poured 1 foot wider and longer than the building is the standard. Steel and Stud also anchors to asphalt or compacted gravel for open or semi-enclosed configurations. A pad-pour bundle is offered at checkout if you don’t already have a slab.
How fast can I get a 18×36 two compact cars tucked side-by-side delivered?
Standard lead time is 3–5 weeks from order to install. Fabrication runs the first 2–3 weeks at our US plant; regional delivery + 1–2-day install by a certified Steel and Stud crew closes out the order. Rush builds are available, call 1-877-275-7048 for current capacity.
Can I finance a 18×36 two compact cars tucked side-by-side without a credit check?
Yes, Steel and Stud’s rent-to-own partner does not pull credit. Approvals close in about 8 minutes with proof of income and your first month’s payment. Terms run 36–60 months with no early-payoff penalty, and the monthly works out to roughly $199/month on a 18×36 two compact cars tucked side-by-side.
What warranty comes with the 18×36 two compact cars tucked side-by-side?
Steel and Stud backs every building with a 20-year rust-through warranty on the galvanized frame and a 10-year sheeting warranty on the 29-gauge panels (upgradeable to 26-gauge or 12-gauge). Workmanship on the install is warrantied for 1 year. Full warranty terms ship with your order packet.
Can I customize the 18×36 two compact cars tucked side-by-side in 3D before I order?
Yes, our free Sensei3D Designer lets you drag and drop doors, windows, and walk-ins; swap 16 roof + trim colors live; and rotate the building in 3D from every angle. No login required. The design saves directly to a quote so what you build is exactly what we price.
Does a 18×36 two compact cars tucked side-by-side add resale value to my home?
An enclosed 18×36 two compact cars tucked side-by-side typically adds $5,184–$7,776 in resale value per regional comp data, and most insurance carriers reduce premiums for indoor vehicle / equipment storage. Steel and Stud’s 20-year rust warranty transfers to the next owner.
Ready to build?
Your Two Compact Cars Tucked Side-by-Side quote takes one minute.
Tell us your zip and the options you want. We’ll send back a same-day, all-in price.
648 sq ft for compact garage, RV cover, or carport
18′ x 36′14 GaugeLocal Certification Available
Pre-engineered 18×36 steel building delivers 648 sq ft of column-free space. Galvanized 14-gauge tubular frame, vertical roof, and certified wind and snow load ratings. Customize doors, windows, colors, eave height, and certifications in our free 3D builder.
Leg height adjustable up to 20'
$9,550.00
Free Delivery & Install RTO from /mo — No credit check
648 sq ft for compact garage, RV cover, or carport
18′ x 36′14 GaugeLocal Certification Available
Pre-engineered 18×36 steel building delivers 648 sq ft of column-free space. Galvanized 14-gauge tubular frame, vertical roof, and certified wind and snow load ratings. Customize doors, windows, colors, eave height, and certifications in our free 3D builder.
18×36 Home Office and Hobby Room | Steel and Stud, From $9,550
18×36 Home Office and Hobby Room, built for daily backyard use.
Built for homeowners who want more covered space, this 18×36 home office and hobby room packs 648 sq ft into a code-compliant shell. Remote workers and small property owners convert the 18×36 into a fully insulated.
You’re viewing:Home Office and Hobby Room·Size18×36·Slate Gray
Starting from your selected configuration$9,550$10,900Save $1,350
or as low as $199/mo · 0% APR · No credit RTO
ℹ️This is an estimate. Final pricing is locked after our sales team reviews your complete requirements (site access, ground type, county-specific certifications, optional upgrades). You’ll receive a written all-in quote within one business day of your request, no surprises, no hidden fees.
FREE delivery & installation in all 48 states. Concrete, asphalt, or compacted gravel.
SKU:SS-18X36-HOME-OFFICE-HOBBBuilt:1,847+Since: 2002Made in: 🇺🇸 USA
🛡️
A+
BBB Accredited
★
4.8/5
customer rating
⏱
Since 2004
In Business
🏠
15,000+
Buildings
🇺🇸
48
States Served
We’ve provided builds for
SPATIAL LAYOUT
See how 800 sq ft fits your finished retreat layout.
18 feet wide × 36 feet long. Built for homeowners who want more covered space, this 18×36 home office and hobby room packs 648 sq ft into a code-compliant shell.
Main lounge · Wet bar / Kitch. · Bath / Storage
Main lounge on one end, wet bar / kitch. through the middle, bath / storage at the rear. Remote workers and small property owners convert the 18×36 into a fully insulated detached office.
💡 Pro tip:Detached Office, add insulation, electrical, and a main lounge-side window for year-round use.
🎨 FREE 3D BUILDER
Build your 18×36 Home Office and Hobby Room in 3D.
Design your building yourself in our free Sensei3D Designer, drag doors and windows where you want them, swap roof + trim colors, and see your spec from every angle. Save your design and email it to yourself for later.
Drag-and-drop doors, windows, walk-ins anywhere on the building
16 colors applied live to roof, walls, and trim, mix & match
Interior + exterior views of your spec, with measurements
Save your design and share it with your contractor or family
Auto-syncs to quote, what you build is what we price
All variants ship with free delivery, installation, drawings, 20-year warranty.
🏗️
648 sq ft enclosed
Fully-enclosed 18×36 vertical-roof structure.
🚪
Roll-up + walk-in doors
Standard configuration door package.
🔩
14-gauge steel frame
American-rolled galvanized tubing.
🎨
1 standard color
Pick from 16 factory-baked finishes.
TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS
Home Office and Hobby Room spec sheet.
Width18′
Length36′ + 6" overhang
Side height9′ standard
Floor space648 sq ft
Doors1 × 9×8 roll-up
Walk-inOptional (+$345)
WindowsOptional
Windup to 180 mph
Snowup to 65 psf
RoofVertical 3:12
Frame14 ga (12 ga upgrade)
Sheeting29 ga (26 ga upgrade)
AnchoringConcrete · Asphalt · Ground
Lead time3 – 5 weeks
USE CASE EXAMPLES
How real buyers use Home Office and Hobby Room.
DAILY USE
Everyday home office and hobby room
648 sq ft is the right size for daily use of a home office and hobby room.
STORAGE OVERFLOW
home office and hobby room + seasonal storage
Park or store equipment in the front half, leave the rear for seasonal storage and overflow.
FLEX ROOM
Expansion-ready
Stud-framed interior makes it easy to add a partition, electrical, or insulation later.
FULL PRODUCT DETAILS
18×36 Home Office and Hobby Room, what makes it different.
648sq ft
Floor Space
180mph
Wind Rated
65psf
Snow Load
20yr
Rust Warranty
40yr
Paint Warranty
$199/mo
From RTO
🏗️
Engineered for your county
Every 18×36 home office and hobby room is fabricated from American-rolled galvanized steel and engineered against the exact wind and snow loads your jurisdiction requires.
Standard: 140 mph wind / 35 psf snow
12-ga upgrade: 180 mph / 65 psf
Permit drawings stamped and emailed free
🔩
Construction details
The same materials commercial fabricators use, not residential-grade. Hot-dip galvanized fasteners, factory-baked siliconized polyester paint, Hilti-grade anchors.
Frame: 14-ga (12-ga upgrade) galvanized tubing
Panels: 29-ga G-90 (26-ga upgrade)
Fasteners: #14 self-drilling with EPDM washer
🚚
Free delivery & install, really free
Regional-route delivery plus 1–2 day on-site installation by a certified crew, bundled into your headline price. No hidden unloading fees, fuel surcharges, or site-prep charges.
$0 deposit · pay only after walkthrough sign-off
3–5 week lead time on regional routes
All 48 states · rush option available
🛡️
Warranty & lifespan
Engineered for a 50-year service life with industry-leading warranties on every wear surface.
20-yr rust-through warranty on frame & panels
40-yr paint warranty against fading + chalking
1-yr craftsmanship on installation
💳
$0-down financing
Three financing paths to fit any credit situation. The rent-to-own option requires no credit pull at all, fastest path to a closed deal.
RTO: $199/mo, no credit check, 36–60 mo
Financing: 0% promo APR · 84 mo term
Cash discount: 4% on $10K+ orders
⚡
Why 18×36?
648 sq ft sits in the sweet spot for residential and light-commercial, fits standard quarter-acre setbacks, comfortably below the 1,000 sq ft municipal threshold that triggers extra inspections.
18′ × 36′ footprint with 648 sq ft interior
Permit-friendly in 96% of US counties
Resale ROI $5,184–$7,776 added home value
PEOPLE ALSO ASK
Common questions from Home Office and Hobby Room shoppers.
The questions our team hears every week. Click any to expand the short answer.
How thick is the steel on a Steel and Stud 18×36 metal building?
Standard frame: 14-gauge (1.5 mm) galvanized tubing. Optional 12-gauge upgrade (2.5 mm) for high-wind/snow zones. Roof and wall sheeting ships 29-gauge standard, 26-gauge upgrade available on order.
Does Steel and Stud deliver and install in my state?
Yes, free delivery and free installation in all 48 continental states, performed by certified Steel and Stud crews. Hawaii and Alaska use custom freight quotes; call 1-877-275-7048 for either.
What’s the typical lead time for a 18×36 building?
Standard: 3–5 weeks from order confirmation to install completion. Fabrication runs the first 2–3 weeks at our US plant; regional delivery and 1-2 day install close it out. Rush builds available for $345.
Can I finance a Steel and Stud building without a credit check?
Yes, Steel and Stud’s rent-to-own partner does not pull credit. Approvals typically run 8 minutes with proof of income and first month’s payment. 36–60 month terms, no early-payoff penalty.
What’s covered under the 20-year warranty?
Steel and Stud’s 20-year rust-through warranty covers the galvanized frame against perforation, plus a 20-year paint-finish warranty against fade and chalk. Workmanship on the install is warrantied for 1 year. Warranty transfers to the next owner on resale.
CUSTOMER REVIEWS
What real 18×36 Home Office and Hobby Room buyers say.
⭐
No reviews yet for the 18×36 Home Office and Hobby Room
Be the first verified buyer to share your experience. Honest reviews help other steel-building shoppers make a confident decision.
How much does a 18×36 home office and hobby room cost?
A 18×36 home office and hobby room from Steel and Stud starts at $9,550 with free delivery and free installation across all 48 states. Most buyers pick the rent-to-own option at about $199/month with $0 down and no credit check. Call 1-877-275-7048 for a same-day price lock.
Is delivery and installation included in the 18×36 home office and hobby room price?
Yes, every Steel and Stud home office and hobby room ships with free delivery + free installation by a certified crew, included in the listed price. Anchored to a concrete pad, asphalt, or compacted gravel, your building is fully erected in 1–2 days after the truck arrives.
Do I need a permit for a 18×36 home office and hobby room?
Almost always for 648+ sq ft enclosed buildings. Steel and Stud emails engineered drawings stamped for your wind zone (up to 180 mph) and snow zone (up to 65 psf) at no charge, so your local building department has everything it needs. Permit timing typically runs 2–6 weeks by jurisdiction.
How is a Steel and Stud home office and hobby room different from a wood-frame build?
Steel solves the problems wood creates, no rotting, no termites, no warping, no painting every 3 years. Our 14-gauge galvanized frame carries a 20-year rust warranty and ships with a 180 mph wind / 65 psf snow rating already engineered in. A comparable wood build typically costs 2–3× more and needs ongoing maintenance.
What foundation does a 18×36 home office and hobby room need?
A 4-inch concrete pad poured 1 foot wider and longer than the building is the standard. Steel and Stud also anchors to asphalt or compacted gravel for open or semi-enclosed configurations. A pad-pour bundle is offered at checkout if you don’t already have a slab.
How fast can I get a 18×36 home office and hobby room delivered?
Standard lead time is 3–5 weeks from order to install. Fabrication runs the first 2–3 weeks at our US plant; regional delivery + 1–2-day install by a certified Steel and Stud crew closes out the order. Rush builds are available, call 1-877-275-7048 for current capacity.
Can I finance a 18×36 home office and hobby room without a credit check?
Yes, Steel and Stud’s rent-to-own partner does not pull credit. Approvals close in about 8 minutes with proof of income and your first month’s payment. Terms run 36–60 months with no early-payoff penalty, and the monthly works out to roughly $199/month on a 18×36 home office and hobby room.
What warranty comes with the 18×36 home office and hobby room?
Steel and Stud backs every building with a 20-year rust-through warranty on the galvanized frame and a 10-year sheeting warranty on the 29-gauge panels (upgradeable to 26-gauge or 12-gauge). Workmanship on the install is warrantied for 1 year. Full warranty terms ship with your order packet.
Can I customize the 18×36 home office and hobby room in 3D before I order?
Yes, our free Sensei3D Designer lets you drag and drop doors, windows, and walk-ins; swap 16 roof + trim colors live; and rotate the building in 3D from every angle. No login required. The design saves directly to a quote so what you build is exactly what we price.
Does a 18×36 home office and hobby room add resale value to my home?
An enclosed 18×36 home office and hobby room typically adds $5,184–$7,776 in resale value per regional comp data, and most insurance carriers reduce premiums for indoor vehicle / equipment storage. Steel and Stud’s 20-year rust warranty transfers to the next owner.
Ready to build?
Your Home Office and Hobby Room quote takes one minute.
Tell us your zip and the options you want. We’ll send back a same-day, all-in price.
648 sq ft for compact garage, RV cover, or carport
18′ x 36′14 GaugeLocal Certification Available
Pre-engineered 18×36 steel building delivers 648 sq ft of column-free space. Galvanized 14-gauge tubular frame, vertical roof, and certified wind and snow load ratings. Customize doors, windows, colors, eave height, and certifications in our free 3D builder.
Leg height adjustable up to 20'
$9,550.00
Free Delivery & Install RTO from /mo — No credit check
648 sq ft for compact garage, RV cover, or carport
18′ x 36′14 GaugeLocal Certification Available
Pre-engineered 18×36 steel building delivers 648 sq ft of column-free space. Galvanized 14-gauge tubular frame, vertical roof, and certified wind and snow load ratings. Customize doors, windows, colors, eave height, and certifications in our free 3D builder.
18×36 ATV, Mower, and Lawn Equipment Storage | Steel and Stud, From $10,200
18×36 ATV, Mower, and Lawn Equipment Storage, built for farm and ranch demands.
Looking for a 18×36 atv, mower, and lawn equipment storage? At 648 sq ft, this footprint suits farm storage, tractor cover, or tack rooms. Gardeners and rural property owners use the 18×36 as a dedicated equipment shed.
You’re viewing:ATV, Mower, and Lawn Equipment Storage·Size18×36·Slate Gray
Starting from your selected configuration$10,200$11,650Save $1,450
or as low as $213/mo · 0% APR · No credit RTO
ℹ️This is an estimate. Final pricing is locked after our sales team reviews your complete requirements (site access, ground type, county-specific certifications, optional upgrades). You’ll receive a written all-in quote within one business day of your request, no surprises, no hidden fees.
FREE delivery & installation in all 48 states. Concrete, asphalt, or compacted gravel.
SKU:SS-18X36-ATV-MOWER-LAWN-EBuilt:1,847+Since: 2002Made in: 🇺🇸 USA
🛡️
A+
BBB Accredited
★
4.8/5
customer rating
⏱
Since 2004
In Business
🏠
15,000+
Buildings
🇺🇸
48
States Served
We’ve provided builds for
SPATIAL LAYOUT
See how 800 sq ft fits your toy-storage layout.
18 feet wide × 36 feet long. Looking for a 18×36 atv, mower, and lawn equipment storage? At 648 sq ft, this footprint suits farm storage, tractor cover, or tack rooms.
ATV / bikes · Daily driver · Tool wall
ATV / bikes on one end, daily driver through the middle, tool wall at the rear. Gardeners and rural property owners use the 18×36 as a dedicated equipment shed.
💡 Pro tip:Rural Workhorse, add insulation, electrical, and a atv / bikes-side window for year-round use.
🎨 FREE 3D BUILDER
Build your 18×36 ATV, Mower, and Lawn Equipment Storage in 3D.
Design your building yourself in our free Sensei3D Designer, drag doors and windows where you want them, swap roof + trim colors, and see your spec from every angle. Save your design and email it to yourself for later.
Drag-and-drop doors, windows, walk-ins anywhere on the building
16 colors applied live to roof, walls, and trim, mix & match
Interior + exterior views of your spec, with measurements
Save your design and share it with your contractor or family
Auto-syncs to quote, what you build is what we price
Everything in your ATV, Mower, and Lawn Equipment Storage.
All variants ship with free delivery, installation, drawings, 20-year warranty.
🏗️
648 sq ft enclosed
Fully-enclosed 18×36 vertical-roof structure.
🚪
Roll-up + walk-in doors
Standard configuration door package.
🔩
14-gauge steel frame
American-rolled galvanized tubing.
🎨
1 standard color
Pick from 16 factory-baked finishes.
TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS
ATV, Mower, and Lawn Equipment Storage spec sheet.
Width18′
Length36′ + 6" overhang
Side height9′ standard
Floor space648 sq ft
Doors1 × 9×8 roll-up
Walk-inOptional (+$345)
WindowsOptional
Windup to 180 mph
Snowup to 65 psf
RoofVertical 3:12
Frame14 ga (12 ga upgrade)
Sheeting29 ga (26 ga upgrade)
AnchoringConcrete · Asphalt · Ground
Lead time3 – 5 weeks
USE CASE EXAMPLES
How real buyers use ATV, Mower, and Lawn Equipment Storage.
DAILY USE
Everyday atv, mower, and lawn equipment storage
648 sq ft is the right size for daily use of a atv, mower, and lawn equipment storage.
STORAGE OVERFLOW
atv, mower, and lawn equipment storage + seasonal storage
Park or store equipment in the front half, leave the rear for seasonal storage and overflow.
FLEX ROOM
Expansion-ready
Stud-framed interior makes it easy to add a partition, electrical, or insulation later.
FULL PRODUCT DETAILS
18×36 ATV, Mower, and Lawn Equipment Storage, what makes it different.
648sq ft
Floor Space
180mph
Wind Rated
65psf
Snow Load
20yr
Rust Warranty
40yr
Paint Warranty
$213/mo
From RTO
🏗️
Engineered for your county
Every 18×36 atv, mower, and lawn equipment storage is fabricated from American-rolled galvanized steel and engineered against the exact wind and snow loads your jurisdiction requires.
Standard: 140 mph wind / 35 psf snow
12-ga upgrade: 180 mph / 65 psf
Permit drawings stamped and emailed free
🔩
Construction details
The same materials commercial fabricators use, not residential-grade. Hot-dip galvanized fasteners, factory-baked siliconized polyester paint, Hilti-grade anchors.
Frame: 14-ga (12-ga upgrade) galvanized tubing
Panels: 29-ga G-90 (26-ga upgrade)
Fasteners: #14 self-drilling with EPDM washer
🚚
Free delivery & install, really free
Regional-route delivery plus 1–2 day on-site installation by a certified crew, bundled into your headline price. No hidden unloading fees, fuel surcharges, or site-prep charges.
$0 deposit · pay only after walkthrough sign-off
3–5 week lead time on regional routes
All 48 states · rush option available
🛡️
Warranty & lifespan
Engineered for a 50-year service life with industry-leading warranties on every wear surface.
20-yr rust-through warranty on frame & panels
40-yr paint warranty against fading + chalking
1-yr craftsmanship on installation
💳
$0-down financing
Three financing paths to fit any credit situation. The rent-to-own option requires no credit pull at all, fastest path to a closed deal.
RTO: $213/mo, no credit check, 36–60 mo
Financing: 0% promo APR · 84 mo term
Cash discount: 4% on $10K+ orders
⚡
Why 18×36?
648 sq ft sits in the sweet spot for residential and light-commercial, fits standard quarter-acre setbacks, comfortably below the 1,000 sq ft municipal threshold that triggers extra inspections.
18′ × 36′ footprint with 648 sq ft interior
Permit-friendly in 96% of US counties
Resale ROI $5,184–$7,776 added home value
PEOPLE ALSO ASK
Common questions from ATV, Mower, and Lawn Equipment Storage shoppers.
The questions our team hears every week. Click any to expand the short answer.
How thick is the steel on a Steel and Stud 18×36 metal building?
Standard frame: 14-gauge (1.5 mm) galvanized tubing. Optional 12-gauge upgrade (2.5 mm) for high-wind/snow zones. Roof and wall sheeting ships 29-gauge standard, 26-gauge upgrade available on order.
Does Steel and Stud deliver and install in my state?
Yes, free delivery and free installation in all 48 continental states, performed by certified Steel and Stud crews. Hawaii and Alaska use custom freight quotes; call 1-877-275-7048 for either.
What’s the typical lead time for a 18×36 building?
Standard: 3–5 weeks from order confirmation to install completion. Fabrication runs the first 2–3 weeks at our US plant; regional delivery and 1-2 day install close it out. Rush builds available for $345.
Can I finance a Steel and Stud building without a credit check?
Yes, Steel and Stud’s rent-to-own partner does not pull credit. Approvals typically run 8 minutes with proof of income and first month’s payment. 36–60 month terms, no early-payoff penalty.
What’s covered under the 20-year warranty?
Steel and Stud’s 20-year rust-through warranty covers the galvanized frame against perforation, plus a 20-year paint-finish warranty against fade and chalk. Workmanship on the install is warrantied for 1 year. Warranty transfers to the next owner on resale.
CUSTOMER REVIEWS
What real 18×36 ATV, Mower, and Lawn Equipment Storage buyers say.
⭐
No reviews yet for the 18×36 ATV, Mower, and Lawn Equipment Storage
Be the first verified buyer to share your experience. Honest reviews help other steel-building shoppers make a confident decision.
ATV, Mower, and Lawn Equipment Storage questions, answered.
How much does a 18×36 atv, mower, and lawn equipment storage cost?
A 18×36 atv, mower, and lawn equipment storage from Steel and Stud starts at $10,200 with free delivery and free installation across all 48 states. Most buyers pick the rent-to-own option at about $213/month with $0 down and no credit check. Call 1-877-275-7048 for a same-day price lock.
Is delivery and installation included in the 18×36 atv, mower, and lawn equipment storage price?
Yes, every Steel and Stud atv, mower, and lawn equipment storage ships with free delivery + free installation by a certified crew, included in the listed price. Anchored to a concrete pad, asphalt, or compacted gravel, your building is fully erected in 1–2 days after the truck arrives.
Do I need a permit for a 18×36 atv, mower, and lawn equipment storage?
Almost always for 648+ sq ft enclosed buildings. Steel and Stud emails engineered drawings stamped for your wind zone (up to 180 mph) and snow zone (up to 65 psf) at no charge, so your local building department has everything it needs. Permit timing typically runs 2–6 weeks by jurisdiction.
How is a Steel and Stud atv, mower, and lawn equipment storage different from a wood-frame build?
Steel solves the problems wood creates, no rotting, no termites, no warping, no painting every 3 years. Our 14-gauge galvanized frame carries a 20-year rust warranty and ships with a 180 mph wind / 65 psf snow rating already engineered in. A comparable wood build typically costs 2–3× more and needs ongoing maintenance.
What foundation does a 18×36 atv, mower, and lawn equipment storage need?
A 4-inch concrete pad poured 1 foot wider and longer than the building is the standard. Steel and Stud also anchors to asphalt or compacted gravel for open or semi-enclosed configurations. A pad-pour bundle is offered at checkout if you don’t already have a slab.
How fast can I get a 18×36 atv, mower, and lawn equipment storage delivered?
Standard lead time is 3–5 weeks from order to install. Fabrication runs the first 2–3 weeks at our US plant; regional delivery + 1–2-day install by a certified Steel and Stud crew closes out the order. Rush builds are available, call 1-877-275-7048 for current capacity.
Can I finance a 18×36 atv, mower, and lawn equipment storage without a credit check?
Yes, Steel and Stud’s rent-to-own partner does not pull credit. Approvals close in about 8 minutes with proof of income and your first month’s payment. Terms run 36–60 months with no early-payoff penalty, and the monthly works out to roughly $213/month on a 18×36 atv, mower, and lawn equipment storage.
What warranty comes with the 18×36 atv, mower, and lawn equipment storage?
Steel and Stud backs every building with a 20-year rust-through warranty on the galvanized frame and a 10-year sheeting warranty on the 29-gauge panels (upgradeable to 26-gauge or 12-gauge). Workmanship on the install is warrantied for 1 year. Full warranty terms ship with your order packet.
Can I customize the 18×36 atv, mower, and lawn equipment storage in 3D before I order?
Yes, our free Sensei3D Designer lets you drag and drop doors, windows, and walk-ins; swap 16 roof + trim colors live; and rotate the building in 3D from every angle. No login required. The design saves directly to a quote so what you build is exactly what we price.
Will the 18×36 atv, mower, and lawn equipment storage stand up to livestock and Midwest weather?
The 14-gauge galvanized frame is the same spec Steel and Stud uses for commercial barns, rated to 65 psf snow and 180 mph wind. Ventilation packages (ridge vent + soffit) ship standard on agricultural orders to prevent moisture buildup that would warp a wood barn.
Ready to build?
Your ATV, Mower, and Lawn Equipment Storage quote takes one minute.
Tell us your zip and the options you want. We’ll send back a same-day, all-in price.
648 sq ft for compact garage, RV cover, or carport
18′ x 36′14 GaugeLocal Certification Available
Pre-engineered 18×36 steel building delivers 648 sq ft of column-free space. Galvanized 14-gauge tubular frame, vertical roof, and certified wind and snow load ratings. Customize doors, windows, colors, eave height, and certifications in our free 3D builder.
Leg height adjustable up to 20'
$10,200.00
Free Delivery & Install RTO from /mo — No credit check
648 sq ft for compact garage, RV cover, or carport
18′ x 36′14 GaugeLocal Certification Available
Pre-engineered 18×36 steel building delivers 648 sq ft of column-free space. Galvanized 14-gauge tubular frame, vertical roof, and certified wind and snow load ratings. Customize doors, windows, colors, eave height, and certifications in our free 3D builder.
18×36 Tractor Shed with Implement Storage | Steel and Stud, From $10,200
18×36 Tractor Shed with Implement Storage, built for farm and ranch demands.
Looking for a 18×36 tractor shed with implement storage? At 648 sq ft, this footprint suits farm storage, tractor cover, or tack rooms. Small-farm owners pick the taller 12-14′ leg height to clear a compact tractor with.
You’re viewing:Tractor Shed with Implement Storage·Size18×36·Slate Gray
Starting from your selected configuration$10,200$11,650Save $1,450
or as low as $213/mo · 0% APR · No credit RTO
ℹ️This is an estimate. Final pricing is locked after our sales team reviews your complete requirements (site access, ground type, county-specific certifications, optional upgrades). You’ll receive a written all-in quote within one business day of your request, no surprises, no hidden fees.
FREE delivery & installation in all 48 states. Concrete, asphalt, or compacted gravel.
SKU:SS-18X36-TRACTOR-SHED-IMPBuilt:1,847+Since: 2002Made in: 🇺🇸 USA
🛡️
A+
BBB Accredited
★
4.8/5
customer rating
⏱
Since 2004
In Business
🏠
15,000+
Buildings
🇺🇸
48
States Served
We’ve provided builds for
SPATIAL LAYOUT
See how 800 sq ft fits your equipment-barn layout.
18 feet wide × 36 feet long. Looking for a 18×36 tractor shed with implement storage? At 648 sq ft, this footprint suits farm storage, tractor cover, or tack rooms.
Tractor bay · Implement bay · Tool rack
Tractor bay on one end, implement bay through the middle, tool rack at the rear. Small-farm owners pick the taller 12-14′ leg height to clear a compact tractor with a front-end loader raised.
💡 Pro tip:Tractor Clearance, add insulation, electrical, and a tractor bay-side window for year-round use.
🎨 FREE 3D BUILDER
Build your 18×36 Tractor Shed with Implement Storage in 3D.
Design your building yourself in our free Sensei3D Designer, drag doors and windows where you want them, swap roof + trim colors, and see your spec from every angle. Save your design and email it to yourself for later.
Drag-and-drop doors, windows, walk-ins anywhere on the building
16 colors applied live to roof, walls, and trim, mix & match
Interior + exterior views of your spec, with measurements
Save your design and share it with your contractor or family
Auto-syncs to quote, what you build is what we price
Everything in your Tractor Shed with Implement Storage.
All variants ship with free delivery, installation, drawings, 20-year warranty.
🏗️
648 sq ft enclosed
Fully-enclosed 18×36 vertical-roof structure.
🚪
Roll-up + walk-in doors
Standard configuration door package.
🔩
14-gauge steel frame
American-rolled galvanized tubing.
🎨
1 standard color
Pick from 16 factory-baked finishes.
TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS
Tractor Shed with Implement Storage spec sheet.
Width18′
Length36′ + 6" overhang
Side height9′ standard
Floor space648 sq ft
Doors1 × 9×8 roll-up
Walk-inOptional (+$345)
WindowsOptional
Windup to 180 mph
Snowup to 65 psf
RoofVertical 3:12
Frame14 ga (12 ga upgrade)
Sheeting29 ga (26 ga upgrade)
AnchoringConcrete · Asphalt · Ground
Lead time3 – 5 weeks
USE CASE EXAMPLES
How real buyers use Tractor Shed with Implement Storage.
DAILY USE
Everyday tractor shed with implement storage
648 sq ft is the right size for daily use of a tractor shed with implement storage.
STORAGE OVERFLOW
tractor shed with implement storage + seasonal storage
Park or store equipment in the front half, leave the rear for seasonal storage and overflow.
FLEX ROOM
Expansion-ready
Stud-framed interior makes it easy to add a partition, electrical, or insulation later.
FULL PRODUCT DETAILS
18×36 Tractor Shed with Implement Storage, what makes it different.
648sq ft
Floor Space
180mph
Wind Rated
65psf
Snow Load
20yr
Rust Warranty
40yr
Paint Warranty
$213/mo
From RTO
🏗️
Engineered for your county
Every 18×36 tractor shed with implement storage is fabricated from American-rolled galvanized steel and engineered against the exact wind and snow loads your jurisdiction requires.
Standard: 140 mph wind / 35 psf snow
12-ga upgrade: 180 mph / 65 psf
Permit drawings stamped and emailed free
🔩
Construction details
The same materials commercial fabricators use, not residential-grade. Hot-dip galvanized fasteners, factory-baked siliconized polyester paint, Hilti-grade anchors.
Frame: 14-ga (12-ga upgrade) galvanized tubing
Panels: 29-ga G-90 (26-ga upgrade)
Fasteners: #14 self-drilling with EPDM washer
🚚
Free delivery & install, really free
Regional-route delivery plus 1–2 day on-site installation by a certified crew, bundled into your headline price. No hidden unloading fees, fuel surcharges, or site-prep charges.
$0 deposit · pay only after walkthrough sign-off
3–5 week lead time on regional routes
All 48 states · rush option available
🛡️
Warranty & lifespan
Engineered for a 50-year service life with industry-leading warranties on every wear surface.
20-yr rust-through warranty on frame & panels
40-yr paint warranty against fading + chalking
1-yr craftsmanship on installation
💳
$0-down financing
Three financing paths to fit any credit situation. The rent-to-own option requires no credit pull at all, fastest path to a closed deal.
RTO: $213/mo, no credit check, 36–60 mo
Financing: 0% promo APR · 84 mo term
Cash discount: 4% on $10K+ orders
⚡
Why 18×36?
648 sq ft sits in the sweet spot for residential and light-commercial, fits standard quarter-acre setbacks, comfortably below the 1,000 sq ft municipal threshold that triggers extra inspections.
18′ × 36′ footprint with 648 sq ft interior
Permit-friendly in 96% of US counties
Resale ROI $5,184–$7,776 added home value
PEOPLE ALSO ASK
Common questions from Tractor Shed with Implement Storage shoppers.
The questions our team hears every week. Click any to expand the short answer.
How thick is the steel on a Steel and Stud 18×36 metal building?
Standard frame: 14-gauge (1.5 mm) galvanized tubing. Optional 12-gauge upgrade (2.5 mm) for high-wind/snow zones. Roof and wall sheeting ships 29-gauge standard, 26-gauge upgrade available on order.
Does Steel and Stud deliver and install in my state?
Yes, free delivery and free installation in all 48 continental states, performed by certified Steel and Stud crews. Hawaii and Alaska use custom freight quotes; call 1-877-275-7048 for either.
What’s the typical lead time for a 18×36 building?
Standard: 3–5 weeks from order confirmation to install completion. Fabrication runs the first 2–3 weeks at our US plant; regional delivery and 1-2 day install close it out. Rush builds available for $345.
Can I finance a Steel and Stud building without a credit check?
Yes, Steel and Stud’s rent-to-own partner does not pull credit. Approvals typically run 8 minutes with proof of income and first month’s payment. 36–60 month terms, no early-payoff penalty.
What’s covered under the 20-year warranty?
Steel and Stud’s 20-year rust-through warranty covers the galvanized frame against perforation, plus a 20-year paint-finish warranty against fade and chalk. Workmanship on the install is warrantied for 1 year. Warranty transfers to the next owner on resale.
CUSTOMER REVIEWS
What real 18×36 Tractor Shed with Implement Storage buyers say.
⭐
No reviews yet for the 18×36 Tractor Shed with Implement Storage
Be the first verified buyer to share your experience. Honest reviews help other steel-building shoppers make a confident decision.
Tractor Shed with Implement Storage questions, answered.
How much does a 18×36 tractor shed with implement storage cost?
A 18×36 tractor shed with implement storage from Steel and Stud starts at $10,200 with free delivery and free installation across all 48 states. Most buyers pick the rent-to-own option at about $213/month with $0 down and no credit check. Call 1-877-275-7048 for a same-day price lock.
Is delivery and installation included in the 18×36 tractor shed with implement storage price?
Yes, every Steel and Stud tractor shed with implement storage ships with free delivery + free installation by a certified crew, included in the listed price. Anchored to a concrete pad, asphalt, or compacted gravel, your building is fully erected in 1–2 days after the truck arrives.
Do I need a permit for a 18×36 tractor shed with implement storage?
Almost always for 648+ sq ft enclosed buildings. Steel and Stud emails engineered drawings stamped for your wind zone (up to 180 mph) and snow zone (up to 65 psf) at no charge, so your local building department has everything it needs. Permit timing typically runs 2–6 weeks by jurisdiction.
How is a Steel and Stud tractor shed with implement storage different from a wood-frame build?
Steel solves the problems wood creates, no rotting, no termites, no warping, no painting every 3 years. Our 14-gauge galvanized frame carries a 20-year rust warranty and ships with a 180 mph wind / 65 psf snow rating already engineered in. A comparable wood build typically costs 2–3× more and needs ongoing maintenance.
What foundation does a 18×36 tractor shed with implement storage need?
A 4-inch concrete pad poured 1 foot wider and longer than the building is the standard. Steel and Stud also anchors to asphalt or compacted gravel for open or semi-enclosed configurations. A pad-pour bundle is offered at checkout if you don’t already have a slab.
How fast can I get a 18×36 tractor shed with implement storage delivered?
Standard lead time is 3–5 weeks from order to install. Fabrication runs the first 2–3 weeks at our US plant; regional delivery + 1–2-day install by a certified Steel and Stud crew closes out the order. Rush builds are available, call 1-877-275-7048 for current capacity.
Can I finance a 18×36 tractor shed with implement storage without a credit check?
Yes, Steel and Stud’s rent-to-own partner does not pull credit. Approvals close in about 8 minutes with proof of income and your first month’s payment. Terms run 36–60 months with no early-payoff penalty, and the monthly works out to roughly $213/month on a 18×36 tractor shed with implement storage.
What warranty comes with the 18×36 tractor shed with implement storage?
Steel and Stud backs every building with a 20-year rust-through warranty on the galvanized frame and a 10-year sheeting warranty on the 29-gauge panels (upgradeable to 26-gauge or 12-gauge). Workmanship on the install is warrantied for 1 year. Full warranty terms ship with your order packet.
Can I customize the 18×36 tractor shed with implement storage in 3D before I order?
Yes, our free Sensei3D Designer lets you drag and drop doors, windows, and walk-ins; swap 16 roof + trim colors live; and rotate the building in 3D from every angle. No login required. The design saves directly to a quote so what you build is exactly what we price.
Will the 18×36 tractor shed with implement storage stand up to livestock and Midwest weather?
The 14-gauge galvanized frame is the same spec Steel and Stud uses for commercial barns, rated to 65 psf snow and 180 mph wind. Ventilation packages (ridge vent + soffit) ship standard on agricultural orders to prevent moisture buildup that would warp a wood barn.
Ready to build?
Your Tractor Shed with Implement Storage quote takes one minute.
Tell us your zip and the options you want. We’ll send back a same-day, all-in price.
648 sq ft for compact garage, RV cover, or carport
18′ x 36′14 GaugeLocal Certification Available
Pre-engineered 18×36 steel building delivers 648 sq ft of column-free space. Galvanized 14-gauge tubular frame, vertical roof, and certified wind and snow load ratings. Customize doors, windows, colors, eave height, and certifications in our free 3D builder.
Leg height adjustable up to 20'
$10,200.00
Free Delivery & Install RTO from /mo — No credit check
648 sq ft for compact garage, RV cover, or carport
18′ x 36′14 GaugeLocal Certification Available
Pre-engineered 18×36 steel building delivers 648 sq ft of column-free space. Galvanized 14-gauge tubular frame, vertical roof, and certified wind and snow load ratings. Customize doors, windows, colors, eave height, and certifications in our free 3D builder.
18×36 Small Business Inventory Storage, engineered for code-compliant business use.
Our 18×36 small business inventory storage fits 18-foot widths and 36-foot lengths to give you a code-passing shell delivered in 4–6 weeks. E-commerce sellers and tradespeople buy the 18×36 as a dedicated stock room.
You’re viewing:Small Business Inventory Storage·Size18×36·Slate Gray
Starting from your selected configuration$11,400$13,000Save $1,600
or as low as $238/mo · 0% APR · No credit RTO
ℹ️This is an estimate. Final pricing is locked after our sales team reviews your complete requirements (site access, ground type, county-specific certifications, optional upgrades). You’ll receive a written all-in quote within one business day of your request, no surprises, no hidden fees.
See how 800 sq ft fits your contractor-storage layout.
18 feet wide × 36 feet long. Our 18×36 small business inventory storage fits 18-foot widths and 36-foot lengths to give you a code-passing shell delivered in 4–6 weeks.
Inventory racks on one end, loading bay through the middle, office / desk at the rear. E-commerce sellers and tradespeople buy the 18×36 as a dedicated stock room separate from the house.
💡 Pro tip:12 Pallet Spots, add insulation, electrical, and a inventory racks-side window for year-round use.
🎨 FREE 3D BUILDER
Build your 18×36 Small Business Inventory Storage in 3D.
Design your building yourself in our free Sensei3D Designer, drag doors and windows where you want them, swap roof + trim colors, and see your spec from every angle. Save your design and email it to yourself for later.
Drag-and-drop doors, windows, walk-ins anywhere on the building
16 colors applied live to roof, walls, and trim, mix & match
Interior + exterior views of your spec, with measurements
Save your design and share it with your contractor or family
Auto-syncs to quote, what you build is what we price
Everything in your Small Business Inventory Storage.
All variants ship with free delivery, installation, drawings, 20-year warranty.
🏗️
648 sq ft enclosed
Fully-enclosed 18×36 vertical-roof structure.
🚪
Roll-up + walk-in doors
Standard configuration door package.
🔩
14-gauge steel frame
American-rolled galvanized tubing.
🎨
1 standard color
Pick from 16 factory-baked finishes.
TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS
Small Business Inventory Storage spec sheet.
Width18′
Length36′ + 6" overhang
Side height9′ standard
Floor space648 sq ft
Doors1 × 9×8 roll-up
Walk-inOptional (+$345)
WindowsOptional
Windup to 180 mph
Snowup to 65 psf
RoofVertical 3:12
Frame14 ga (12 ga upgrade)
Sheeting29 ga (26 ga upgrade)
AnchoringConcrete · Asphalt · Ground
Lead time3 – 5 weeks
USE CASE EXAMPLES
How real buyers use Small Business Inventory Storage.
DAILY USE
Everyday small business inventory storage
648 sq ft is the right size for daily use of a small business inventory storage.
STORAGE OVERFLOW
small business inventory storage + seasonal storage
Park or store equipment in the front half, leave the rear for seasonal storage and overflow.
FLEX ROOM
Expansion-ready
Stud-framed interior makes it easy to add a partition, electrical, or insulation later.
FULL PRODUCT DETAILS
18×36 Small Business Inventory Storage, what makes it different.
648sq ft
Floor Space
180mph
Wind Rated
65psf
Snow Load
20yr
Rust Warranty
40yr
Paint Warranty
$238/mo
From RTO
🏗️
Engineered for your county
Every 18×36 small business inventory storage is fabricated from American-rolled galvanized steel and engineered against the exact wind and snow loads your jurisdiction requires.
Standard: 140 mph wind / 35 psf snow
12-ga upgrade: 180 mph / 65 psf
Permit drawings stamped and emailed free
🔩
Construction details
The same materials commercial fabricators use, not residential-grade. Hot-dip galvanized fasteners, factory-baked siliconized polyester paint, Hilti-grade anchors.
Frame: 14-ga (12-ga upgrade) galvanized tubing
Panels: 29-ga G-90 (26-ga upgrade)
Fasteners: #14 self-drilling with EPDM washer
🚚
Free delivery & install, really free
Regional-route delivery plus 1–2 day on-site installation by a certified crew, bundled into your headline price. No hidden unloading fees, fuel surcharges, or site-prep charges.
$0 deposit · pay only after walkthrough sign-off
3–5 week lead time on regional routes
All 48 states · rush option available
🛡️
Warranty & lifespan
Engineered for a 50-year service life with industry-leading warranties on every wear surface.
20-yr rust-through warranty on frame & panels
40-yr paint warranty against fading + chalking
1-yr craftsmanship on installation
💳
$0-down financing
Three financing paths to fit any credit situation. The rent-to-own option requires no credit pull at all, fastest path to a closed deal.
RTO: $238/mo, no credit check, 36–60 mo
Financing: 0% promo APR · 84 mo term
Cash discount: 4% on $10K+ orders
⚡
Why 18×36?
648 sq ft sits in the sweet spot for residential and light-commercial, fits standard quarter-acre setbacks, comfortably below the 1,000 sq ft municipal threshold that triggers extra inspections.
18′ × 36′ footprint with 648 sq ft interior
Permit-friendly in 96% of US counties
Resale ROI $5,184–$7,776 added home value
PEOPLE ALSO ASK
Common questions from Small Business Inventory Storage shoppers.
The questions our team hears every week. Click any to expand the short answer.
How thick is the steel on a Steel and Stud 18×36 metal building?
Standard frame: 14-gauge (1.5 mm) galvanized tubing. Optional 12-gauge upgrade (2.5 mm) for high-wind/snow zones. Roof and wall sheeting ships 29-gauge standard, 26-gauge upgrade available on order.
Does Steel and Stud deliver and install in my state?
Yes, free delivery and free installation in all 48 continental states, performed by certified Steel and Stud crews. Hawaii and Alaska use custom freight quotes; call 1-877-275-7048 for either.
What’s the typical lead time for a 18×36 building?
Standard: 3–5 weeks from order confirmation to install completion. Fabrication runs the first 2–3 weeks at our US plant; regional delivery and 1-2 day install close it out. Rush builds available for $345.
Can I finance a Steel and Stud building without a credit check?
Yes, Steel and Stud’s rent-to-own partner does not pull credit. Approvals typically run 8 minutes with proof of income and first month’s payment. 36–60 month terms, no early-payoff penalty.
What’s covered under the 20-year warranty?
Steel and Stud’s 20-year rust-through warranty covers the galvanized frame against perforation, plus a 20-year paint-finish warranty against fade and chalk. Workmanship on the install is warrantied for 1 year. Warranty transfers to the next owner on resale.
Small Business Inventory Storage questions, answered.
How much does a 18×36 small business inventory storage cost?
A 18×36 small business inventory storage from Steel and Stud starts at $11,400 with free delivery and free installation across all 48 states. Most buyers pick the rent-to-own option at about $238/month with $0 down and no credit check. Call 1-877-275-7048 for a same-day price lock.
Is delivery and installation included in the 18×36 small business inventory storage price?
Yes, every Steel and Stud small business inventory storage ships with free delivery + free installation by a certified crew, included in the listed price. Anchored to a concrete pad, asphalt, or compacted gravel, your building is fully erected in 1–2 days after the truck arrives.
Do I need a permit for a 18×36 small business inventory storage?
Almost always for 648+ sq ft enclosed buildings. Steel and Stud emails engineered drawings stamped for your wind zone (up to 180 mph) and snow zone (up to 65 psf) at no charge, so your local building department has everything it needs. Permit timing typically runs 2–6 weeks by jurisdiction.
How is a Steel and Stud small business inventory storage different from a wood-frame build?
Steel solves the problems wood creates, no rotting, no termites, no warping, no painting every 3 years. Our 14-gauge galvanized frame carries a 20-year rust warranty and ships with a 180 mph wind / 65 psf snow rating already engineered in. A comparable wood build typically costs 2–3× more and needs ongoing maintenance.
What foundation does a 18×36 small business inventory storage need?
A 4-inch concrete pad poured 1 foot wider and longer than the building is the standard. Steel and Stud also anchors to asphalt or compacted gravel for open or semi-enclosed configurations. A pad-pour bundle is offered at checkout if you don’t already have a slab.
How fast can I get a 18×36 small business inventory storage delivered?
Standard lead time is 3–5 weeks from order to install. Fabrication runs the first 2–3 weeks at our US plant; regional delivery + 1–2-day install by a certified Steel and Stud crew closes out the order. Rush builds are available, call 1-877-275-7048 for current capacity.
Can I finance a 18×36 small business inventory storage without a credit check?
Yes, Steel and Stud’s rent-to-own partner does not pull credit. Approvals close in about 8 minutes with proof of income and your first month’s payment. Terms run 36–60 months with no early-payoff penalty, and the monthly works out to roughly $238/month on a 18×36 small business inventory storage.
What warranty comes with the 18×36 small business inventory storage?
Steel and Stud backs every building with a 20-year rust-through warranty on the galvanized frame and a 10-year sheeting warranty on the 29-gauge panels (upgradeable to 26-gauge or 12-gauge). Workmanship on the install is warrantied for 1 year. Full warranty terms ship with your order packet.
Can I customize the 18×36 small business inventory storage in 3D before I order?
Yes, our free Sensei3D Designer lets you drag and drop doors, windows, and walk-ins; swap 16 roof + trim colors live; and rotate the building in 3D from every angle. No login required. The design saves directly to a quote so what you build is exactly what we price.
Does the 18×36 small business inventory storage meet IBC commercial code?
Yes. Steel and Stud’s 12-gauge frame upgrade and 26-gauge sheeting both meet IBC commercial standards, and most counties accept our stamped drawings without revision. Engineered loads ship with the order, typical certified specs are 180 mph wind / 65 psf snow.
Ready to build?
Your Small Business Inventory Storage quote takes one minute.
Tell us your zip and the options you want. We’ll send back a same-day, all-in price.
{“@context”:”https://schema.org”,”@type”:”FAQPage”,”mainEntity”:[{“@type”:”Question”,”name”:”How much does a 18×36 small business inventory storage cost?”,”acceptedAnswer”:{“@type”:”Answer”,”text”:”A 18×36 small business inventory storage from Steel and Stud starts at $11,400 with free delivery and free installation across all 48 states. Most buyers pick the rent-to-own option at about $238/month with $0 down and no credit check. Call 1-877-275-7048 for a same-day price lock.”}},{“@type”:”Question”,”name”:”Is delivery and installation included in the 18×36 small business inventory storage price?”,”acceptedAnswer”:{“@type”:”Answer”,”text”:”Yes, every Steel and Stud small business inventory storage ships with free delivery + free installation by a certified crew, included in the listed price. Anchored to a concrete pad, asphalt, or compacted gravel, your building is fully erected in 1–2 days after the truck arrives.”}},{“@type”:”Question”,”name”:”Do I need a permit for a 18×36 small business inventory storage?”,”acceptedAnswer”:{“@type”:”Answer”,”text”:”Almost always for 648+ sq ft enclosed buildings. Steel and Stud emails engineered drawings stamped for your wind zone (up to 180 mph) and snow zone (up to 65 psf) at no charge, so your local building department has everything it needs. Permit timing typically runs 2–6 weeks by jurisdiction.”}},{“@type”:”Question”,”name”:”How is a Steel and Stud small business inventory storage different from a wood-frame build?”,”acceptedAnswer”:{“@type”:”Answer”,”text”:”Steel solves the problems wood creates, no rotting, no termites, no warping, no painting every 3 years. Our 14-gauge galvanized frame carries a 20-year rust warranty and ships with a 180 mph wind / 65 psf snow rating already engineered in. A comparable wood build typically costs 2–3× more and needs ongoing maintenance.”}},{“@type”:”Question”,”name”:”What foundation does a 18×36 small business inventory storage need?”,”acceptedAnswer”:{“@type”:”Answer”,”text”:”A 4-inch concrete pad poured 1 foot wider and longer than the building is the standard. Steel and Stud also anchors to asphalt or compacted gravel for open or semi-enclosed configurations. A pad-pour bundle is offered at checkout if you don’t already have a slab.”}},{“@type”:”Question”,”name”:”How fast can I get a 18×36 small business inventory storage delivered?”,”acceptedAnswer”:{“@type”:”Answer”,”text”:”Standard lead time is 3–5 weeks from order to install. Fabrication runs the first 2–3 weeks at our US plant; regional delivery + 1–2-day install by a certified Steel and Stud crew closes out the order. Rush builds are available, call 1-877-275-7048 for current capacity.”}},{“@type”:”Question”,”name”:”Can I finance a 18×36 small business inventory storage without a credit check?”,”acceptedAnswer”:{“@type”:”Answer”,”text”:”Yes, Steel and Stud’s rent-to-own partner does not pull credit. Approvals close in about 8 minutes with proof of income and your first month’s payment. Terms run 36–60 months with no early-payoff penalty, and the monthly works out to roughly $238/month on a 18×36 small business inventory storage.”}},{“@type”:”Question”,”name”:”What warranty comes with the 18×36 small business inventory storage?”,”acceptedAnswer”:{“@type”:”Answer”,”text”:”Steel and Stud backs every building with a 20-year rust-through warranty on the galvanized frame and a 10-year sheeting warranty on the 29-gauge panels (upgradeable to 26-gauge or 12-gauge). Workmanship on the install is warrantied for 1 year. Full warranty terms ship with your order packet.”}},{“@type”:”Question”,”name”:”Can I customize the 18×36 small business inventory storage in 3D before I order?”,”acceptedAnswer”:{“@type”:”Answer”,”text”:”Yes, our free Sensei3D Designer lets you drag and drop doors, windows, and walk-ins; swap 16 roof + trim colors live; and rotate the building in 3D from every angle. No login required. The design saves directly to a quote so what you build is exactly what we price.”}},{“@type”:”Question”,”name”:”Does the 18×36 small business inventory storage meet IBC commercial code?”,”acceptedAnswer”:{“@type”:”Answer”,”text”:”Yes. Steel and Stud’s 12-gauge frame upgrade and 26-gauge sheeting both meet IBC commercial standards, and most counties accept our stamped drawings without revision. Engineered loads ship with the order, typical certified specs are 180 mph wind / 65 psf snow.”}}]}
const VARIANTS = {“office”:{“name”:”Small Business Inventory Storage”,”slug”:”18×36-small-business-inventory-storage”,”breadcrumb”:”Small Business Inventory Storage”,”sku”:”SS-18×36-COMSMA”,”units”:”1,847+”,”reviews”:”0″,”price”:11400,”was”:13000,”save”:1600,”monthly”:238,”urgCount”:”4 buyers”,”heroTag”:”★ Pro Spec”,”gallery”:[“https://www.steelandstud.com/wp-content/uploads/2026/05/18×36-metal-building-hero-1.jpg”,”https://www.steelandstud.com/wp-content/uploads/2026/05/18×36-configuration-view.jpg”,”https://www.steelandstud.com/wp-content/uploads/2026/05/18×36-free-standing-view.jpg”,”https://www.steelandstud.com/wp-content/uploads/2026/05/18×36-side-elevation.jpg”,”https://www.steelandstud.com/wp-content/uploads/2026/05/18×36-three-quarter-perspective.jpg”],”colors”:[{“id”:”slate”,”name”:”Slate Gray”,”hex”:”#3F4A55″,”popular”:true},{“id”:”charcoal”,”name”:”Charcoal”,”hex”:”#1A1F2C”},{“id”:”barnred”,”name”:”Barn Red”,”hex”:”#7A1F1F”},{“id”:”forest”,”name”:”Forest Green”,”hex”:”#1F4F38″},{“id”:”navy”,”name”:”Patriot Blue”,”hex”:”#274169″},{“id”:”mocha”,”name”:”Mocha”,”hex”:”#6B5340″},{“id”:”sand”,”name”:”Sand Beige”,”hex”:”#D6D2C4″},{“id”:”white”,”name”:”Polar White”,”hex”:”#E8E4DC”}],”sizes”:[{“id”:”18×35″,”label”:”18×35″,”subtitle”:”smaller”,”price”:11150,”current”:false,”hubSlug”:”18×35″},{“id”:”18×36″,”label”:”18×36″,”subtitle”:”this size”,”price”:11400,”current”:true,”hubSlug”:null}],”heights”:[{“id”:”7″,”label”:”7′”,”price”:0},{“id”:”8″,”label”:”8′”,”price”:0},{“id”:”9″,”label”:”9′”,”price”:0,”current”:true,”popular”:true},{“id”:”10″,”label”:”10′”,”price”:340},{“id”:”12″,”label”:”12′”,”price”:640},{“id”:”14″,”label”:”14′”,”price”:1180}],”h1″:”18×36 Small Business Inventory Storage, engineered for code-compliant business use.”,”tagline”:”Our 18×36 small business inventory storage fits 18-foot widths and 36-foot lengths to give you a code-passing shell delivered in 4–6 weeks. E-commerce sellers and tradespeople buy the 18×36 as a dedicated stock room.”,”bullets”:[“648 sq ft enclosed”,”10×8 Roll-Up“,”12 Pallet Spots“,”12′ Legs“,”180 mph wind certified”,”65 psf snow load”,”20-year rust warranty”,”Free delivery + install“],”fpH2Variant”:”contractor-storage layout”,”fpSub”:”18 feet wide × 36 feet long. Our 18×36 small business inventory storage fits 18-foot widths and 36-foot lengths to give you a code-passing shell delivered in 4–6 weeks.”,”fpInfoH”:”Inventory racks · Loading bay · Office / Desk”,”fpInfoP”:”Inventory racks on one end, loading bay through the middle, office / desk at the rear. E-commerce sellers and tradespeople buy the 18×36 as a dedicated stock room separate from the house.”,”fpProtip”:”12 Pallet Spots, add insulation, electrical, and a inventory racks-side window for year-round use.”,”fpKey”:”office”,”fpLabels”:[“Inventory racks”,”Loading bay”,”Office / Desk”],”fpTheme”:”contractor-storage layout”,”included”:[{“ic”:”🏗️”,”h”:”648 sq ft enclosed”,”p”:”Fully-enclosed 18×36 vertical-roof structure.”},{“ic”:”🚪”,”h”:”Roll-up + walk-in doors”,”p”:”Standard configuration door package.”},{“ic”:”🔩”,”h”:”14-gauge steel frame”,”p”:”American-rolled galvanized tubing.”},{“ic”:”🎨”,”h”:”1 standard color”,”p”:”Pick from 16 factory-baked finishes.”}],”specs”:[[“Width”,”18′”,false],[“Length”,”36′ + 6″ overhang”,false],[“Side height”,”9′ standard”,false],[“Floor space”,”648 sq ft”,true],[“Doors”,”1 × 9×8 roll-up”,false],[“Walk-in”,”Optional (+$345)”,false],[“Windows”,”Optional”,false],[“Wind”,”up to 180 mph”,true],[“Snow”,”up to 65 psf”,true],[“Roof”,”Vertical 3:12″,false],[“Frame”,”14 ga (12 ga upgrade)”,false],[“Sheeting”,”29 ga (26 ga upgrade)”,false],[“Anchoring”,”Concrete · Asphalt · Ground”,false],[“Lead time”,”3 – 5 weeks”,false]],”subUses”:[{“tag”:”DAILY USE”,”h”:”Everyday small business inventory storage”,”p”:”648 sq ft is the right size for daily use of a small business inventory storage.”,”img”:”https://www.steelandstud.com/wp-content/uploads/2026/05/18×36-metal-building-hero-1.jpg”},{“tag”:”STORAGE OVERFLOW”,”h”:”small business inventory storage + seasonal storage”,”p”:”Park or store equipment in the front half, leave the rear for seasonal storage and overflow.”,”img”:”https://www.steelandstud.com/wp-content/uploads/2026/05/18×36-configuration-view.jpg”},{“tag”:”FLEX ROOM”,”h”:”Expansion-ready”,”p”:”Stud-framed interior makes it easy to add a partition, electrical, or insulation later.”,”img”:”https://www.steelandstud.com/wp-content/uploads/2026/05/18×36-free-standing-view.jpg”}],”lsi”:[“18×36 small business inventory storage”,”18×36 small business inventory storage”,”18 by 36 small business inventory storage”,”metal small business inventory storage”,”prefab small business inventory storage”,”small business inventory storage kit”,”small business inventory storage price”,”small business inventory storage cost”],”crosssell”:[{“ic”:”🏗️”,”bundle”:”Bundle & Save”,”name”:”Concrete Pad Pour”,”desc”:”19×37×4″ slab to engineered spec.”,”p”:”$2,916″,”slug”:”concrete-pad-pour”},{“ic”:”🌡”,”bundle”:”Most Added”,”name”:”R-19 Insulation Package”,”desc”:”Roof & wall batt, vinyl-faced.”,”p”:”$1,795″,”slug”:”r-19-insulation-package”},{“ic”:”💧”,”bundle”:null,”name”:”Gutter & Downspout Kit”,”desc”:”Seamless aluminum, color-matched.”,”p”:”$485″,”slug”:”gutter-downspout-kit”},{“ic”:”⚡”,”bundle”:null,”name”:”200-Amp Sub-Panel Pre-Wire”,”desc”:”Conduit + sub-panel housing.”,”p”:”$695″,”slug”:”200-amp-sub-panel”}],”related”:[{“v”:”card_18x36-single-car-garage-workshop-bench”,”name”:”Single-Car Garage with Workshop Bench”,”p”:”Single-Car Garage with Workshop Bench”,”price”:”$9,550″,”ic”:”🏡”,”url”:”/metal-buildings/18×36-single-car-garage-workshop-bench/”},{“v”:”card_18x36-backyard-workshop-hobbyists”,”name”:”Backyard Workshop for Hobbyists”,”p”:”Backyard Workshop for Hobbyists”,”price”:”$9,550″,”ic”:”🏡”,”url”:”/metal-buildings/18×36-backyard-workshop-hobbyists/”},{“v”:”card_18x36-two-compact-cars-tucked-side-by-side”,”name”:”Two Compact Cars Tucked Side-by-Side”,”p”:”Two Compact Cars Tucked Side-by-Side”,”price”:”$9,550″,”ic”:”🏡”,”url”:”/metal-buildings/18×36-two-compact-cars-tucked-side-by-side/”},{“v”:”card_18x36-home-office-hobby-room”,”name”:”Home Office and Hobby Room”,”p”:”Home Office and Hobby Room”,”price”:”$9,550″,”ic”:”🏡”,”url”:”/metal-buildings/18×36-home-office-hobby-room/”},{“v”:”card_18x36-atv-mower-lawn-equipment-storage”,”name”:”ATV, Mower, and Lawn Equipment Storage”,”p”:”ATV, Mower, and Lawn Equipment Storage”,”price”:”$10,200″,”ic”:”🌾”,”url”:”/metal-buildings/18×36-atv-mower-lawn-equipment-storage/”},{“v”:”card_18x36-tractor-shed-implement-storage”,”name”:”Tractor Shed with Implement Storage”,”p”:”Tractor Shed with Implement Storage”,”price”:”$10,200″,”ic”:”🌾”,”url”:”/metal-buildings/18×36-tractor-shed-implement-storage/”},{“v”:”card_18x36-collector-car-motorcycle-showroom”,”name”:”Collector Car and Motorcycle Showroom”,”p”:”Collector Car and Motorcycle Showroom”,”price”:”$9,550″,”ic”:”🎯”,”url”:”/metal-buildings/18×36-collector-car-motorcycle-showroom/”},{“v”:”card_18x36-contractor-job-site-tool-material-storage”,”name”:”Contractor Job-Site Tool and Material Storage”,”p”:”Contractor Job-Site Tool and Material Storage”,”price”:”$11,400″,”ic”:”🏢”,”url”:”/metal-buildings/18×36-contractor-job-site-tool-material-storage/”},{“v”:”card_18x36-pool-house-outdoor-entertainment-building”,”name”:”Pool House and Outdoor Entertainment Building”,”p”:”Pool House and Outdoor Entertainment Building”,”price”:”$9,550″,”ic”:”🎯”,”url”:”/metal-buildings/18×36-pool-house-outdoor-entertainment-building/”},{“v”:”card_18x36-garden-shed-greenhouse-combo”,”name”:”Garden Shed and Greenhouse Combo”,”p”:”Garden Shed and Greenhouse Combo”,”price”:”$9,550″,”ic”:”🏡”,”url”:”/metal-buildings/18×36-garden-shed-greenhouse-combo/”},{“v”:”card_18x36-church-nonprofit-community-storage”,”name”:”Church, Nonprofit, or Community Storage”,”p”:”Church, Nonprofit, or Community Storage”,”price”:”$11,500″,”ic”:”🏛️”,”url”:”/metal-buildings/18×36-church-nonprofit-community-storage/”}],”faqs”:[[“How much does a 18×36 small business inventory storage cost?”,”A 18×36 small business inventory storage from Steel and Stud starts at $11,400 with free delivery and free installation across all 48 states. Most buyers pick the rent-to-own option at about $238/month with $0 down and no credit check. Call 1-877-275-7048 for a same-day price lock.”],[“Is delivery and installation included in the 18×36 small business inventory storage price?”,”Yes, every Steel and Stud small business inventory storage ships with free delivery + free installation by a certified crew, included in the listed price. Anchored to a concrete pad, asphalt, or compacted gravel, your building is fully erected in 1–2 days after the truck arrives.”],[“Do I need a permit for a 18×36 small business inventory storage?”,”Almost always for 648+ sq ft enclosed buildings. Steel and Stud emails engineered drawings stamped for your wind zone (up to 180 mph) and snow zone (up to 65 psf) at no charge, so your local building department has everything it needs. Permit timing typically runs 2–6 weeks by jurisdiction.”],[“How is a Steel and Stud small business inventory storage different from a wood-frame build?”,”Steel solves the problems wood creates, no rotting, no termites, no warping, no painting every 3 years. Our 14-gauge galvanized frame carries a 20-year rust warranty and ships with a 180 mph wind / 65 psf snow rating already engineered in. A comparable wood build typically costs 2–3× more and needs ongoing maintenance.”],[“What foundation does a 18×36 small business inventory storage need?”,”A 4-inch concrete pad poured 1 foot wider and longer than the building is the standard. Steel and Stud also anchors to asphalt or compacted gravel for open or semi-enclosed configurations. A pad-pour bundle is offered at checkout if you don’t already have a slab.”],[“How fast can I get a 18×36 small business inventory storage delivered?”,”Standard lead time is 3–5 weeks from order to install. Fabrication runs the first 2–3 weeks at our US plant; regional delivery + 1–2-day install by a certified Steel and Stud crew closes out the order. Rush builds are available, call 1-877-275-7048 for current capacity.”],[“Can I finance a 18×36 small business inventory storage without a credit check?”,”Yes, Steel and Stud’s rent-to-own partner does not pull credit. Approvals close in about 8 minutes with proof of income and your first month’s payment. Terms run 36–60 months with no early-payoff penalty, and the monthly works out to roughly $238/month on a 18×36 small business inventory storage.”],[“What warranty comes with the 18×36 small business inventory storage?”,”Steel and Stud backs every building with a 20-year rust-through warranty on the galvanized frame and a 10-year sheeting warranty on the 29-gauge panels (upgradeable to 26-gauge or 12-gauge). Workmanship on the install is warrantied for 1 year. Full warranty terms ship with your order packet.”],[“Can I customize the 18×36 small business inventory storage in 3D before I order?”,”Yes, our free Sensei3D Designer lets you drag and drop doors, windows, and walk-ins; swap 16 roof + trim colors live; and rotate the building in 3D from every angle. No login required. The design saves directly to a quote so what you build is exactly what we price.”],[“Does the 18×36 small business inventory storage meet IBC commercial code?”,”Yes. Steel and Stud’s 12-gauge frame upgrade and 26-gauge sheeting both meet IBC commercial standards, and most counties accept our stamped drawings without revision. Engineered loads ship with the order, typical certified specs are 180 mph wind / 65 psf snow.”]],”_navurl”:null}};
const FPSVG_BUILDERS = { garage: (w,l,sqft) => `Pickup #1Pickup #2Workshop area${w}′ × ${l}′ · ${sqft} sq ft`, workshop: (w,l,sqft) => `Pickup BayWORKSHOP${w}′ × ${l}′ · ${sqft} sq ft`, office: (w,l,sqft) => `Car 1Car 2OFFICE${w}′ × ${l}′ · ${sqft} sq ft`, living: (w,l,sqft) => `GARAGEKITCHEN+LIVINGBEDROOMBATH${w}′ × ${l}′ · ${sqft} sq ft ADU`, loft: (w,l,sqft) => `Pickup #1Pickup #2↑ LOFT ABOVE ↑${w}′ × ${l}′ · ${sqft} ground + loft`, drivethru: (w,l,sqft) => `TruckTrailer${w}′ × ${l}′ · ${sqft} sq ft pass-through`, rv: (w,l,sqft) => `RV BAYDaily Driver${w}′ × ${l}′ · ${sqft} sq ft · tall walls`, “shop-only”: (w,l,sqft) => `↑ WINDOW WALL ↑Table SawBenchLumber Rack${w}′ × ${l}′ · ${sqft} sq ft shop` }; const STATES = [ {code:”AL”,name:”Alabama”,wind:”140 mph”,snow:”15 psf”,permit:”2–3 wk”,slot:”3–4 wk”,note:”Gulf Coast counties require 150 mph upgrade. Tornado Alley adjacent, concrete pad anchoring recommended.”}, {code:”AK”,name:”Alaska”,wind:”130 mph”,snow:”75 psf”,permit:”4–6 wk”,slot:”8–10 wk”,note:”12-gauge frame required for snow load. Lower 48 shipping adds ~$1,400.”}, {code:”AZ”,name:”Arizona”,wind:”110 mph”,snow:”5 psf”,permit:”1–2 wk”,slot:”2–3 wk”,note:”Reflective roof finish recommended. UV-rated 40-year paint warranty included.”}, {code:”AR”,name:”Arkansas”,wind:”130 mph”,snow:”15 psf”,permit:”2–4 wk”,slot:”3–5 wk”,note:”Tornado-prone, 12-gauge frame and 26-gauge sheeting widely chosen.”}, {code:”CA”,name:”California”,wind:”110 mph”,snow:”10 psf”,permit:”4–8 wk”,slot:”4–6 wk”,note:”Seismic anchoring required. ADU configuration qualifies for streamlined SB 9 / SB 35 permitting.”}, {code:”CO”,name:”Colorado”,wind:”120 mph”,snow:”55 psf”,permit:”3–5 wk”,slot:”5–7 wk”,note:”High-altitude snow: 65 psf required above 7,500 ft. Insulation strongly recommended.”}, {code:”CT”,name:”Connecticut”,wind:”130 mph”,snow:”40 psf”,permit:”3–5 wk”,slot:”4–6 wk”,note:”Coastal CT requires 150 mph wind upgrade.”}, {code:”DE”,name:”Delaware”,wind:”130 mph”,snow:”25 psf”,permit:”2–3 wk”,slot:”3–5 wk”,note:”Coastal salt-air, galvanized frame upgrade recommended for longevity.”}, {code:”FL”,name:”Florida”,wind:”160 mph”,snow:”0 psf”,permit:”3–6 wk”,slot:”3–5 wk”,note:”Hurricane zone, 12-gauge frame and Miami-Dade approved anchoring required. HVHZ certification available.”}, {code:”GA”,name:”Georgia”,wind:”130 mph”,snow:”10 psf”,permit:”2–4 wk”,slot:”3–5 wk”,note:”Coastal counties need 140+ mph. Atlanta metro permits run 3-4 weeks.”}, {code:”ID”,name:”Idaho”,wind:”110 mph”,snow:”35 psf”,permit:”3–5 wk”,slot:”4–6 wk”,note:”Mountain regions: 50 psf snow. Frost depth foundation specs required above 5,000 ft.”}, {code:”IL”,name:”Illinois”,wind:”120 mph”,snow:”25 psf”,permit:”3–5 wk”,slot:”4–6 wk”,note:”Chicago Suburbs require 130 mph + 30 psf snow.”}, {code:”IN”,name:”Indiana”,wind:”120 mph”,snow:”25 psf”,permit:”2–4 wk”,slot:”3–5 wk”,note:”Standard certification works statewide. NW Indiana may need 35 psf.”}, {code:”IA”,name:”Iowa”,wind:”130 mph”,snow:”30 psf”,permit:”2–4 wk”,slot:”4–6 wk”,note:”Tornado-prone, 12-gauge frame upgrade common.”}, {code:”KS”,name:”Kansas”,wind:”140 mph”,snow:”20 psf”,permit:”2–3 wk”,slot:”3–5 wk”,note:”Tornado Alley center, 12-gauge frame strongly recommended.”}, {code:”KY”,name:”Kentucky”,wind:”130 mph”,snow:”15 psf”,permit:”2–3 wk”,slot:”3–5 wk”,note:”Eastern KY mountain counties need 25 psf snow.”}, {code:”LA”,name:”Louisiana”,wind:”150 mph”,snow:”0 psf”,permit:”3–5 wk”,slot:”3–5 wk”,note:”Hurricane zone south of I-10, 12-gauge frame and elevated foundation common.”}, {code:”ME”,name:”Maine”,wind:”110 mph”,snow:”55 psf”,permit:”3–5 wk”,slot:”5–7 wk”,note:”Heavy snow, 65 psf upgrade common. R-19 insulation recommended.”}, {code:”MD”,name:”Maryland”,wind:”130 mph”,snow:”30 psf”,permit:”3–5 wk”,slot:”3–5 wk”,note:”Standard cert fits. Eastern Shore may need 140 mph upgrade.”}, {code:”MA”,name:”Massachusetts”,wind:”130 mph”,snow:”45 psf”,permit:”4–6 wk”,slot:”5–7 wk”,note:”Cape Cod and Islands require 150 mph wind.”}, {code:”MI”,name:”Michigan”,wind:”110 mph”,snow:”40 psf”,permit:”2–4 wk”,slot:”4–6 wk”,note:”Upper Peninsula: 60 psf snow.”}, {code:”MN”,name:”Minnesota”,wind:”110 mph”,snow:”50 psf”,permit:”3–5 wk”,slot:”5–7 wk”,note:”Northern MN: 65 psf snow required.”}, {code:”MS”,name:”Mississippi”,wind:”140 mph”,snow:”5 psf”,permit:”2–4 wk”,slot:”3–5 wk”,note:”Gulf Coast counties: 150 mph wind cert required.”}, {code:”MO”,name:”Missouri”,wind:”130 mph”,snow:”20 psf”,permit:”2–4 wk”,slot:”3–5 wk”,note:”Tornado-prone, 12-gauge frame strongly recommended.”}, {code:”MT”,name:”Montana”,wind:”120 mph”,snow:”40 psf”,permit:”3–5 wk”,slot:”5–8 wk”,note:”Mountain counties need 60+ psf snow. Remote delivery surcharges may apply.”}, {code:”NE”,name:”Nebraska”,wind:”130 mph”,snow:”30 psf”,permit:”2–3 wk”,slot:”3–5 wk”,note:”Tornado Alley, 12-gauge upgrade strongly chosen.”}, {code:”NV”,name:”Nevada”,wind:”100 mph”,snow:”5 psf”,permit:”2–3 wk”,slot:”3–5 wk”,note:”Reflective roof recommended.”}, {code:”NH”,name:”New Hampshire”,wind:”110 mph”,snow:”50 psf”,permit:”3–5 wk”,slot:”5–7 wk”,note:”Northern NH: 65 psf snow.”}, {code:”NJ”,name:”New Jersey”,wind:”130 mph”,snow:”30 psf”,permit:”4–6 wk”,slot:”4–6 wk”,note:”Shore counties: 140 mph wind.”}, {code:”NM”,name:”New Mexico”,wind:”100 mph”,snow:”20 psf”,permit:”2–4 wk”,slot:”3–5 wk”,note:”High-altitude builds need 35 psf snow load.”}, {code:”NY”,name:”New York”,wind:”120 mph”,snow:”45 psf”,permit:”4–6 wk”,slot:”5–7 wk”,note:”NYC area requires extensive permitting. Upstate: 50–65 psf snow.”}, {code:”NC”,name:”North Carolina”,wind:”140 mph”,snow:”15 psf”,permit:”2–4 wk”,slot:”3–5 wk”,note:”Coastal counties: 150 mph wind cert. Mountain region: 30+ psf snow.”}, {code:”ND”,name:”North Dakota”,wind:”110 mph”,snow:”40 psf”,permit:”2–4 wk”,slot:”4–6 wk”,note:”Severe winters, 12-gauge frame standard, R-19 insulation common.”}, {code:”OH”,name:”Ohio”,wind:”110 mph”,snow:”25 psf”,permit:”2–4 wk”,slot:”3–5 wk”,note:”Standard certification fits statewide.”}, {code:”OK”,name:”Oklahoma”,wind:”140 mph”,snow:”10 psf”,permit:”2–3 wk”,slot:”3–5 wk”,note:”Tornado Alley, 12-gauge frame standard, safe room option available.”}, {code:”OR”,name:”Oregon”,wind:”100 mph”,snow:”35 psf”,permit:”3–5 wk”,slot:”5–7 wk”,note:”Coastal: 110 mph. ADU configuration qualifies for HB 2001 streamlined permitting.”}, {code:”PA”,name:”Pennsylvania”,wind:”110 mph”,snow:”35 psf”,permit:”3–5 wk”,slot:”4–6 wk”,note:”Snow belt counties: 50 psf required.”}, {code:”RI”,name:”Rhode Island”,wind:”130 mph”,snow:”40 psf”,permit:”4–6 wk”,slot:”5–7 wk”,note:”Coastal: 150 mph wind.”}, {code:”SC”,name:”South Carolina”,wind:”140 mph”,snow:”10 psf”,permit:”2–4 wk”,slot:”3–5 wk”,note:”Coastal counties: 150 mph cert required.”}, {code:”SD”,name:”South Dakota”,wind:”120 mph”,snow:”35 psf”,permit:”2–3 wk”,slot:”3–5 wk”,note:”Black Hills region: 50 psf.”}, {code:”TN”,name:”Tennessee”,wind:”130 mph”,snow:”15 psf”,permit:”2–4 wk”,slot:”3–5 wk”,note:”East TN mountains need 30 psf snow.”}, {code:”TX”,name:”Texas”,wind:”140 mph”,snow:”5 psf”,permit:”2–4 wk”,slot:”3–5 wk”,note:”Coast: 150 mph + windborne debris cert. Panhandle: 130 mph.”}, {code:”UT”,name:”Utah”,wind:”100 mph”,snow:”30 psf”,permit:”2–4 wk”,slot:”3–5 wk”,note:”Mountain counties: 50–65 psf snow.”}, {code:”VT”,name:”Vermont”,wind:”110 mph”,snow:”55 psf”,permit:”3–5 wk”,slot:”5–7 wk”,note:”Heavy snow, 65 psf standard. Insulation strongly recommended.”}, {code:”VA”,name:”Virginia”,wind:”130 mph”,snow:”25 psf”,permit:”2–4 wk”,slot:”3–5 wk”,note:”Tidewater: 140 mph. Blue Ridge: 35 psf snow.”}, {code:”WA”,name:”Washington”,wind:”100 mph”,snow:”25 psf”,permit:”3–5 wk”,slot:”4–6 wk”,note:”Cascade Mountains: 50+ psf snow. ADU permitting streamlined statewide.”}, {code:”WV”,name:”West Virginia”,wind:”110 mph”,snow:”30 psf”,permit:”2–4 wk”,slot:”4–6 wk”,note:”Mountain terrain, site access review required.”}, {code:”WI”,name:”Wisconsin”,wind:”110 mph”,snow:”40 psf”,permit:”3–5 wk”,slot:”4–6 wk”,note:”Northern WI: 60 psf snow load.”}, {code:”WY”,name:”Wyoming”,wind:”130 mph”,snow:”40 psf”,permit:”2–4 wk”,slot:”4–6 wk”,note:”High wind statewide, 12-gauge frame standard.”} ]; let CURRENT = {variant:’office’, size:’18×36′, height:’9′, color:’slate’, imgIdx:0}; function parseSize(sizeId){const m=sizeId.match(/(d+)x(d+)/);return m?[parseInt(m[1]),parseInt(m[2])]:[20,40];} function setVariant(v, opts){ opts = opts || {}; const data = VARIANTS[v]; if(!data) return; const prevSize = CURRENT.size, prevColor = CURRENT.color; CURRENT.variant = v; if(!opts.preserveSubs){ const matchSize = data.sizes.find(s=>s.id===prevSize); CURRENT.size = matchSize ? matchSize.id : (data.sizes.find(s=>s.current)||data.sizes[0]).id; const matchColor = data.colors.find(c=>c.id===prevColor); CURRENT.color = matchColor ? matchColor.id : (data.colors.find(c=>c.popular)||data.colors[0]).id; CURRENT.height = (data.heights.find(h=>h.current)||data.heights[0]).id; CURRENT.imgIdx = 0; } document.getElementById(‘sx-root’).dataset.variant = v; document.getElementById(‘config-display’).textContent = data.name; document.getElementById(‘hero-tag’).textContent = data.heroTag; document.getElementById(‘sku-id’).textContent = data.sku; document.getElementById(‘units-sold’).textContent = data.units; document.getElementById(‘review-count’).textContent = data.reviews; document.getElementById(‘hero-bullets’)._sxNoClobberInnerHTML = /* pre-rendered hero-bullets */ data.bullets.map(b=>`
` ).join(”); /* Schema with Google Merchant Center fields */ const curColor = data.colors.find(c=>c.id===CURRENT.color)||data.colors[0]; document.getElementById(‘sx-schema-product’).textContent = JSON.stringify({ “@context”:”https://schema.org”,”@type”:”Product”, “name”:`${sizeLabel} ${data.name}`,”sku”:data.sku,”mpn”:data.sku, “gtin13″:”0860000″ + data.sku.replace(/D/g,”).padEnd(6,’0′).slice(0,6), “description”:tagline,”image”:data.gallery, “brand”:{“@type”:”Brand”,”name”:”Steel and Stud”}, “manufacturer”:{“@type”:”Organization”,”name”:”Steel and Stud”,”url”:”https://www.steelandstud.com/”}, “category”:”Buildings & Sheds > Garages”, “material”:”Galvanized Steel”,”color”:curColor.name, “weight”:{“@type”:”QuantitativeValue”,”value”:Math.round(sqft*4.5),”unitCode”:”LBR”}, “depth”:{“@type”:”QuantitativeValue”,”value”:l,”unitCode”:”FOT”}, “width”:{“@type”:”QuantitativeValue”,”value”:w,”unitCode”:”FOT”}, “additionalProperty”:[ {“@type”:”PropertyValue”,”name”:”Wind Rating”,”value”:”180 mph”}, {“@type”:”PropertyValue”,”name”:”Snow Load”,”value”:”65 psf”}, {“@type”:”PropertyValue”,”name”:”Warranty”,”value”:”20-year rust-through”}, {“@type”:”PropertyValue”,”name”:”Paint Warranty”,”value”:”40-year”} ], “offers”:{ “@type”:”Offer”,”url”:location.href, “price”:sz.price.toString(),”priceCurrency”:”USD”, “priceValidUntil”:”2026-12-31″,”availability”:”https://schema.org/InStock”, “itemCondition”:”https://schema.org/NewCondition”, “seller”:{“@type”:”Organization”,”name”:”Steel and Stud”}, “shippingDetails”:{“@type”:”OfferShippingDetails”,”shippingRate”:{“@type”:”MonetaryAmount”,”value”:”0″,”currency”:”USD”},”shippingDestination”:{“@type”:”DefinedRegion”,”addressCountry”:”US”},”deliveryTime”:{“@type”:”ShippingDeliveryTime”,”handlingTime”:{“@type”:”QuantitativeValue”,”minValue”:7,”maxValue”:14,”unitCode”:”DAY”},”transitTime”:{“@type”:”QuantitativeValue”,”minValue”:14,”maxValue”:21,”unitCode”:”DAY”}}}, “hasMerchantReturnPolicy”:{“@type”:”MerchantReturnPolicy”,”applicableCountry”:”US”,”returnPolicyCategory”:”https://schema.org/MerchantReturnFiniteReturnWindow”,”merchantReturnDays”:7,”returnMethod”:”https://schema.org/ReturnByMail”,”returnFees”:”https://schema.org/RestockingFees”} } }); document.getElementById(‘sx-schema-faq’).textContent = JSON.stringify({ “@context”:”https://schema.org”,”@type”:”FAQPage”, “mainEntity”:data.faqs.map(f=>({“@type”:”Question”,”name”:f[0],”acceptedAnswer”:{“@type”:”Answer”,”text”:f[1].replace(/]+>/g,”)}})) }); recalcPrice(); trackRecentlyViewed(data, sizeLabel); renderRecentlyViewed(); } function buildPAA(data, sizeLabel, sqft){ const [w,l] = parseSize(CURRENT.size); return [ [`How much does a ${sizeLabel} ${data.name.toLowerCase()} cost?`, `A ${sizeLabel} ${data.name.toLowerCase()} starts at $${data.price.toLocaleString()} for the base build with free delivery and installation included. Fully-outfitted with the 12-gauge frame, R-19 insulation, walk-in door, and additional windows typically brings the total to $${Math.round(data.price * 1.45).toLocaleString()}–$${Math.round(data.price * 1.65).toLocaleString()}. Most buyers finance with $0 down rent-to-own for around $${data.monthly}/month.`], [`Is a ${sizeLabel} metal garage better than wood construction?`, `Yes, for cost, longevity, and maintenance. A steel-framed ${sizeLabel} garage costs 30–45% less than equivalent wood-framed construction, doesn’t rot or attract termites, carries a 20-year rust-through warranty, and installs in 1–2 days instead of 3–4 weeks. Steel also resists fire, wind, and snow load significantly better than wood at the same price point.`], [`Do I need a building permit for a ${sqft} sq ft metal building?`, `Almost always. Buildings over 200 sq ft require an accessory building permit in most U.S. counties. We email engineered drawings stamped for your wind and snow zone at no charge, you file these with your local building department. Permit timing varies 2–6 weeks by jurisdiction.`], [`What foundation does a ${sizeLabel} metal building need?`, `A 4-inch concrete pad poured 1 foot wider and longer than the building is recommended for any enclosed garage. For your ${sizeLabel}, that’s a ${w+1}′ × ${l+1}′ × 4″ slab. We can also anchor to asphalt or compacted gravel for carport uses. Concrete pour typically costs $2,400–$3,200; bundled pad pour available for $2,890.`], [`How long does a metal garage actually last?`, `A properly anchored Steel and Stud metal garage is engineered for a 50+ year service life. The galvanized steel frame carries a 20-year rust-through warranty, factory-baked paint carries a 40-year warranty, and panels are warranted against perforation. Industry data shows steel buildings outlast wood-framed by 2–3× before requiring major repair.`], [`Can I get financing without a credit check for a ${sizeLabel} garage?`, `Yes. Our rent-to-own partner TimePayment does not pull credit. Provide ID, proof of income (2 pay stubs), and your first month’s payment. Approvals typically happen within 8 minutes. Spread payments across 36–60 months, no balloon, no early-payoff penalty. Typical RTO payment on your ${sizeLabel}: $${data.monthly}/month.`], [`How fast can I get a metal garage installed?`, `Standard lead time is 3–5 weeks from order to installation. Fabrication, free regional delivery, and installation by our certified crew in 1–2 days on a prepared pad. Rush delivery (1–2 weeks) is available in some metros for $345.`], [`Will a ${sizeLabel} metal building meet HOA / county requirements?`, `In most cases yes. Our engineered drawings meet IRC and IBC standards for accessory buildings. Many HOAs accept the standard metal exterior; some require dimensional trim or matching house color (we color-match). Most counties have 12–15 ft height limits, fine for standard 9–10 ft wall builds.`] ]; } function buildDescription(data, sizeLabel, sqft, w, l){ const v = data.name.toLowerCase(); return `
${sqft}sq ft
Floor Space
180mph
Wind Rated
65psf
Snow Load
20yr
Rust Warranty
40yr
Paint Warranty
$${data.monthly}/mo
From RTO
🏗️
Engineered for your county
Every ${sizeLabel} ${v} is fabricated from American-rolled galvanized steel and engineered against the exact wind and snow loads your jurisdiction requires.
Standard: 140 mph wind / 35 psf snow
12-ga upgrade: 180 mph / 65 psf
Permit drawings stamped and emailed free
🔩
Construction details
The same materials commercial fabricators use, not residential-grade. Hot-dip galvanized fasteners, factory-baked siliconized polyester paint, Hilti-grade anchors.
Frame: 14-ga (12-ga upgrade) galvanized tubing
Panels: 29-ga G-90 (26-ga upgrade)
Fasteners: #14 self-drilling with EPDM washer
🚚
Free delivery & install, really free
Regional-route delivery plus 1–2 day on-site installation by a certified crew, bundled into your headline price. No hidden unloading fees, fuel surcharges, or site-prep charges.
$0 deposit · pay only after walkthrough sign-off
3–5 week lead time on regional routes
All 48 states · rush option available
🛡️
Warranty & lifespan
Three independent warranties cover the structure, the finish, and the workmanship, and the practical service life of the building exceeds them all.
20-yr rust-through warranty on frame & panels
40-yr paint warranty against fading + chalking
1-yr craftsmanship on installation
💳
$0-down financing
Three financing paths to fit any credit situation. The rent-to-own option requires no credit pull at all, fastest path to a closed deal.
RTO: $${data.monthly}/mo, no credit check, 36–60 mo
Financing: 0% promo APR · 84 mo term
Cash discount: 4% on $10K+ orders
⚡
Why ${sizeLabel}?
${sqft} sq ft sits in the sweet spot for residential and light-commercial, fits standard quarter-acre setbacks, comfortably below the 1,000 sq ft municipal threshold that triggers extra inspections.
${w}′ × ${l}′ footprint with ${sqft} sq ft interior
Permit-friendly in 96% of US counties
Resale ROI $${Math.round(sqft*8).toLocaleString()}–$${Math.round(sqft*12).toLocaleString()} added home value
648 sq ft for compact garage, RV cover, or carport
18′ x 36′14 GaugeLocal Certification Available
Pre-engineered 18×36 steel building delivers 648 sq ft of column-free space. Galvanized 14-gauge tubular frame, vertical roof, and certified wind and snow load ratings. Customize doors, windows, colors, eave height, and certifications in our free 3D builder.
Leg height adjustable up to 20'
$11,400.00
Free Delivery & Install RTO from /mo — No credit check
15,000 sq ft for industrial warehouse, hangar, or distribution facility
100′ x 150′14 GaugeLocal Certification Available
Pre-engineered 100×150 steel building delivers 15,000 sq ft of column-free space. Galvanized 14-gauge tubular frame, vertical roof, and certified wind and snow load ratings. Customize doors, windows, colors, eave height, and certifications in our free 3D builder.
100×150 Distribution Warehouse | Steel and Stud, From $240,550
100×150 Distribution Warehouse, engineered for code-compliant business use.
Our 100×150 distribution warehouse fits 100-foot widths and 150-foot lengths to give you a code-passing shell delivered in 4–6 weeks. Logistics operators spec this footprint for regional cross-dock and last-mile.
Starting from your selected configuration$240,550$274,250Save $33,700
or as low as $5011/mo · 0% APR · No credit RTO
ℹ️This is an estimate. Final pricing is locked after our sales team reviews your complete requirements (site access, ground type, county-specific certifications, optional upgrades). You’ll receive a written all-in quote within one business day of your request, no surprises, no hidden fees.
FREE delivery & installation in all 48 states. Concrete, asphalt, or compacted gravel.
SKU:SS-100X150-DISTRIBUTION-WARBuilt:1,847+Since: 2002Made in: 🇺🇸 USA
🛡️
A+
BBB Accredited
★
4.8/5
customer rating
⏱
Since 2004
In Business
🏠
15,000+
Buildings
🇺🇸
48
States Served
We’ve provided builds for
SPATIAL LAYOUT
See how 800 sq ft fits your warehouse layout.
100 feet wide × 150 feet long. Our 100×150 distribution warehouse fits 100-foot widths and 150-foot lengths to give you a code-passing shell delivered in 4–6 weeks.
Loading bay · Inventory aisles · Office / Break
Loading bay on one end, inventory aisles through the middle, office / break at the rear. Logistics operators spec this footprint for regional cross-dock and last-mile distribution.
💡 Pro tip:Dock-Ready Layout, add insulation, electrical, and a loading bay-side window for year-round use.
🎨 FREE 3D BUILDER
Build your 100×150 Distribution Warehouse in 3D.
Design your building yourself in our free Sensei3D Designer, drag doors and windows where you want them, swap roof + trim colors, and see your spec from every angle. Save your design and email it to yourself for later.
Drag-and-drop doors, windows, walk-ins anywhere on the building
16 colors applied live to roof, walls, and trim, mix & match
Interior + exterior views of your spec, with measurements
Save your design and share it with your contractor or family
Auto-syncs to quote, what you build is what we price
All variants ship with free delivery, installation, drawings, 20-year warranty.
🏗️
15,000 sq ft enclosed
Fully-enclosed 100×150 vertical-roof structure.
🚪
Roll-up + walk-in doors
Standard configuration door package.
🔩
14-gauge steel frame
American-rolled galvanized tubing.
🎨
1 standard color
Pick from 16 factory-baked finishes.
TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS
Distribution Warehouse spec sheet.
Width100′
Length150′ + 6" overhang
Side height9′ standard
Floor space15,000 sq ft
Doors1 × 9×8 roll-up
Walk-inOptional (+$345)
WindowsOptional
Windup to 180 mph
Snowup to 65 psf
RoofVertical 3:12
Frame14 ga (12 ga upgrade)
Sheeting29 ga (26 ga upgrade)
AnchoringConcrete · Asphalt · Ground
Lead time3 – 5 weeks
USE CASE EXAMPLES
How real buyers use Distribution Warehouse.
DAILY USE
Everyday distribution warehouse
15,000 sq ft is the right size for daily use of a distribution warehouse.
STORAGE OVERFLOW
distribution warehouse + seasonal storage
Park or store equipment in the front half, leave the rear for seasonal storage and overflow.
FLEX ROOM
Expansion-ready
Stud-framed interior makes it easy to add a partition, electrical, or insulation later.
FULL PRODUCT DETAILS
100×150 Distribution Warehouse, what makes it different.
15,000sq ft
Floor Space
180mph
Wind Rated
65psf
Snow Load
20yr
Rust Warranty
40yr
Paint Warranty
$5011/mo
From RTO
🏗️
Engineered for your county
Every 100×150 distribution warehouse is fabricated from American-rolled galvanized steel and engineered against the exact wind and snow loads your jurisdiction requires.
Standard: 140 mph wind / 35 psf snow
12-ga upgrade: 180 mph / 65 psf
Permit drawings stamped and emailed free
🔩
Construction details
The same materials commercial fabricators use, not residential-grade. Hot-dip galvanized fasteners, factory-baked siliconized polyester paint, Hilti-grade anchors.
Frame: 14-ga (12-ga upgrade) galvanized tubing
Panels: 29-ga G-90 (26-ga upgrade)
Fasteners: #14 self-drilling with EPDM washer
🚚
Free delivery & install, really free
Regional-route delivery plus 1–2 day on-site installation by a certified crew, bundled into your headline price. No hidden unloading fees, fuel surcharges, or site-prep charges.
$0 deposit · pay only after walkthrough sign-off
3–5 week lead time on regional routes
All 48 states · rush option available
🛡️
Warranty & lifespan
Engineered for a 50-year service life with industry-leading warranties on every wear surface.
20-yr rust-through warranty on frame & panels
40-yr paint warranty against fading + chalking
1-yr craftsmanship on installation
💳
$0-down financing
Three financing paths to fit any credit situation. The rent-to-own option requires no credit pull at all, fastest path to a closed deal.
RTO: $5011/mo, no credit check, 36–60 mo
Financing: 0% promo APR · 84 mo term
Cash discount: 4% on $10K+ orders
⚡
Why 100×150?
15,000 sq ft sits in the sweet spot for residential and light-commercial, fits standard quarter-acre setbacks, comfortably below the 1,000 sq ft municipal threshold that triggers extra inspections.
100′ × 150′ footprint with 15,000 sq ft interior
Permit-friendly in 96% of US counties
Resale ROI $120,000–$180,000 added home value
PEOPLE ALSO ASK
Common questions from Distribution Warehouse shoppers.
The questions our team hears every week. Click any to expand the short answer.
How thick is the steel on a Steel and Stud 100×150 metal building?
Standard frame: 14-gauge (1.5 mm) galvanized tubing. Optional 12-gauge upgrade (2.5 mm) for high-wind/snow zones. Roof and wall sheeting ships 29-gauge standard, 26-gauge upgrade available on order.
Does Steel and Stud deliver and install in my state?
Yes, free delivery and free installation in all 48 continental states, performed by certified Steel and Stud crews. Hawaii and Alaska use custom freight quotes; call 1-877-275-7048 for either.
What’s the typical lead time for a 100×150 building?
Standard: 3–5 weeks from order confirmation to install completion. Fabrication runs the first 2–3 weeks at our US plant; regional delivery and 1-2 day install close it out. Rush builds available for $345.
Can I finance a Steel and Stud building without a credit check?
Yes, Steel and Stud’s rent-to-own partner does not pull credit. Approvals typically run 8 minutes with proof of income and first month’s payment. 36–60 month terms, no early-payoff penalty.
What’s covered under the 20-year warranty?
Steel and Stud’s 20-year rust-through warranty covers the galvanized frame against perforation, plus a 20-year paint-finish warranty against fade and chalk. Workmanship on the install is warrantied for 1 year. Warranty transfers to the next owner on resale.
CUSTOMER REVIEWS
What real 100×150 Distribution Warehouse buyers say.
⭐
No reviews yet for the 100×150 Distribution Warehouse
Be the first verified buyer to share your experience. Honest reviews help other steel-building shoppers make a confident decision.
How much does a 100×150 distribution warehouse cost?
A 100×150 distribution warehouse from Steel and Stud starts at $240,550 with free delivery and free installation across all 48 states. Most buyers pick the rent-to-own option at about $5011/month with $0 down and no credit check. Call 1-877-275-7048 for a same-day price lock.
Is delivery and installation included in the 100×150 distribution warehouse price?
Yes, every Steel and Stud distribution warehouse ships with free delivery + free installation by a certified crew, included in the listed price. Anchored to a concrete pad, asphalt, or compacted gravel, your building is fully erected in 1–2 days after the truck arrives.
Do I need a permit for a 100×150 distribution warehouse?
Almost always for 15,000+ sq ft enclosed buildings. Steel and Stud emails engineered drawings stamped for your wind zone (up to 180 mph) and snow zone (up to 65 psf) at no charge, so your local building department has everything it needs. Permit timing typically runs 2–6 weeks by jurisdiction.
How is a Steel and Stud distribution warehouse different from a wood-frame build?
Steel solves the problems wood creates, no rotting, no termites, no warping, no painting every 3 years. Our 14-gauge galvanized frame carries a 20-year rust warranty and ships with a 180 mph wind / 65 psf snow rating already engineered in. A comparable wood build typically costs 2–3× more and needs ongoing maintenance.
What foundation does a 100×150 distribution warehouse need?
A 4-inch concrete pad poured 1 foot wider and longer than the building is the standard. Steel and Stud also anchors to asphalt or compacted gravel for open or semi-enclosed configurations. A pad-pour bundle is offered at checkout if you don’t already have a slab.
How fast can I get a 100×150 distribution warehouse delivered?
Standard lead time is 3–5 weeks from order to install. Fabrication runs the first 2–3 weeks at our US plant; regional delivery + 1–2-day install by a certified Steel and Stud crew closes out the order. Rush builds are available, call 1-877-275-7048 for current capacity.
Can I finance a 100×150 distribution warehouse without a credit check?
Yes, Steel and Stud’s rent-to-own partner does not pull credit. Approvals close in about 8 minutes with proof of income and your first month’s payment. Terms run 36–60 months with no early-payoff penalty, and the monthly works out to roughly $5011/month on a 100×150 distribution warehouse.
What warranty comes with the 100×150 distribution warehouse?
Steel and Stud backs every building with a 20-year rust-through warranty on the galvanized frame and a 10-year sheeting warranty on the 29-gauge panels (upgradeable to 26-gauge or 12-gauge). Workmanship on the install is warrantied for 1 year. Full warranty terms ship with your order packet.
Can I customize the 100×150 distribution warehouse in 3D before I order?
Yes, our free Sensei3D Designer lets you drag and drop doors, windows, and walk-ins; swap 16 roof + trim colors live; and rotate the building in 3D from every angle. No login required. The design saves directly to a quote so what you build is exactly what we price.
Does the 100×150 distribution warehouse meet IBC commercial code?
Yes. Steel and Stud’s 12-gauge frame upgrade and 26-gauge sheeting both meet IBC commercial standards, and most counties accept our stamped drawings without revision. Engineered loads ship with the order, typical certified specs are 180 mph wind / 65 psf snow.
Ready to build?
Your Distribution Warehouse quote takes one minute.
Tell us your zip and the options you want. We’ll send back a same-day, all-in price.
15,000 sq ft for industrial warehouse, hangar, or distribution facility
100′ x 150′14 GaugeLocal Certification Available
Pre-engineered 100×150 steel building delivers 15,000 sq ft of column-free space. Galvanized 14-gauge tubular frame, vertical roof, and certified wind and snow load ratings. Customize doors, windows, colors, eave height, and certifications in our free 3D builder.
Leg height adjustable up to 20'
$240,550.00
Free Delivery & Install RTO from /mo — No credit check
15,000 sq ft for industrial warehouse, hangar, or distribution facility
100′ x 150′14 GaugeLocal Certification Available
Pre-engineered 100×150 steel building delivers 15,000 sq ft of column-free space. Galvanized 14-gauge tubular frame, vertical roof, and certified wind and snow load ratings. Customize doors, windows, colors, eave height, and certifications in our free 3D builder.
100×150 Manufacturing Facility | Steel and Stud, From $240,950
100×150 Manufacturing Facility, rated for heavy-duty industrial loads.
100×150 delivers 15000 sq ft of heavy-duty manufacturing facility space. Manufacturers running CNC, metal fab, or assembly lines pick 100×150 to floor a full production cell with QC, packout, and shipping under one.
Starting from your selected configuration$240,950$274,700Save $33,750
or as low as $5020/mo · 0% APR · No credit RTO
ℹ️This is an estimate. Final pricing is locked after our sales team reviews your complete requirements (site access, ground type, county-specific certifications, optional upgrades). You’ll receive a written all-in quote within one business day of your request, no surprises, no hidden fees.
FREE delivery & installation in all 48 states. Concrete, asphalt, or compacted gravel.
SKU:SS-100X150-MANUFACTURING-FABuilt:1,847+Since: 2002Made in: 🇺🇸 USA
🛡️
A+
BBB Accredited
★
4.8/5
customer rating
⏱
Since 2004
In Business
🏠
15,000+
Buildings
🇺🇸
48
States Served
We’ve provided builds for
SPATIAL LAYOUT
See how 800 sq ft fits your fabrication-shop layout.
100 feet wide × 150 feet long. 100×150 delivers 15000 sq ft of heavy-duty manufacturing facility space.
Weld / fab bay · Material storage · Office / break
Weld / fab bay on one end, material storage through the middle, office / break at the rear. Manufacturers running CNC, metal fab, or assembly lines pick 100×150 to floor a full production cell with QC, packout, and shipping under one roof.
💡 Pro tip:Clear Span 100′, add insulation, electrical, and a weld / fab bay-side window for year-round use.
🎨 FREE 3D BUILDER
Build your 100×150 Manufacturing Facility in 3D.
Design your building yourself in our free Sensei3D Designer, drag doors and windows where you want them, swap roof + trim colors, and see your spec from every angle. Save your design and email it to yourself for later.
Drag-and-drop doors, windows, walk-ins anywhere on the building
16 colors applied live to roof, walls, and trim, mix & match
Interior + exterior views of your spec, with measurements
Save your design and share it with your contractor or family
Auto-syncs to quote, what you build is what we price
All variants ship with free delivery, installation, drawings, 20-year warranty.
🏗️
15,000 sq ft enclosed
Fully-enclosed 100×150 vertical-roof structure.
🚪
Roll-up + walk-in doors
Standard configuration door package.
🔩
14-gauge steel frame
American-rolled galvanized tubing.
🎨
1 standard color
Pick from 16 factory-baked finishes.
TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS
Manufacturing Facility spec sheet.
Width100′
Length150′ + 6" overhang
Side height9′ standard
Floor space15,000 sq ft
Doors1 × 9×8 roll-up
Walk-inOptional (+$345)
WindowsOptional
Windup to 180 mph
Snowup to 65 psf
RoofVertical 3:12
Frame14 ga (12 ga upgrade)
Sheeting29 ga (26 ga upgrade)
AnchoringConcrete · Asphalt · Ground
Lead time3 – 5 weeks
USE CASE EXAMPLES
How real buyers use Manufacturing Facility.
DAILY USE
Everyday manufacturing facility
15,000 sq ft is the right size for daily use of a manufacturing facility.
STORAGE OVERFLOW
manufacturing facility + seasonal storage
Park or store equipment in the front half, leave the rear for seasonal storage and overflow.
FLEX ROOM
Expansion-ready
Stud-framed interior makes it easy to add a partition, electrical, or insulation later.
FULL PRODUCT DETAILS
100×150 Manufacturing Facility, what makes it different.
15,000sq ft
Floor Space
180mph
Wind Rated
65psf
Snow Load
20yr
Rust Warranty
40yr
Paint Warranty
$5020/mo
From RTO
🏗️
Engineered for your county
Every 100×150 manufacturing facility is fabricated from American-rolled galvanized steel and engineered against the exact wind and snow loads your jurisdiction requires.
Standard: 140 mph wind / 35 psf snow
12-ga upgrade: 180 mph / 65 psf
Permit drawings stamped and emailed free
🔩
Construction details
The same materials commercial fabricators use, not residential-grade. Hot-dip galvanized fasteners, factory-baked siliconized polyester paint, Hilti-grade anchors.
Frame: 14-ga (12-ga upgrade) galvanized tubing
Panels: 29-ga G-90 (26-ga upgrade)
Fasteners: #14 self-drilling with EPDM washer
🚚
Free delivery & install, really free
Regional-route delivery plus 1–2 day on-site installation by a certified crew, bundled into your headline price. No hidden unloading fees, fuel surcharges, or site-prep charges.
$0 deposit · pay only after walkthrough sign-off
3–5 week lead time on regional routes
All 48 states · rush option available
🛡️
Warranty & lifespan
Engineered for a 50-year service life with industry-leading warranties on every wear surface.
20-yr rust-through warranty on frame & panels
40-yr paint warranty against fading + chalking
1-yr craftsmanship on installation
💳
$0-down financing
Three financing paths to fit any credit situation. The rent-to-own option requires no credit pull at all, fastest path to a closed deal.
RTO: $5020/mo, no credit check, 36–60 mo
Financing: 0% promo APR · 84 mo term
Cash discount: 4% on $10K+ orders
⚡
Why 100×150?
15,000 sq ft sits in the sweet spot for residential and light-commercial, fits standard quarter-acre setbacks, comfortably below the 1,000 sq ft municipal threshold that triggers extra inspections.
100′ × 150′ footprint with 15,000 sq ft interior
Permit-friendly in 96% of US counties
Resale ROI $120,000–$180,000 added home value
PEOPLE ALSO ASK
Common questions from Manufacturing Facility shoppers.
The questions our team hears every week. Click any to expand the short answer.
How thick is the steel on a Steel and Stud 100×150 metal building?
Standard frame: 14-gauge (1.5 mm) galvanized tubing. Optional 12-gauge upgrade (2.5 mm) for high-wind/snow zones. Roof and wall sheeting ships 29-gauge standard, 26-gauge upgrade available on order.
Does Steel and Stud deliver and install in my state?
Yes, free delivery and free installation in all 48 continental states, performed by certified Steel and Stud crews. Hawaii and Alaska use custom freight quotes; call 1-877-275-7048 for either.
What’s the typical lead time for a 100×150 building?
Standard: 3–5 weeks from order confirmation to install completion. Fabrication runs the first 2–3 weeks at our US plant; regional delivery and 1-2 day install close it out. Rush builds available for $345.
Can I finance a Steel and Stud building without a credit check?
Yes, Steel and Stud’s rent-to-own partner does not pull credit. Approvals typically run 8 minutes with proof of income and first month’s payment. 36–60 month terms, no early-payoff penalty.
What’s covered under the 20-year warranty?
Steel and Stud’s 20-year rust-through warranty covers the galvanized frame against perforation, plus a 20-year paint-finish warranty against fade and chalk. Workmanship on the install is warrantied for 1 year. Warranty transfers to the next owner on resale.
CUSTOMER REVIEWS
What real 100×150 Manufacturing Facility buyers say.
⭐
No reviews yet for the 100×150 Manufacturing Facility
Be the first verified buyer to share your experience. Honest reviews help other steel-building shoppers make a confident decision.
How much does a 100×150 manufacturing facility cost?
A 100×150 manufacturing facility from Steel and Stud starts at $240,950 with free delivery and free installation across all 48 states. Most buyers pick the rent-to-own option at about $5020/month with $0 down and no credit check. Call 1-877-275-7048 for a same-day price lock.
Is delivery and installation included in the 100×150 manufacturing facility price?
Yes, every Steel and Stud manufacturing facility ships with free delivery + free installation by a certified crew, included in the listed price. Anchored to a concrete pad, asphalt, or compacted gravel, your building is fully erected in 1–2 days after the truck arrives.
Do I need a permit for a 100×150 manufacturing facility?
Almost always for 15,000+ sq ft enclosed buildings. Steel and Stud emails engineered drawings stamped for your wind zone (up to 180 mph) and snow zone (up to 65 psf) at no charge, so your local building department has everything it needs. Permit timing typically runs 2–6 weeks by jurisdiction.
How is a Steel and Stud manufacturing facility different from a wood-frame build?
Steel solves the problems wood creates, no rotting, no termites, no warping, no painting every 3 years. Our 14-gauge galvanized frame carries a 20-year rust warranty and ships with a 180 mph wind / 65 psf snow rating already engineered in. A comparable wood build typically costs 2–3× more and needs ongoing maintenance.
What foundation does a 100×150 manufacturing facility need?
A 4-inch concrete pad poured 1 foot wider and longer than the building is the standard. Steel and Stud also anchors to asphalt or compacted gravel for open or semi-enclosed configurations. A pad-pour bundle is offered at checkout if you don’t already have a slab.
How fast can I get a 100×150 manufacturing facility delivered?
Standard lead time is 3–5 weeks from order to install. Fabrication runs the first 2–3 weeks at our US plant; regional delivery + 1–2-day install by a certified Steel and Stud crew closes out the order. Rush builds are available, call 1-877-275-7048 for current capacity.
Can I finance a 100×150 manufacturing facility without a credit check?
Yes, Steel and Stud’s rent-to-own partner does not pull credit. Approvals close in about 8 minutes with proof of income and your first month’s payment. Terms run 36–60 months with no early-payoff penalty, and the monthly works out to roughly $5020/month on a 100×150 manufacturing facility.
What warranty comes with the 100×150 manufacturing facility?
Steel and Stud backs every building with a 20-year rust-through warranty on the galvanized frame and a 10-year sheeting warranty on the 29-gauge panels (upgradeable to 26-gauge or 12-gauge). Workmanship on the install is warrantied for 1 year. Full warranty terms ship with your order packet.
Can I customize the 100×150 manufacturing facility in 3D before I order?
Yes, our free Sensei3D Designer lets you drag and drop doors, windows, and walk-ins; swap 16 roof + trim colors live; and rotate the building in 3D from every angle. No login required. The design saves directly to a quote so what you build is exactly what we price.
Will the 100×150 manufacturing facility handle heavy equipment and forklifts?
Standard 100×150 manufacturing facility ships rated for 35 psf live load on the floor (over concrete pad), and the 12-gauge frame upgrade supports trolley- and jib-crane mounts up to 1-ton capacity. Steel and Stud engineers will spec heavier rigging on request, call 1-877-275-7048.
Ready to build?
Your Manufacturing Facility quote takes one minute.
Tell us your zip and the options you want. We’ll send back a same-day, all-in price.
15,000 sq ft for industrial warehouse, hangar, or distribution facility
100′ x 150′14 GaugeLocal Certification Available
Pre-engineered 100×150 steel building delivers 15,000 sq ft of column-free space. Galvanized 14-gauge tubular frame, vertical roof, and certified wind and snow load ratings. Customize doors, windows, colors, eave height, and certifications in our free 3D builder.
Leg height adjustable up to 20'
$240,950.00
Free Delivery & Install RTO from /mo — No credit check
20,000 sq ft for industrial warehouse, hangar, or distribution facility
100′ x 200′14 GaugeLocal Certification Available
Pre-engineered 100×200 steel building delivers 20,000 sq ft of column-free space. Galvanized 14-gauge tubular frame, vertical roof, and certified wind and snow load ratings. Customize doors, windows, colors, eave height, and certifications in our free 3D builder.
100×200 Distribution Warehouse | Steel and Stud, From $299,900
100×200 Distribution Warehouse, engineered for code-compliant business use.
Our 100×200 distribution warehouse fits 100-foot widths and 200-foot lengths to give you a code-passing shell delivered in 4–6 weeks. Logistics operators spec this footprint for regional cross-dock and last-mile.
Starting from your selected configuration$299,900$341,900Save $42,000
or as low as $6248/mo · 0% APR · No credit RTO
ℹ️This is an estimate. Final pricing is locked after our sales team reviews your complete requirements (site access, ground type, county-specific certifications, optional upgrades). You’ll receive a written all-in quote within one business day of your request, no surprises, no hidden fees.
FREE delivery & installation in all 48 states. Concrete, asphalt, or compacted gravel.
SKU:SS-100X200-DISTRIBUTION-WARBuilt:1,847+Since: 2002Made in: 🇺🇸 USA
🛡️
A+
BBB Accredited
★
4.8/5
customer rating
⏱
Since 2004
In Business
🏠
15,000+
Buildings
🇺🇸
48
States Served
We’ve provided builds for
SPATIAL LAYOUT
See how 800 sq ft fits your distribution facility.
100 feet wide × 200 feet long. Column-free clear span; 18-ft+ height for 5-tier racking. Our 100×200 distribution warehouse fits 100-foot widths and 200-foot lengths to give you a code-passing shell delivered in 4–6 weeks.
Multi-dock loading bays at the front, high-bay racking aisles in the middle, office mezzanine + break + restrooms at the rear. Capacity: ~400 pallet positions, full forklift ops. Logistics operators spec this footprint for regional cross-dock and last-mile distribution.
💡 Pro tip:Dock-Ready Layout. Size affords: multiple dock doors, mezzanine office, in-rack sprinklers.
🎨 FREE 3D BUILDER
Build your 100×200 Distribution Warehouse in 3D.
Design your building yourself in our free Sensei3D Designer, drag doors and windows where you want them, swap roof + trim colors, and see your spec from every angle. Save your design and email it to yourself for later.
Drag-and-drop doors, windows, walk-ins anywhere on the building
16 colors applied live to roof, walls, and trim, mix & match
Interior + exterior views of your spec, with measurements
Save your design and share it with your contractor or family
Auto-syncs to quote, what you build is what we price
All variants ship with free delivery, installation, drawings, 20-year warranty.
🏗️
20,000 sq ft enclosed
Fully-enclosed 100×200 vertical-roof structure.
🚪
Roll-up + walk-in doors
Standard configuration door package.
🔩
14-gauge steel frame
American-rolled galvanized tubing.
🎨
1 standard color
Pick from 16 factory-baked finishes.
TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS
Distribution Warehouse spec sheet.
Width100′
Length200′ + 6" overhang
Side height9′ standard
Floor space20,000 sq ft
Doors1 × 9×8 roll-up
Walk-inOptional (+$345)
WindowsOptional
Windup to 180 mph
Snowup to 65 psf
RoofVertical 3:12
Frame14 ga (12 ga upgrade)
Sheeting29 ga (26 ga upgrade)
AnchoringConcrete · Asphalt · Ground
Lead time3 – 5 weeks
USE CASE EXAMPLES
How real buyers use Distribution Warehouse.
DAILY USE
Everyday distribution warehouse
20,000 sq ft is the right size for daily use of a distribution warehouse.
STORAGE OVERFLOW
distribution warehouse + seasonal storage
Park or store equipment in the front half, leave the rear for seasonal storage and overflow.
FLEX ROOM
Expansion-ready
Stud-framed interior makes it easy to add a partition, electrical, or insulation later.
FULL PRODUCT DETAILS
100×200 Distribution Warehouse, what makes it different.
20,000sq ft
Floor Space
180mph
Wind Rated
65psf
Snow Load
20yr
Rust Warranty
40yr
Paint Warranty
$6248/mo
From RTO
🏗️
Engineered for your county
Every 100×200 distribution warehouse is fabricated from American-rolled galvanized steel and engineered against the exact wind and snow loads your jurisdiction requires.
Standard: 140 mph wind / 35 psf snow
12-ga upgrade: 180 mph / 65 psf
Permit drawings stamped and emailed free
🔩
Construction details
The same materials commercial fabricators use, not residential-grade. Hot-dip galvanized fasteners, factory-baked siliconized polyester paint, Hilti-grade anchors.
Frame: 14-ga (12-ga upgrade) galvanized tubing
Panels: 29-ga G-90 (26-ga upgrade)
Fasteners: #14 self-drilling with EPDM washer
🚚
Free delivery & install, really free
Regional-route delivery plus 1–2 day on-site installation by a certified crew, bundled into your headline price. No hidden unloading fees, fuel surcharges, or site-prep charges.
$0 deposit · pay only after walkthrough sign-off
3–5 week lead time on regional routes
All 48 states · rush option available
🛡️
Warranty & lifespan
Engineered for a 50-year service life with industry-leading warranties on every wear surface.
20-yr rust-through warranty on frame & panels
40-yr paint warranty against fading + chalking
1-yr craftsmanship on installation
💳
$0-down financing
Three financing paths to fit any credit situation. The rent-to-own option requires no credit pull at all, fastest path to a closed deal.
RTO: $6248/mo, no credit check, 36–60 mo
Financing: 0% promo APR · 84 mo term
Cash discount: 4% on $10K+ orders
⚡
Why 100×200?
20,000 sq ft sits in the sweet spot for residential and light-commercial, fits standard quarter-acre setbacks, comfortably below the 1,000 sq ft municipal threshold that triggers extra inspections.
100′ × 200′ footprint with 20,000 sq ft interior
Permit-friendly in 96% of US counties
Resale ROI $160,000–$240,000 added home value
PEOPLE ALSO ASK
Common questions from Distribution Warehouse shoppers.
The questions our team hears every week. Click any to expand the short answer.
How thick is the steel on a Steel and Stud 100×200 metal building?
Standard frame: 14-gauge (1.5 mm) galvanized tubing. Optional 12-gauge upgrade (2.5 mm) for high-wind/snow zones. Roof and wall sheeting ships 29-gauge standard, 26-gauge upgrade available on order.
Does Steel and Stud deliver and install in my state?
Yes, free delivery and free installation in all 48 continental states, performed by certified Steel and Stud crews. Hawaii and Alaska use custom freight quotes; call 1-877-275-7048 for either.
What’s the typical lead time for a 100×200 building?
Standard: 3–5 weeks from order confirmation to install completion. Fabrication runs the first 2–3 weeks at our US plant; regional delivery and 1-2 day install close it out. Rush builds available for $345.
Can I finance a Steel and Stud building without a credit check?
Yes, Steel and Stud’s rent-to-own partner does not pull credit. Approvals typically run 8 minutes with proof of income and first month’s payment. 36–60 month terms, no early-payoff penalty.
What’s covered under the 20-year warranty?
Steel and Stud’s 20-year rust-through warranty covers the galvanized frame against perforation, plus a 20-year paint-finish warranty against fade and chalk. Workmanship on the install is warrantied for 1 year. Warranty transfers to the next owner on resale.
CUSTOMER REVIEWS
What real 100×200 Distribution Warehouse buyers say.
⭐
No reviews yet for the 100×200 Distribution Warehouse
Be the first verified buyer to share your experience. Honest reviews help other steel-building shoppers make a confident decision.
How much does a 100×200 distribution warehouse cost?
A 100×200 distribution warehouse from Steel and Stud starts at $299,900 with free delivery and free installation across all 48 states. Most buyers pick the rent-to-own option at about $6248/month with $0 down and no credit check. Call 1-877-275-7048 for a same-day price lock.
Is delivery and installation included in the 100×200 distribution warehouse price?
Yes, every Steel and Stud distribution warehouse ships with free delivery + free installation by a certified crew, included in the listed price. Anchored to a concrete pad, asphalt, or compacted gravel, your building is fully erected in 1–2 days after the truck arrives.
Do I need a permit for a 100×200 distribution warehouse?
Almost always for 20,000+ sq ft enclosed buildings. Steel and Stud emails engineered drawings stamped for your wind zone (up to 180 mph) and snow zone (up to 65 psf) at no charge, so your local building department has everything it needs. Permit timing typically runs 2–6 weeks by jurisdiction.
How is a Steel and Stud distribution warehouse different from a wood-frame build?
Steel solves the problems wood creates, no rotting, no termites, no warping, no painting every 3 years. Our 14-gauge galvanized frame carries a 20-year rust warranty and ships with a 180 mph wind / 65 psf snow rating already engineered in. A comparable wood build typically costs 2–3× more and needs ongoing maintenance.
What foundation does a 100×200 distribution warehouse need?
A 4-inch concrete pad poured 1 foot wider and longer than the building is the standard. Steel and Stud also anchors to asphalt or compacted gravel for open or semi-enclosed configurations. A pad-pour bundle is offered at checkout if you don’t already have a slab.
How fast can I get a 100×200 distribution warehouse delivered?
Standard lead time is 3–5 weeks from order to install. Fabrication runs the first 2–3 weeks at our US plant; regional delivery + 1–2-day install by a certified Steel and Stud crew closes out the order. Rush builds are available, call 1-877-275-7048 for current capacity.
Can I finance a 100×200 distribution warehouse without a credit check?
Yes, Steel and Stud’s rent-to-own partner does not pull credit. Approvals close in about 8 minutes with proof of income and your first month’s payment. Terms run 36–60 months with no early-payoff penalty, and the monthly works out to roughly $6248/month on a 100×200 distribution warehouse.
What warranty comes with the 100×200 distribution warehouse?
Steel and Stud backs every building with a 20-year rust-through warranty on the galvanized frame and a 10-year sheeting warranty on the 29-gauge panels (upgradeable to 26-gauge or 12-gauge). Workmanship on the install is warrantied for 1 year. Full warranty terms ship with your order packet.
Can I customize the 100×200 distribution warehouse in 3D before I order?
Yes, our free Sensei3D Designer lets you drag and drop doors, windows, and walk-ins; swap 16 roof + trim colors live; and rotate the building in 3D from every angle. No login required. The design saves directly to a quote so what you build is exactly what we price.
Does the 100×200 distribution warehouse meet IBC commercial code?
Yes. Steel and Stud’s 12-gauge frame upgrade and 26-gauge sheeting both meet IBC commercial standards, and most counties accept our stamped drawings without revision. Engineered loads ship with the order, typical certified specs are 180 mph wind / 65 psf snow.
Ready to build?
Your Distribution Warehouse quote takes one minute.
Tell us your zip and the options you want. We’ll send back a same-day, all-in price.
20,000 sq ft for industrial warehouse, hangar, or distribution facility
100′ x 200′14 GaugeLocal Certification Available
Pre-engineered 100×200 steel building delivers 20,000 sq ft of column-free space. Galvanized 14-gauge tubular frame, vertical roof, and certified wind and snow load ratings. Customize doors, windows, colors, eave height, and certifications in our free 3D builder.
Leg height adjustable up to 20'
$299,900.00
Free Delivery & Install RTO from /mo — No credit check
20,000 sq ft for industrial warehouse, hangar, or distribution facility
100′ x 200′14 GaugeLocal Certification Available
Pre-engineered 100×200 steel building delivers 20,000 sq ft of column-free space. Galvanized 14-gauge tubular frame, vertical roof, and certified wind and snow load ratings. Customize doors, windows, colors, eave height, and certifications in our free 3D builder.
100×200 Manufacturing Facility | Steel and Stud, From $300,300
100×200 Manufacturing Facility, rated for heavy-duty industrial loads.
100×200 delivers 20000 sq ft of heavy-duty manufacturing facility space. Manufacturers running CNC, metal fab, or assembly lines pick 100×200 to floor a full production cell with QC, packout, and shipping under one.
Starting from your selected configuration$300,300$342,350Save $42,050
or as low as $6256/mo · 0% APR · No credit RTO
ℹ️This is an estimate. Final pricing is locked after our sales team reviews your complete requirements (site access, ground type, county-specific certifications, optional upgrades). You’ll receive a written all-in quote within one business day of your request, no surprises, no hidden fees.
FREE delivery & installation in all 48 states. Concrete, asphalt, or compacted gravel.
SKU:SS-100X200-MANUFACTURING-FABuilt:1,847+Since: 2002Made in: 🇺🇸 USA
🛡️
A+
BBB Accredited
★
4.8/5
customer rating
⏱
Since 2004
In Business
🏠
15,000+
Buildings
🇺🇸
48
States Served
We’ve provided builds for
SPATIAL LAYOUT
See how 800 sq ft fits your fabrication-shop layout.
100 feet wide × 200 feet long. 100×200 delivers 20000 sq ft of heavy-duty manufacturing facility space.
Weld / fab bay · Material storage · Office / break
Weld / fab bay at the front, material storage in the middle, office / break at the rear. Manufacturers running CNC, metal fab, or assembly lines pick 100×200 to floor a full production cell with QC, packout, and shipping under one roof.
💡 Pro tip:Clear Span 100′.
🎨 FREE 3D BUILDER
Build your 100×200 Manufacturing Facility in 3D.
Design your building yourself in our free Sensei3D Designer, drag doors and windows where you want them, swap roof + trim colors, and see your spec from every angle. Save your design and email it to yourself for later.
Drag-and-drop doors, windows, walk-ins anywhere on the building
16 colors applied live to roof, walls, and trim, mix & match
Interior + exterior views of your spec, with measurements
Save your design and share it with your contractor or family
Auto-syncs to quote, what you build is what we price
All variants ship with free delivery, installation, drawings, 20-year warranty.
🏗️
20,000 sq ft enclosed
Fully-enclosed 100×200 vertical-roof structure.
🚪
Roll-up + walk-in doors
Standard configuration door package.
🔩
14-gauge steel frame
American-rolled galvanized tubing.
🎨
1 standard color
Pick from 16 factory-baked finishes.
TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS
Manufacturing Facility spec sheet.
Width100′
Length200′ + 6" overhang
Side height9′ standard
Floor space20,000 sq ft
Doors1 × 9×8 roll-up
Walk-inOptional (+$345)
WindowsOptional
Windup to 180 mph
Snowup to 65 psf
RoofVertical 3:12
Frame14 ga (12 ga upgrade)
Sheeting29 ga (26 ga upgrade)
AnchoringConcrete · Asphalt · Ground
Lead time3 – 5 weeks
USE CASE EXAMPLES
How real buyers use Manufacturing Facility.
DAILY USE
Everyday manufacturing facility
20,000 sq ft is the right size for daily use of a manufacturing facility.
STORAGE OVERFLOW
manufacturing facility + seasonal storage
Park or store equipment in the front half, leave the rear for seasonal storage and overflow.
FLEX ROOM
Expansion-ready
Stud-framed interior makes it easy to add a partition, electrical, or insulation later.
FULL PRODUCT DETAILS
100×200 Manufacturing Facility, what makes it different.
20,000sq ft
Floor Space
180mph
Wind Rated
65psf
Snow Load
20yr
Rust Warranty
40yr
Paint Warranty
$6256/mo
From RTO
🏗️
Engineered for your county
Every 100×200 manufacturing facility is fabricated from American-rolled galvanized steel and engineered against the exact wind and snow loads your jurisdiction requires.
Standard: 140 mph wind / 35 psf snow
12-ga upgrade: 180 mph / 65 psf
Permit drawings stamped and emailed free
🔩
Construction details
The same materials commercial fabricators use, not residential-grade. Hot-dip galvanized fasteners, factory-baked siliconized polyester paint, Hilti-grade anchors.
Frame: 14-ga (12-ga upgrade) galvanized tubing
Panels: 29-ga G-90 (26-ga upgrade)
Fasteners: #14 self-drilling with EPDM washer
🚚
Free delivery & install, really free
Regional-route delivery plus 1–2 day on-site installation by a certified crew, bundled into your headline price. No hidden unloading fees, fuel surcharges, or site-prep charges.
$0 deposit · pay only after walkthrough sign-off
3–5 week lead time on regional routes
All 48 states · rush option available
🛡️
Warranty & lifespan
Engineered for a 50-year service life with industry-leading warranties on every wear surface.
20-yr rust-through warranty on frame & panels
40-yr paint warranty against fading + chalking
1-yr craftsmanship on installation
💳
$0-down financing
Three financing paths to fit any credit situation. The rent-to-own option requires no credit pull at all, fastest path to a closed deal.
RTO: $6256/mo, no credit check, 36–60 mo
Financing: 0% promo APR · 84 mo term
Cash discount: 4% on $10K+ orders
⚡
Why 100×200?
20,000 sq ft sits in the sweet spot for residential and light-commercial, fits standard quarter-acre setbacks, comfortably below the 1,000 sq ft municipal threshold that triggers extra inspections.
100′ × 200′ footprint with 20,000 sq ft interior
Permit-friendly in 96% of US counties
Resale ROI $160,000–$240,000 added home value
PEOPLE ALSO ASK
Common questions from Manufacturing Facility shoppers.
The questions our team hears every week. Click any to expand the short answer.
How thick is the steel on a Steel and Stud 100×200 metal building?
Standard frame: 14-gauge (1.5 mm) galvanized tubing. Optional 12-gauge upgrade (2.5 mm) for high-wind/snow zones. Roof and wall sheeting ships 29-gauge standard, 26-gauge upgrade available on order.
Does Steel and Stud deliver and install in my state?
Yes, free delivery and free installation in all 48 continental states, performed by certified Steel and Stud crews. Hawaii and Alaska use custom freight quotes; call 1-877-275-7048 for either.
What’s the typical lead time for a 100×200 building?
Standard: 3–5 weeks from order confirmation to install completion. Fabrication runs the first 2–3 weeks at our US plant; regional delivery and 1-2 day install close it out. Rush builds available for $345.
Can I finance a Steel and Stud building without a credit check?
Yes, Steel and Stud’s rent-to-own partner does not pull credit. Approvals typically run 8 minutes with proof of income and first month’s payment. 36–60 month terms, no early-payoff penalty.
What’s covered under the 20-year warranty?
Steel and Stud’s 20-year rust-through warranty covers the galvanized frame against perforation, plus a 20-year paint-finish warranty against fade and chalk. Workmanship on the install is warrantied for 1 year. Warranty transfers to the next owner on resale.
CUSTOMER REVIEWS
What real 100×200 Manufacturing Facility buyers say.
⭐
No reviews yet for the 100×200 Manufacturing Facility
Be the first verified buyer to share your experience. Honest reviews help other steel-building shoppers make a confident decision.
How much does a 100×200 manufacturing facility cost?
A 100×200 manufacturing facility from Steel and Stud starts at $300,300 with free delivery and free installation across all 48 states. Most buyers pick the rent-to-own option at about $6256/month with $0 down and no credit check. Call 1-877-275-7048 for a same-day price lock.
Is delivery and installation included in the 100×200 manufacturing facility price?
Yes, every Steel and Stud manufacturing facility ships with free delivery + free installation by a certified crew, included in the listed price. Anchored to a concrete pad, asphalt, or compacted gravel, your building is fully erected in 1–2 days after the truck arrives.
Do I need a permit for a 100×200 manufacturing facility?
Almost always for 20,000+ sq ft enclosed buildings. Steel and Stud emails engineered drawings stamped for your wind zone (up to 180 mph) and snow zone (up to 65 psf) at no charge, so your local building department has everything it needs. Permit timing typically runs 2–6 weeks by jurisdiction.
How is a Steel and Stud manufacturing facility different from a wood-frame build?
Steel solves the problems wood creates, no rotting, no termites, no warping, no painting every 3 years. Our 14-gauge galvanized frame carries a 20-year rust warranty and ships with a 180 mph wind / 65 psf snow rating already engineered in. A comparable wood build typically costs 2–3× more and needs ongoing maintenance.
What foundation does a 100×200 manufacturing facility need?
A 4-inch concrete pad poured 1 foot wider and longer than the building is the standard. Steel and Stud also anchors to asphalt or compacted gravel for open or semi-enclosed configurations. A pad-pour bundle is offered at checkout if you don’t already have a slab.
How fast can I get a 100×200 manufacturing facility delivered?
Standard lead time is 3–5 weeks from order to install. Fabrication runs the first 2–3 weeks at our US plant; regional delivery + 1–2-day install by a certified Steel and Stud crew closes out the order. Rush builds are available, call 1-877-275-7048 for current capacity.
Can I finance a 100×200 manufacturing facility without a credit check?
Yes, Steel and Stud’s rent-to-own partner does not pull credit. Approvals close in about 8 minutes with proof of income and your first month’s payment. Terms run 36–60 months with no early-payoff penalty, and the monthly works out to roughly $6256/month on a 100×200 manufacturing facility.
What warranty comes with the 100×200 manufacturing facility?
Steel and Stud backs every building with a 20-year rust-through warranty on the galvanized frame and a 10-year sheeting warranty on the 29-gauge panels (upgradeable to 26-gauge or 12-gauge). Workmanship on the install is warrantied for 1 year. Full warranty terms ship with your order packet.
Can I customize the 100×200 manufacturing facility in 3D before I order?
Yes, our free Sensei3D Designer lets you drag and drop doors, windows, and walk-ins; swap 16 roof + trim colors live; and rotate the building in 3D from every angle. No login required. The design saves directly to a quote so what you build is exactly what we price.
Will the 100×200 manufacturing facility handle heavy equipment and forklifts?
Standard 100×200 manufacturing facility ships rated for 35 psf live load on the floor (over concrete pad), and the 12-gauge frame upgrade supports trolley- and jib-crane mounts up to 1-ton capacity. Steel and Stud engineers will spec heavier rigging on request, call 1-877-275-7048.
Ready to build?
Your Manufacturing Facility quote takes one minute.
Tell us your zip and the options you want. We’ll send back a same-day, all-in price.
20,000 sq ft for industrial warehouse, hangar, or distribution facility
100′ x 200′14 GaugeLocal Certification Available
Pre-engineered 100×200 steel building delivers 20,000 sq ft of column-free space. Galvanized 14-gauge tubular frame, vertical roof, and certified wind and snow load ratings. Customize doors, windows, colors, eave height, and certifications in our free 3D builder.
Leg height adjustable up to 20'
$300,300.00
Free Delivery & Install RTO from /mo — No credit check
20,000 sq ft for industrial warehouse, hangar, or distribution facility
100′ x 200′14 GaugeLocal Certification Available
Pre-engineered 100×200 steel building delivers 20,000 sq ft of column-free space. Galvanized 14-gauge tubular frame, vertical roof, and certified wind and snow load ratings. Customize doors, windows, colors, eave height, and certifications in our free 3D builder.
100×200 Commercial Workshop | Steel and Stud, From $299,900
100×200 Commercial Workshop, engineered for code-compliant business use.
100×200 delivers 20000 sq ft of code-compliant commercial workshop space. Multi-tenant commercial real estate developers split this footprint into four 100×200 bays, each with its own roll-up and walk-in door. It’s a.
Starting from your selected configuration$299,900$341,900Save $42,000
or as low as $6248/mo · 0% APR · No credit RTO
ℹ️This is an estimate. Final pricing is locked after our sales team reviews your complete requirements (site access, ground type, county-specific certifications, optional upgrades). You’ll receive a written all-in quote within one business day of your request, no surprises, no hidden fees.
Wood + metal benches · CNC / table-saw center · Finishing room + Material storage
Wood + metal benches at the front, cnc / table-saw center in the middle, finishing room + material storage at the rear. Capacity: multi-craft shop / small business. Multi-tenant commercial real estate developers split this footprint into four 100×200 bays, each with its own roll-up and walk-in door.
Design your building yourself in our free Sensei3D Designer, drag doors and windows where you want them, swap roof + trim colors, and see your spec from every angle. Save your design and email it to yourself for later.
Drag-and-drop doors, windows, walk-ins anywhere on the building
16 colors applied live to roof, walls, and trim, mix & match
Interior + exterior views of your spec, with measurements
Save your design and share it with your contractor or family
Auto-syncs to quote, what you build is what we price
All variants ship with free delivery, installation, drawings, 20-year warranty.
🏗️
20,000 sq ft enclosed
Fully-enclosed 100×200 vertical-roof structure.
🚪
Roll-up + walk-in doors
Standard configuration door package.
🔩
14-gauge steel frame
American-rolled galvanized tubing.
🎨
1 standard color
Pick from 16 factory-baked finishes.
TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS
Commercial Workshop spec sheet.
Width100′
Length200′ + 6" overhang
Side height9′ standard
Floor space20,000 sq ft
Doors1 × 9×8 roll-up
Walk-inOptional (+$345)
WindowsOptional
Windup to 180 mph
Snowup to 65 psf
RoofVertical 3:12
Frame14 ga (12 ga upgrade)
Sheeting29 ga (26 ga upgrade)
AnchoringConcrete · Asphalt · Ground
Lead time3 – 5 weeks
USE CASE EXAMPLES
How real buyers use Commercial Workshop.
DAILY USE
Everyday commercial workshop
20,000 sq ft is the right size for daily use of a commercial workshop.
STORAGE OVERFLOW
commercial workshop + seasonal storage
Park or store equipment in the front half, leave the rear for seasonal storage and overflow.
FLEX ROOM
Expansion-ready
Stud-framed interior makes it easy to add a partition, electrical, or insulation later.
FULL PRODUCT DETAILS
100×200 Commercial Workshop, what makes it different.
20,000sq ft
Floor Space
180mph
Wind Rated
65psf
Snow Load
20yr
Rust Warranty
40yr
Paint Warranty
$6248/mo
From RTO
🏗️
Engineered for your county
Every 100×200 commercial workshop is fabricated from American-rolled galvanized steel and engineered against the exact wind and snow loads your jurisdiction requires.
Standard: 140 mph wind / 35 psf snow
12-ga upgrade: 180 mph / 65 psf
Permit drawings stamped and emailed free
🔩
Construction details
The same materials commercial fabricators use, not residential-grade. Hot-dip galvanized fasteners, factory-baked siliconized polyester paint, Hilti-grade anchors.
Frame: 14-ga (12-ga upgrade) galvanized tubing
Panels: 29-ga G-90 (26-ga upgrade)
Fasteners: #14 self-drilling with EPDM washer
🚚
Free delivery & install, really free
Regional-route delivery plus 1–2 day on-site installation by a certified crew, bundled into your headline price. No hidden unloading fees, fuel surcharges, or site-prep charges.
$0 deposit · pay only after walkthrough sign-off
3–5 week lead time on regional routes
All 48 states · rush option available
🛡️
Warranty & lifespan
Engineered for a 50-year service life with industry-leading warranties on every wear surface.
20-yr rust-through warranty on frame & panels
40-yr paint warranty against fading + chalking
1-yr craftsmanship on installation
💳
$0-down financing
Three financing paths to fit any credit situation. The rent-to-own option requires no credit pull at all, fastest path to a closed deal.
RTO: $6248/mo, no credit check, 36–60 mo
Financing: 0% promo APR · 84 mo term
Cash discount: 4% on $10K+ orders
⚡
Why 100×200?
20,000 sq ft sits in the sweet spot for residential and light-commercial, fits standard quarter-acre setbacks, comfortably below the 1,000 sq ft municipal threshold that triggers extra inspections.
100′ × 200′ footprint with 20,000 sq ft interior
Permit-friendly in 96% of US counties
Resale ROI $160,000–$240,000 added home value
PEOPLE ALSO ASK
Common questions from Commercial Workshop shoppers.
The questions our team hears every week. Click any to expand the short answer.
How thick is the steel on a Steel and Stud 100×200 metal building?
Standard frame: 14-gauge (1.5 mm) galvanized tubing. Optional 12-gauge upgrade (2.5 mm) for high-wind/snow zones. Roof and wall sheeting ships 29-gauge standard, 26-gauge upgrade available on order.
Does Steel and Stud deliver and install in my state?
Yes, free delivery and free installation in all 48 continental states, performed by certified Steel and Stud crews. Hawaii and Alaska use custom freight quotes; call 1-877-275-7048 for either.
What’s the typical lead time for a 100×200 building?
Standard: 3–5 weeks from order confirmation to install completion. Fabrication runs the first 2–3 weeks at our US plant; regional delivery and 1-2 day install close it out. Rush builds available for $345.
Can I finance a Steel and Stud building without a credit check?
Yes, Steel and Stud’s rent-to-own partner does not pull credit. Approvals typically run 8 minutes with proof of income and first month’s payment. 36–60 month terms, no early-payoff penalty.
What’s covered under the 20-year warranty?
Steel and Stud’s 20-year rust-through warranty covers the galvanized frame against perforation, plus a 20-year paint-finish warranty against fade and chalk. Workmanship on the install is warrantied for 1 year. Warranty transfers to the next owner on resale.
CUSTOMER REVIEWS
What real 100×200 Commercial Workshop buyers say.
⭐
No reviews yet for the 100×200 Commercial Workshop
Be the first verified buyer to share your experience. Honest reviews help other steel-building shoppers make a confident decision.
A 100×200 commercial workshop from Steel and Stud starts at $299,900 with free delivery and free installation across all 48 states. Most buyers pick the rent-to-own option at about $6248/month with $0 down and no credit check. Call 1-877-275-7048 for a same-day price lock.
Is delivery and installation included in the 100×200 commercial workshop price?
Yes, every Steel and Stud commercial workshop ships with free delivery + free installation by a certified crew, included in the listed price. Anchored to a concrete pad, asphalt, or compacted gravel, your building is fully erected in 1–2 days after the truck arrives.
Do I need a permit for a 100×200 commercial workshop?
Almost always for 20,000+ sq ft enclosed buildings. Steel and Stud emails engineered drawings stamped for your wind zone (up to 180 mph) and snow zone (up to 65 psf) at no charge, so your local building department has everything it needs. Permit timing typically runs 2–6 weeks by jurisdiction.
How is a Steel and Stud commercial workshop different from a wood-frame build?
Steel solves the problems wood creates, no rotting, no termites, no warping, no painting every 3 years. Our 14-gauge galvanized frame carries a 20-year rust warranty and ships with a 180 mph wind / 65 psf snow rating already engineered in. A comparable wood build typically costs 2–3× more and needs ongoing maintenance.
What foundation does a 100×200 commercial workshop need?
A 4-inch concrete pad poured 1 foot wider and longer than the building is the standard. Steel and Stud also anchors to asphalt or compacted gravel for open or semi-enclosed configurations. A pad-pour bundle is offered at checkout if you don’t already have a slab.
How fast can I get a 100×200 commercial workshop delivered?
Standard lead time is 3–5 weeks from order to install. Fabrication runs the first 2–3 weeks at our US plant; regional delivery + 1–2-day install by a certified Steel and Stud crew closes out the order. Rush builds are available, call 1-877-275-7048 for current capacity.
Can I finance a 100×200 commercial workshop without a credit check?
Yes, Steel and Stud’s rent-to-own partner does not pull credit. Approvals close in about 8 minutes with proof of income and your first month’s payment. Terms run 36–60 months with no early-payoff penalty, and the monthly works out to roughly $6248/month on a 100×200 commercial workshop.
What warranty comes with the 100×200 commercial workshop?
Steel and Stud backs every building with a 20-year rust-through warranty on the galvanized frame and a 10-year sheeting warranty on the 29-gauge panels (upgradeable to 26-gauge or 12-gauge). Workmanship on the install is warrantied for 1 year. Full warranty terms ship with your order packet.
Can I customize the 100×200 commercial workshop in 3D before I order?
Yes, our free Sensei3D Designer lets you drag and drop doors, windows, and walk-ins; swap 16 roof + trim colors live; and rotate the building in 3D from every angle. No login required. The design saves directly to a quote so what you build is exactly what we price.
Does the 100×200 commercial workshop meet IBC commercial code?
Yes. Steel and Stud’s 12-gauge frame upgrade and 26-gauge sheeting both meet IBC commercial standards, and most counties accept our stamped drawings without revision. Engineered loads ship with the order, typical certified specs are 180 mph wind / 65 psf snow.
Ready to build?
Your Commercial Workshop quote takes one minute.
Tell us your zip and the options you want. We’ll send back a same-day, all-in price.
20,000 sq ft for industrial warehouse, hangar, or distribution facility
100′ x 200′14 GaugeLocal Certification Available
Pre-engineered 100×200 steel building delivers 20,000 sq ft of column-free space. Galvanized 14-gauge tubular frame, vertical roof, and certified wind and snow load ratings. Customize doors, windows, colors, eave height, and certifications in our free 3D builder.
Leg height adjustable up to 20'
$299,900.00
Free Delivery & Install RTO from /mo — No credit check
20,000 sq ft for industrial warehouse, hangar, or distribution facility
100′ x 200′14 GaugeLocal Certification Available
Pre-engineered 100×200 steel building delivers 20,000 sq ft of column-free space. Galvanized 14-gauge tubular frame, vertical roof, and certified wind and snow load ratings. Customize doors, windows, colors, eave height, and certifications in our free 3D builder.
100×200 Equipment & Hay Barn | Steel and Stud, From $298,700
100×200 Equipment & Hay Barn, built for farm and ranch demands.
Our 100×200 equipment & hay barn fits 100-foot widths and 200-foot lengths to give you durable cover that handles snow, wind, and feed loads. 100×200 delivers 12500 sq ft of rugged equipment & hay barn space.
You’re viewing:Equipment & Hay Barn·Size100×200·Slate Gray
Starting from your selected configuration$298,700$340,500Save $41,800
or as low as $6223/mo · 0% APR · No credit RTO
ℹ️This is an estimate. Final pricing is locked after our sales team reviews your complete requirements (site access, ground type, county-specific certifications, optional upgrades). You’ll receive a written all-in quote within one business day of your request, no surprises, no hidden fees.
FREE delivery & installation in all 48 states. Concrete, asphalt, or compacted gravel.
SKU:SS-100X200-EQUIPMENT-HAY-BABuilt:1,847+Since: 2002Made in: 🇺🇸 USA
🛡️
A+
BBB Accredited
★
4.8/5
customer rating
⏱
Since 2004
In Business
🏠
15,000+
Buildings
🇺🇸
48
States Served
We’ve provided builds for
SPATIAL LAYOUT
See how 800 sq ft fits your hay-barn layout.
100 feet wide × 200 feet long. Our 100×200 equipment & hay barn fits 100-foot widths and 200-foot lengths to give you durable cover that handles snow, wind, and feed loads.
Hay storage · Feed alley · Equipment
Hay storage at the front, feed alley in the middle, equipment at the rear. 100×200 delivers 12500 sq ft of rugged equipment & hay barn space.
💡 Pro tip:Drive-Through.
🎨 FREE 3D BUILDER
Build your 100×200 Equipment & Hay Barn in 3D.
Design your building yourself in our free Sensei3D Designer, drag doors and windows where you want them, swap roof + trim colors, and see your spec from every angle. Save your design and email it to yourself for later.
Drag-and-drop doors, windows, walk-ins anywhere on the building
16 colors applied live to roof, walls, and trim, mix & match
Interior + exterior views of your spec, with measurements
Save your design and share it with your contractor or family
Auto-syncs to quote, what you build is what we price
All variants ship with free delivery, installation, drawings, 20-year warranty.
🏗️
20,000 sq ft enclosed
Fully-enclosed 100×200 vertical-roof structure.
🚪
Roll-up + walk-in doors
Standard configuration door package.
🔩
14-gauge steel frame
American-rolled galvanized tubing.
🎨
1 standard color
Pick from 16 factory-baked finishes.
TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS
Equipment & Hay Barn spec sheet.
Width100′
Length200′ + 6" overhang
Side height9′ standard
Floor space20,000 sq ft
Doors1 × 9×8 roll-up
Walk-inOptional (+$345)
WindowsOptional
Windup to 180 mph
Snowup to 65 psf
RoofVertical 3:12
Frame14 ga (12 ga upgrade)
Sheeting29 ga (26 ga upgrade)
AnchoringConcrete · Asphalt · Ground
Lead time3 – 5 weeks
USE CASE EXAMPLES
How real buyers use Equipment & Hay Barn.
DAILY USE
Everyday equipment & hay barn
20,000 sq ft is the right size for daily use of a equipment & hay barn.
STORAGE OVERFLOW
equipment & hay barn + seasonal storage
Park or store equipment in the front half, leave the rear for seasonal storage and overflow.
FLEX ROOM
Expansion-ready
Stud-framed interior makes it easy to add a partition, electrical, or insulation later.
FULL PRODUCT DETAILS
100×200 Equipment & Hay Barn, what makes it different.
20,000sq ft
Floor Space
180mph
Wind Rated
65psf
Snow Load
20yr
Rust Warranty
40yr
Paint Warranty
$6223/mo
From RTO
🏗️
Engineered for your county
Every 100×200 equipment & hay barn is fabricated from American-rolled galvanized steel and engineered against the exact wind and snow loads your jurisdiction requires.
Standard: 140 mph wind / 35 psf snow
12-ga upgrade: 180 mph / 65 psf
Permit drawings stamped and emailed free
🔩
Construction details
The same materials commercial fabricators use, not residential-grade. Hot-dip galvanized fasteners, factory-baked siliconized polyester paint, Hilti-grade anchors.
Frame: 14-ga (12-ga upgrade) galvanized tubing
Panels: 29-ga G-90 (26-ga upgrade)
Fasteners: #14 self-drilling with EPDM washer
🚚
Free delivery & install, really free
Regional-route delivery plus 1–2 day on-site installation by a certified crew, bundled into your headline price. No hidden unloading fees, fuel surcharges, or site-prep charges.
$0 deposit · pay only after walkthrough sign-off
3–5 week lead time on regional routes
All 48 states · rush option available
🛡️
Warranty & lifespan
Engineered for a 50-year service life with industry-leading warranties on every wear surface.
20-yr rust-through warranty on frame & panels
40-yr paint warranty against fading + chalking
1-yr craftsmanship on installation
💳
$0-down financing
Three financing paths to fit any credit situation. The rent-to-own option requires no credit pull at all, fastest path to a closed deal.
RTO: $6223/mo, no credit check, 36–60 mo
Financing: 0% promo APR · 84 mo term
Cash discount: 4% on $10K+ orders
⚡
Why 100×200?
20,000 sq ft sits in the sweet spot for residential and light-commercial, fits standard quarter-acre setbacks, comfortably below the 1,000 sq ft municipal threshold that triggers extra inspections.
100′ × 200′ footprint with 20,000 sq ft interior
Permit-friendly in 96% of US counties
Resale ROI $160,000–$240,000 added home value
PEOPLE ALSO ASK
Common questions from Equipment & Hay Barn shoppers.
The questions our team hears every week. Click any to expand the short answer.
How thick is the steel on a Steel and Stud 100×200 metal building?
Standard frame: 14-gauge (1.5 mm) galvanized tubing. Optional 12-gauge upgrade (2.5 mm) for high-wind/snow zones. Roof and wall sheeting ships 29-gauge standard, 26-gauge upgrade available on order.
Does Steel and Stud deliver and install in my state?
Yes, free delivery and free installation in all 48 continental states, performed by certified Steel and Stud crews. Hawaii and Alaska use custom freight quotes; call 1-877-275-7048 for either.
What’s the typical lead time for a 100×200 building?
Standard: 3–5 weeks from order confirmation to install completion. Fabrication runs the first 2–3 weeks at our US plant; regional delivery and 1-2 day install close it out. Rush builds available for $345.
Can I finance a Steel and Stud building without a credit check?
Yes, Steel and Stud’s rent-to-own partner does not pull credit. Approvals typically run 8 minutes with proof of income and first month’s payment. 36–60 month terms, no early-payoff penalty.
What’s covered under the 20-year warranty?
Steel and Stud’s 20-year rust-through warranty covers the galvanized frame against perforation, plus a 20-year paint-finish warranty against fade and chalk. Workmanship on the install is warrantied for 1 year. Warranty transfers to the next owner on resale.
CUSTOMER REVIEWS
What real 100×200 Equipment & Hay Barn buyers say.
⭐
No reviews yet for the 100×200 Equipment & Hay Barn
Be the first verified buyer to share your experience. Honest reviews help other steel-building shoppers make a confident decision.
How much does a 100×200 equipment & hay barn cost?
A 100×200 equipment & hay barn from Steel and Stud starts at $298,700 with free delivery and free installation across all 48 states. Most buyers pick the rent-to-own option at about $6223/month with $0 down and no credit check. Call 1-877-275-7048 for a same-day price lock.
Is delivery and installation included in the 100×200 equipment & hay barn price?
Yes, every Steel and Stud equipment & hay barn ships with free delivery + free installation by a certified crew, included in the listed price. Anchored to a concrete pad, asphalt, or compacted gravel, your building is fully erected in 1–2 days after the truck arrives.
Do I need a permit for a 100×200 equipment & hay barn?
Almost always for 20,000+ sq ft enclosed buildings. Steel and Stud emails engineered drawings stamped for your wind zone (up to 180 mph) and snow zone (up to 65 psf) at no charge, so your local building department has everything it needs. Permit timing typically runs 2–6 weeks by jurisdiction.
How is a Steel and Stud equipment & hay barn different from a wood-frame build?
Steel solves the problems wood creates, no rotting, no termites, no warping, no painting every 3 years. Our 14-gauge galvanized frame carries a 20-year rust warranty and ships with a 180 mph wind / 65 psf snow rating already engineered in. A comparable wood build typically costs 2–3× more and needs ongoing maintenance.
What foundation does a 100×200 equipment & hay barn need?
A 4-inch concrete pad poured 1 foot wider and longer than the building is the standard. Steel and Stud also anchors to asphalt or compacted gravel for open or semi-enclosed configurations. A pad-pour bundle is offered at checkout if you don’t already have a slab.
How fast can I get a 100×200 equipment & hay barn delivered?
Standard lead time is 3–5 weeks from order to install. Fabrication runs the first 2–3 weeks at our US plant; regional delivery + 1–2-day install by a certified Steel and Stud crew closes out the order. Rush builds are available, call 1-877-275-7048 for current capacity.
Can I finance a 100×200 equipment & hay barn without a credit check?
Yes, Steel and Stud’s rent-to-own partner does not pull credit. Approvals close in about 8 minutes with proof of income and your first month’s payment. Terms run 36–60 months with no early-payoff penalty, and the monthly works out to roughly $6223/month on a 100×200 equipment & hay barn.
What warranty comes with the 100×200 equipment & hay barn?
Steel and Stud backs every building with a 20-year rust-through warranty on the galvanized frame and a 10-year sheeting warranty on the 29-gauge panels (upgradeable to 26-gauge or 12-gauge). Workmanship on the install is warrantied for 1 year. Full warranty terms ship with your order packet.
Can I customize the 100×200 equipment & hay barn in 3D before I order?
Yes, our free Sensei3D Designer lets you drag and drop doors, windows, and walk-ins; swap 16 roof + trim colors live; and rotate the building in 3D from every angle. No login required. The design saves directly to a quote so what you build is exactly what we price.
Will the 100×200 equipment & hay barn stand up to livestock and Midwest weather?
The 14-gauge galvanized frame is the same spec Steel and Stud uses for commercial barns, rated to 65 psf snow and 180 mph wind. Ventilation packages (ridge vent + soffit) ship standard on agricultural orders to prevent moisture buildup that would warp a wood barn.
Ready to build?
Your Equipment & Hay Barn quote takes one minute.
Tell us your zip and the options you want. We’ll send back a same-day, all-in price.
20,000 sq ft for industrial warehouse, hangar, or distribution facility
100′ x 200′14 GaugeLocal Certification Available
Pre-engineered 100×200 steel building delivers 20,000 sq ft of column-free space. Galvanized 14-gauge tubular frame, vertical roof, and certified wind and snow load ratings. Customize doors, windows, colors, eave height, and certifications in our free 3D builder.
Leg height adjustable up to 20'
$298,700.00
Free Delivery & Install RTO from /mo — No credit check
20,000 sq ft for industrial warehouse, hangar, or distribution facility
100′ x 200′14 GaugeLocal Certification Available
Pre-engineered 100×200 steel building delivers 20,000 sq ft of column-free space. Galvanized 14-gauge tubular frame, vertical roof, and certified wind and snow load ratings. Customize doors, windows, colors, eave height, and certifications in our free 3D builder.
100×200 Aircraft Hangar | Steel and Stud, From $299,900
100×200 Aircraft Hangar, engineered for code-compliant business use.
100×200 delivers 20000 sq ft of code-compliant aircraft hangar space. Private operators hangar light twins, turboprops, and small jets in this footprint. The 100-foot opening accommodates a King Air or Citation.
Starting from your selected configuration$299,900$341,900Save $42,000
or as low as $6248/mo · 0% APR · No credit RTO
ℹ️This is an estimate. Final pricing is locked after our sales team reviews your complete requirements (site access, ground type, county-specific certifications, optional upgrades). You’ll receive a written all-in quote within one business day of your request, no surprises, no hidden fees.
FREE delivery & installation in all 48 states. Concrete, asphalt, or compacted gravel.
SKU:SS-100X200-AIRCRAFT-HANGARBuilt:1,847+Since: 2002Made in: 🇺🇸 USA
🛡️
A+
BBB Accredited
★
4.8/5
customer rating
⏱
Since 2004
In Business
🏠
15,000+
Buildings
🇺🇸
48
States Served
We’ve provided builds for
SPATIAL LAYOUT
See how 800 sq ft fits your multi-aircraft hangar.
100 feet wide × 200 feet long. Engineered for column-free clear span at 100ft width. 100×200 delivers 20000 sq ft of code-compliant aircraft hangar space.
Multi-aircraft floor · Maintenance / engine zone · Office + parts + pilot lounge
Multi-aircraft floor at the front, maintenance / engine zone in the middle, office + parts + pilot lounge at the rear. Capacity: 2-4 aircraft, full FBO operations. Private operators hangar light twins, turboprops, and small jets in this footprint.
💡 Pro tip:FAA-Ready Drawings. Size affords: overhead crane, office mezzanine, parts storage cage.
🎨 FREE 3D BUILDER
Build your 100×200 Aircraft Hangar in 3D.
Design your building yourself in our free Sensei3D Designer, drag doors and windows where you want them, swap roof + trim colors, and see your spec from every angle. Save your design and email it to yourself for later.
Drag-and-drop doors, windows, walk-ins anywhere on the building
16 colors applied live to roof, walls, and trim, mix & match
Interior + exterior views of your spec, with measurements
Save your design and share it with your contractor or family
Auto-syncs to quote, what you build is what we price
All variants ship with free delivery, installation, drawings, 20-year warranty.
🏗️
20,000 sq ft enclosed
Fully-enclosed 100×200 vertical-roof structure.
🚪
Roll-up + walk-in doors
Standard configuration door package.
🔩
14-gauge steel frame
American-rolled galvanized tubing.
🎨
1 standard color
Pick from 16 factory-baked finishes.
TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS
Aircraft Hangar spec sheet.
Width100′
Length200′ + 6" overhang
Side height9′ standard
Floor space20,000 sq ft
Doors1 × 9×8 roll-up
Walk-inOptional (+$345)
WindowsOptional
Windup to 180 mph
Snowup to 65 psf
RoofVertical 3:12
Frame14 ga (12 ga upgrade)
Sheeting29 ga (26 ga upgrade)
AnchoringConcrete · Asphalt · Ground
Lead time3 – 5 weeks
USE CASE EXAMPLES
How real buyers use Aircraft Hangar.
DAILY USE
Everyday aircraft hangar
20,000 sq ft is the right size for daily use of a aircraft hangar.
STORAGE OVERFLOW
aircraft hangar + seasonal storage
Park or store equipment in the front half, leave the rear for seasonal storage and overflow.
FLEX ROOM
Expansion-ready
Stud-framed interior makes it easy to add a partition, electrical, or insulation later.
FULL PRODUCT DETAILS
100×200 Aircraft Hangar, what makes it different.
20,000sq ft
Floor Space
180mph
Wind Rated
65psf
Snow Load
20yr
Rust Warranty
40yr
Paint Warranty
$6248/mo
From RTO
🏗️
Engineered for your county
Every 100×200 aircraft hangar is fabricated from American-rolled galvanized steel and engineered against the exact wind and snow loads your jurisdiction requires.
Standard: 140 mph wind / 35 psf snow
12-ga upgrade: 180 mph / 65 psf
Permit drawings stamped and emailed free
🔩
Construction details
The same materials commercial fabricators use, not residential-grade. Hot-dip galvanized fasteners, factory-baked siliconized polyester paint, Hilti-grade anchors.
Frame: 14-ga (12-ga upgrade) galvanized tubing
Panels: 29-ga G-90 (26-ga upgrade)
Fasteners: #14 self-drilling with EPDM washer
🚚
Free delivery & install, really free
Regional-route delivery plus 1–2 day on-site installation by a certified crew, bundled into your headline price. No hidden unloading fees, fuel surcharges, or site-prep charges.
$0 deposit · pay only after walkthrough sign-off
3–5 week lead time on regional routes
All 48 states · rush option available
🛡️
Warranty & lifespan
Engineered for a 50-year service life with industry-leading warranties on every wear surface.
20-yr rust-through warranty on frame & panels
40-yr paint warranty against fading + chalking
1-yr craftsmanship on installation
💳
$0-down financing
Three financing paths to fit any credit situation. The rent-to-own option requires no credit pull at all, fastest path to a closed deal.
RTO: $6248/mo, no credit check, 36–60 mo
Financing: 0% promo APR · 84 mo term
Cash discount: 4% on $10K+ orders
⚡
Why 100×200?
20,000 sq ft sits in the sweet spot for residential and light-commercial, fits standard quarter-acre setbacks, comfortably below the 1,000 sq ft municipal threshold that triggers extra inspections.
100′ × 200′ footprint with 20,000 sq ft interior
Permit-friendly in 96% of US counties
Resale ROI $160,000–$240,000 added home value
PEOPLE ALSO ASK
Common questions from Aircraft Hangar shoppers.
The questions our team hears every week. Click any to expand the short answer.
How thick is the steel on a Steel and Stud 100×200 metal building?
Standard frame: 14-gauge (1.5 mm) galvanized tubing. Optional 12-gauge upgrade (2.5 mm) for high-wind/snow zones. Roof and wall sheeting ships 29-gauge standard, 26-gauge upgrade available on order.
Does Steel and Stud deliver and install in my state?
Yes, free delivery and free installation in all 48 continental states, performed by certified Steel and Stud crews. Hawaii and Alaska use custom freight quotes; call 1-877-275-7048 for either.
What’s the typical lead time for a 100×200 building?
Standard: 3–5 weeks from order confirmation to install completion. Fabrication runs the first 2–3 weeks at our US plant; regional delivery and 1-2 day install close it out. Rush builds available for $345.
Can I finance a Steel and Stud building without a credit check?
Yes, Steel and Stud’s rent-to-own partner does not pull credit. Approvals typically run 8 minutes with proof of income and first month’s payment. 36–60 month terms, no early-payoff penalty.
What’s covered under the 20-year warranty?
Steel and Stud’s 20-year rust-through warranty covers the galvanized frame against perforation, plus a 20-year paint-finish warranty against fade and chalk. Workmanship on the install is warrantied for 1 year. Warranty transfers to the next owner on resale.
CUSTOMER REVIEWS
What real 100×200 Aircraft Hangar buyers say.
⭐
No reviews yet for the 100×200 Aircraft Hangar
Be the first verified buyer to share your experience. Honest reviews help other steel-building shoppers make a confident decision.
A 100×200 aircraft hangar from Steel and Stud starts at $299,900 with free delivery and free installation across all 48 states. Most buyers pick the rent-to-own option at about $6248/month with $0 down and no credit check. Call 1-877-275-7048 for a same-day price lock.
Is delivery and installation included in the 100×200 aircraft hangar price?
Yes, every Steel and Stud aircraft hangar ships with free delivery + free installation by a certified crew, included in the listed price. Anchored to a concrete pad, asphalt, or compacted gravel, your building is fully erected in 1–2 days after the truck arrives.
Do I need a permit for a 100×200 aircraft hangar?
Almost always for 20,000+ sq ft enclosed buildings. Steel and Stud emails engineered drawings stamped for your wind zone (up to 180 mph) and snow zone (up to 65 psf) at no charge, so your local building department has everything it needs. Permit timing typically runs 2–6 weeks by jurisdiction.
How is a Steel and Stud aircraft hangar different from a wood-frame build?
Steel solves the problems wood creates, no rotting, no termites, no warping, no painting every 3 years. Our 14-gauge galvanized frame carries a 20-year rust warranty and ships with a 180 mph wind / 65 psf snow rating already engineered in. A comparable wood build typically costs 2–3× more and needs ongoing maintenance.
What foundation does a 100×200 aircraft hangar need?
A 4-inch concrete pad poured 1 foot wider and longer than the building is the standard. Steel and Stud also anchors to asphalt or compacted gravel for open or semi-enclosed configurations. A pad-pour bundle is offered at checkout if you don’t already have a slab.
How fast can I get a 100×200 aircraft hangar delivered?
Standard lead time is 3–5 weeks from order to install. Fabrication runs the first 2–3 weeks at our US plant; regional delivery + 1–2-day install by a certified Steel and Stud crew closes out the order. Rush builds are available, call 1-877-275-7048 for current capacity.
Can I finance a 100×200 aircraft hangar without a credit check?
Yes, Steel and Stud’s rent-to-own partner does not pull credit. Approvals close in about 8 minutes with proof of income and your first month’s payment. Terms run 36–60 months with no early-payoff penalty, and the monthly works out to roughly $6248/month on a 100×200 aircraft hangar.
What warranty comes with the 100×200 aircraft hangar?
Steel and Stud backs every building with a 20-year rust-through warranty on the galvanized frame and a 10-year sheeting warranty on the 29-gauge panels (upgradeable to 26-gauge or 12-gauge). Workmanship on the install is warrantied for 1 year. Full warranty terms ship with your order packet.
Can I customize the 100×200 aircraft hangar in 3D before I order?
Yes, our free Sensei3D Designer lets you drag and drop doors, windows, and walk-ins; swap 16 roof + trim colors live; and rotate the building in 3D from every angle. No login required. The design saves directly to a quote so what you build is exactly what we price.
Does the 100×200 aircraft hangar meet IBC commercial code?
Yes. Steel and Stud’s 12-gauge frame upgrade and 26-gauge sheeting both meet IBC commercial standards, and most counties accept our stamped drawings without revision. Engineered loads ship with the order, typical certified specs are 180 mph wind / 65 psf snow.
Ready to build?
Your Aircraft Hangar quote takes one minute.
Tell us your zip and the options you want. We’ll send back a same-day, all-in price.
20,000 sq ft for industrial warehouse, hangar, or distribution facility
100′ x 200′14 GaugeLocal Certification Available
Pre-engineered 100×200 steel building delivers 20,000 sq ft of column-free space. Galvanized 14-gauge tubular frame, vertical roof, and certified wind and snow load ratings. Customize doors, windows, colors, eave height, and certifications in our free 3D builder.
Leg height adjustable up to 20'
$299,900.00
Free Delivery & Install RTO from /mo — No credit check
20,000 sq ft for industrial warehouse, hangar, or distribution facility
100′ x 200′14 GaugeLocal Certification Available
Pre-engineered 100×200 steel building delivers 20,000 sq ft of column-free space. Galvanized 14-gauge tubular frame, vertical roof, and certified wind and snow load ratings. Customize doors, windows, colors, eave height, and certifications in our free 3D builder.
100×200 Cold Storage Facility | Steel and Stud, From $300,300
100×200 Cold Storage Facility, rated for heavy-duty industrial loads.
Built for industrial buyers managing equipment and inventory, this 100×200 cold storage facility packs 20000 sq ft into a code-compliant shell. Food distributors and produce operators spec insulated metal panels (IMPs).
Starting from your selected configuration$300,300$342,350Save $42,050
or as low as $6256/mo · 0% APR · No credit RTO
ℹ️This is an estimate. Final pricing is locked after our sales team reviews your complete requirements (site access, ground type, county-specific certifications, optional upgrades). You’ll receive a written all-in quote within one business day of your request, no surprises, no hidden fees.
FREE delivery & installation in all 48 states. Concrete, asphalt, or compacted gravel.
SKU:SS-100X200-COLD-STORAGE-FACBuilt:1,847+Since: 2002Made in: 🇺🇸 USA
🛡️
A+
BBB Accredited
★
4.8/5
customer rating
⏱
Since 2004
In Business
🏠
15,000+
Buildings
🇺🇸
48
States Served
We’ve provided builds for
SPATIAL LAYOUT
See how 800 sq ft fits your distribution facility.
100 feet wide × 200 feet long. Column-free clear span; 18-ft+ height for 5-tier racking. Built for industrial buyers managing equipment and inventory, this 100×200 cold storage facility packs 20000 sq ft into a code-compliant shell.
Multi-dock loading bays at the front, high-bay racking aisles in the middle, office mezzanine + break + restrooms at the rear. Capacity: ~400 pallet positions, full forklift ops. Food distributors and produce operators spec insulated metal panels (IMPs) on this footprint for refrigerated and freezer storage.
💡 Pro tip:Refrigeration-Ready. Size affords: multiple dock doors, mezzanine office, in-rack sprinklers.
🎨 FREE 3D BUILDER
Build your 100×200 Cold Storage Facility in 3D.
Design your building yourself in our free Sensei3D Designer, drag doors and windows where you want them, swap roof + trim colors, and see your spec from every angle. Save your design and email it to yourself for later.
Drag-and-drop doors, windows, walk-ins anywhere on the building
16 colors applied live to roof, walls, and trim, mix & match
Interior + exterior views of your spec, with measurements
Save your design and share it with your contractor or family
Auto-syncs to quote, what you build is what we price
All variants ship with free delivery, installation, drawings, 20-year warranty.
🏗️
20,000 sq ft enclosed
Fully-enclosed 100×200 vertical-roof structure.
🚪
Roll-up + walk-in doors
Standard configuration door package.
🔩
14-gauge steel frame
American-rolled galvanized tubing.
🎨
1 standard color
Pick from 16 factory-baked finishes.
TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS
Cold Storage Facility spec sheet.
Width100′
Length200′ + 6" overhang
Side height9′ standard
Floor space20,000 sq ft
Doors1 × 9×8 roll-up
Walk-inOptional (+$345)
WindowsOptional
Windup to 180 mph
Snowup to 65 psf
RoofVertical 3:12
Frame14 ga (12 ga upgrade)
Sheeting29 ga (26 ga upgrade)
AnchoringConcrete · Asphalt · Ground
Lead time3 – 5 weeks
USE CASE EXAMPLES
How real buyers use Cold Storage Facility.
DAILY USE
Everyday cold storage facility
20,000 sq ft is the right size for daily use of a cold storage facility.
STORAGE OVERFLOW
cold storage facility + seasonal storage
Park or store equipment in the front half, leave the rear for seasonal storage and overflow.
FLEX ROOM
Expansion-ready
Stud-framed interior makes it easy to add a partition, electrical, or insulation later.
FULL PRODUCT DETAILS
100×200 Cold Storage Facility, what makes it different.
20,000sq ft
Floor Space
180mph
Wind Rated
65psf
Snow Load
20yr
Rust Warranty
40yr
Paint Warranty
$6256/mo
From RTO
🏗️
Engineered for your county
Every 100×200 cold storage facility is fabricated from American-rolled galvanized steel and engineered against the exact wind and snow loads your jurisdiction requires.
Standard: 140 mph wind / 35 psf snow
12-ga upgrade: 180 mph / 65 psf
Permit drawings stamped and emailed free
🔩
Construction details
The same materials commercial fabricators use, not residential-grade. Hot-dip galvanized fasteners, factory-baked siliconized polyester paint, Hilti-grade anchors.
Frame: 14-ga (12-ga upgrade) galvanized tubing
Panels: 29-ga G-90 (26-ga upgrade)
Fasteners: #14 self-drilling with EPDM washer
🚚
Free delivery & install, really free
Regional-route delivery plus 1–2 day on-site installation by a certified crew, bundled into your headline price. No hidden unloading fees, fuel surcharges, or site-prep charges.
$0 deposit · pay only after walkthrough sign-off
3–5 week lead time on regional routes
All 48 states · rush option available
🛡️
Warranty & lifespan
Engineered for a 50-year service life with industry-leading warranties on every wear surface.
20-yr rust-through warranty on frame & panels
40-yr paint warranty against fading + chalking
1-yr craftsmanship on installation
💳
$0-down financing
Three financing paths to fit any credit situation. The rent-to-own option requires no credit pull at all, fastest path to a closed deal.
RTO: $6256/mo, no credit check, 36–60 mo
Financing: 0% promo APR · 84 mo term
Cash discount: 4% on $10K+ orders
⚡
Why 100×200?
20,000 sq ft sits in the sweet spot for residential and light-commercial, fits standard quarter-acre setbacks, comfortably below the 1,000 sq ft municipal threshold that triggers extra inspections.
100′ × 200′ footprint with 20,000 sq ft interior
Permit-friendly in 96% of US counties
Resale ROI $160,000–$240,000 added home value
PEOPLE ALSO ASK
Common questions from Cold Storage Facility shoppers.
The questions our team hears every week. Click any to expand the short answer.
How thick is the steel on a Steel and Stud 100×200 metal building?
Standard frame: 14-gauge (1.5 mm) galvanized tubing. Optional 12-gauge upgrade (2.5 mm) for high-wind/snow zones. Roof and wall sheeting ships 29-gauge standard, 26-gauge upgrade available on order.
Does Steel and Stud deliver and install in my state?
Yes, free delivery and free installation in all 48 continental states, performed by certified Steel and Stud crews. Hawaii and Alaska use custom freight quotes; call 1-877-275-7048 for either.
What’s the typical lead time for a 100×200 building?
Standard: 3–5 weeks from order confirmation to install completion. Fabrication runs the first 2–3 weeks at our US plant; regional delivery and 1-2 day install close it out. Rush builds available for $345.
Can I finance a Steel and Stud building without a credit check?
Yes, Steel and Stud’s rent-to-own partner does not pull credit. Approvals typically run 8 minutes with proof of income and first month’s payment. 36–60 month terms, no early-payoff penalty.
What’s covered under the 20-year warranty?
Steel and Stud’s 20-year rust-through warranty covers the galvanized frame against perforation, plus a 20-year paint-finish warranty against fade and chalk. Workmanship on the install is warrantied for 1 year. Warranty transfers to the next owner on resale.
CUSTOMER REVIEWS
What real 100×200 Cold Storage Facility buyers say.
⭐
No reviews yet for the 100×200 Cold Storage Facility
Be the first verified buyer to share your experience. Honest reviews help other steel-building shoppers make a confident decision.
How much does a 100×200 cold storage facility cost?
A 100×200 cold storage facility from Steel and Stud starts at $300,300 with free delivery and free installation across all 48 states. Most buyers pick the rent-to-own option at about $6256/month with $0 down and no credit check. Call 1-877-275-7048 for a same-day price lock.
Is delivery and installation included in the 100×200 cold storage facility price?
Yes, every Steel and Stud cold storage facility ships with free delivery + free installation by a certified crew, included in the listed price. Anchored to a concrete pad, asphalt, or compacted gravel, your building is fully erected in 1–2 days after the truck arrives.
Do I need a permit for a 100×200 cold storage facility?
Almost always for 20,000+ sq ft enclosed buildings. Steel and Stud emails engineered drawings stamped for your wind zone (up to 180 mph) and snow zone (up to 65 psf) at no charge, so your local building department has everything it needs. Permit timing typically runs 2–6 weeks by jurisdiction.
How is a Steel and Stud cold storage facility different from a wood-frame build?
Steel solves the problems wood creates, no rotting, no termites, no warping, no painting every 3 years. Our 14-gauge galvanized frame carries a 20-year rust warranty and ships with a 180 mph wind / 65 psf snow rating already engineered in. A comparable wood build typically costs 2–3× more and needs ongoing maintenance.
What foundation does a 100×200 cold storage facility need?
A 4-inch concrete pad poured 1 foot wider and longer than the building is the standard. Steel and Stud also anchors to asphalt or compacted gravel for open or semi-enclosed configurations. A pad-pour bundle is offered at checkout if you don’t already have a slab.
How fast can I get a 100×200 cold storage facility delivered?
Standard lead time is 3–5 weeks from order to install. Fabrication runs the first 2–3 weeks at our US plant; regional delivery + 1–2-day install by a certified Steel and Stud crew closes out the order. Rush builds are available, call 1-877-275-7048 for current capacity.
Can I finance a 100×200 cold storage facility without a credit check?
Yes, Steel and Stud’s rent-to-own partner does not pull credit. Approvals close in about 8 minutes with proof of income and your first month’s payment. Terms run 36–60 months with no early-payoff penalty, and the monthly works out to roughly $6256/month on a 100×200 cold storage facility.
What warranty comes with the 100×200 cold storage facility?
Steel and Stud backs every building with a 20-year rust-through warranty on the galvanized frame and a 10-year sheeting warranty on the 29-gauge panels (upgradeable to 26-gauge or 12-gauge). Workmanship on the install is warrantied for 1 year. Full warranty terms ship with your order packet.
Can I customize the 100×200 cold storage facility in 3D before I order?
Yes, our free Sensei3D Designer lets you drag and drop doors, windows, and walk-ins; swap 16 roof + trim colors live; and rotate the building in 3D from every angle. No login required. The design saves directly to a quote so what you build is exactly what we price.
Will the 100×200 cold storage facility handle heavy equipment and forklifts?
Standard 100×200 cold storage facility ships rated for 35 psf live load on the floor (over concrete pad), and the 12-gauge frame upgrade supports trolley- and jib-crane mounts up to 1-ton capacity. Steel and Stud engineers will spec heavier rigging on request, call 1-877-275-7048.
Ready to build?
Your Cold Storage Facility quote takes one minute.
Tell us your zip and the options you want. We’ll send back a same-day, all-in price.
20,000 sq ft for industrial warehouse, hangar, or distribution facility
100′ x 200′14 GaugeLocal Certification Available
Pre-engineered 100×200 steel building delivers 20,000 sq ft of column-free space. Galvanized 14-gauge tubular frame, vertical roof, and certified wind and snow load ratings. Customize doors, windows, colors, eave height, and certifications in our free 3D builder.
Leg height adjustable up to 20'
$300,300.00
Free Delivery & Install RTO from /mo — No credit check
20,000 sq ft for industrial warehouse, hangar, or distribution facility
100′ x 200′14 GaugeLocal Certification Available
Pre-engineered 100×200 steel building delivers 20,000 sq ft of column-free space. Galvanized 14-gauge tubular frame, vertical roof, and certified wind and snow load ratings. Customize doors, windows, colors, eave height, and certifications in our free 3D builder.
100×200 Indoor Riding Arena | Steel and Stud, From $298,700
100×200 Indoor Riding Arena, built for farm and ranch demands.
Large indoor riding arena with mounted-rider clearance, kickwall reinforcement up to 8 feet, and a side lean-to for tack rooms or stalls. Galvanized framing handles ammonia and humidity from year-round equine use.
Starting from your selected configuration$298,700$340,500Save $41,800
or as low as $6223/mo · 0% APR · No credit RTO
ℹ️This is an estimate. Final pricing is locked after our sales team reviews your complete requirements (site access, ground type, county-specific certifications, optional upgrades). You’ll receive a written all-in quote within one business day of your request, no surprises, no hidden fees.
FREE delivery & installation in all 48 states. Concrete, asphalt, or compacted gravel.
SKU:SS-100X200-INDOOR-RIDING-ARBuilt:1,847+Since: 2002Made in: 🇺🇸 USA
🛡️
A+
BBB Accredited
★
4.8/5
customer rating
⏱
Since 2004
In Business
🏠
15,000+
Buildings
🇺🇸
48
States Served
We’ve provided builds for
SPATIAL LAYOUT
See how 800 sq ft fits your open-arena layout.
100 feet wide × 200 feet long. Large indoor riding arena with mounted-rider clearance, kickwall reinforcement up to 8 feet, and a side lean-to for tack rooms or stalls.
Court / Field · Sideline / Bench · Equipment storage
Court / Field at the front, sideline / bench in the middle, equipment storage at the rear. Galvanized framing handles ammonia and humidity from year-round equine use.
💡 Pro tip:Indoor Riding Arena at 100×200, add insulation + electrical for year-round use.
🎨 FREE 3D BUILDER
Build your 100×200 Indoor Riding Arena in 3D.
Design your building yourself in our free Sensei3D Designer, drag doors and windows where you want them, swap roof + trim colors, and see your spec from every angle. Save your design and email it to yourself for later.
Drag-and-drop doors, windows, walk-ins anywhere on the building
16 colors applied live to roof, walls, and trim, mix & match
Interior + exterior views of your spec, with measurements
Save your design and share it with your contractor or family
Auto-syncs to quote, what you build is what we price
All variants ship with free delivery, installation, drawings, 20-year warranty.
🏗️
20,000 sq ft enclosed
Fully-enclosed 100×200 vertical-roof structure.
🚪
Roll-up + walk-in doors
Standard configuration door package.
🔩
14-gauge steel frame
American-rolled galvanized tubing.
🎨
1 standard color
Pick from 16 factory-baked finishes.
TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS
Indoor Riding Arena spec sheet.
Width100′
Length200′ + 6" overhang
Side height9′ standard
Floor space20,000 sq ft
Doors1 × 9×8 roll-up
Walk-inOptional (+$345)
WindowsOptional
Windup to 180 mph
Snowup to 65 psf
RoofVertical 3:12
Frame14 ga (12 ga upgrade)
Sheeting29 ga (26 ga upgrade)
AnchoringConcrete · Asphalt · Ground
Lead time3 – 5 weeks
USE CASE EXAMPLES
How real buyers use Indoor Riding Arena.
DAILY USE
Everyday indoor riding arena
20,000 sq ft is the right size for daily use of a indoor riding arena.
STORAGE OVERFLOW
indoor riding arena + seasonal storage
Park or store equipment in the front half, leave the rear for seasonal storage and overflow.
FLEX ROOM
Expansion-ready
Stud-framed interior makes it easy to add a partition, electrical, or insulation later.
FULL PRODUCT DETAILS
100×200 Indoor Riding Arena, what makes it different.
20,000sq ft
Floor Space
180mph
Wind Rated
65psf
Snow Load
20yr
Rust Warranty
40yr
Paint Warranty
$6223/mo
From RTO
🏗️
Engineered for your county
Every 100×200 indoor riding arena is fabricated from American-rolled galvanized steel and engineered against the exact wind and snow loads your jurisdiction requires.
Standard: 140 mph wind / 35 psf snow
12-ga upgrade: 180 mph / 65 psf
Permit drawings stamped and emailed free
🔩
Construction details
The same materials commercial fabricators use, not residential-grade. Hot-dip galvanized fasteners, factory-baked siliconized polyester paint, Hilti-grade anchors.
Frame: 14-ga (12-ga upgrade) galvanized tubing
Panels: 29-ga G-90 (26-ga upgrade)
Fasteners: #14 self-drilling with EPDM washer
🚚
Free delivery & install, really free
Regional-route delivery plus 1–2 day on-site installation by a certified crew, bundled into your headline price. No hidden unloading fees, fuel surcharges, or site-prep charges.
$0 deposit · pay only after walkthrough sign-off
3–5 week lead time on regional routes
All 48 states · rush option available
🛡️
Warranty & lifespan
Engineered for a 50-year service life with industry-leading warranties on every wear surface.
20-yr rust-through warranty on frame & panels
40-yr paint warranty against fading + chalking
1-yr craftsmanship on installation
💳
$0-down financing
Three financing paths to fit any credit situation. The rent-to-own option requires no credit pull at all, fastest path to a closed deal.
RTO: $6223/mo, no credit check, 36–60 mo
Financing: 0% promo APR · 84 mo term
Cash discount: 4% on $10K+ orders
⚡
Why 100×200?
20,000 sq ft sits in the sweet spot for residential and light-commercial, fits standard quarter-acre setbacks, comfortably below the 1,000 sq ft municipal threshold that triggers extra inspections.
100′ × 200′ footprint with 20,000 sq ft interior
Permit-friendly in 96% of US counties
Resale ROI $160,000–$240,000 added home value
PEOPLE ALSO ASK
Common questions from Indoor Riding Arena shoppers.
The questions our team hears every week. Click any to expand the short answer.
How thick is the steel on a Steel and Stud 100×200 metal building?
Standard frame: 14-gauge (1.5 mm) galvanized tubing. Optional 12-gauge upgrade (2.5 mm) for high-wind/snow zones. Roof and wall sheeting ships 29-gauge standard, 26-gauge upgrade available on order.
Does Steel and Stud deliver and install in my state?
Yes, free delivery and free installation in all 48 continental states, performed by certified Steel and Stud crews. Hawaii and Alaska use custom freight quotes; call 1-877-275-7048 for either.
What’s the typical lead time for a 100×200 building?
Standard: 3–5 weeks from order confirmation to install completion. Fabrication runs the first 2–3 weeks at our US plant; regional delivery and 1-2 day install close it out. Rush builds available for $345.
Can I finance a Steel and Stud building without a credit check?
Yes, Steel and Stud’s rent-to-own partner does not pull credit. Approvals typically run 8 minutes with proof of income and first month’s payment. 36–60 month terms, no early-payoff penalty.
What’s covered under the 20-year warranty?
Steel and Stud’s 20-year rust-through warranty covers the galvanized frame against perforation, plus a 20-year paint-finish warranty against fade and chalk. Workmanship on the install is warrantied for 1 year. Warranty transfers to the next owner on resale.
CUSTOMER REVIEWS
What real 100×200 Indoor Riding Arena buyers say.
⭐
No reviews yet for the 100×200 Indoor Riding Arena
Be the first verified buyer to share your experience. Honest reviews help other steel-building shoppers make a confident decision.
A 100×200 indoor riding arena from Steel and Stud starts at $298,700 with free delivery and free installation across all 48 states. Most buyers pick the rent-to-own option at about $6223/month with $0 down and no credit check. Call 1-877-275-7048 for a same-day price lock.
Is delivery and installation included in the 100×200 indoor riding arena price?
Yes, every Steel and Stud indoor riding arena ships with free delivery + free installation by a certified crew, included in the listed price. Anchored to a concrete pad, asphalt, or compacted gravel, your building is fully erected in 1–2 days after the truck arrives.
Do I need a permit for a 100×200 indoor riding arena?
Almost always for 20,000+ sq ft enclosed buildings. Steel and Stud emails engineered drawings stamped for your wind zone (up to 180 mph) and snow zone (up to 65 psf) at no charge, so your local building department has everything it needs. Permit timing typically runs 2–6 weeks by jurisdiction.
How is a Steel and Stud indoor riding arena different from a wood-frame build?
Steel solves the problems wood creates, no rotting, no termites, no warping, no painting every 3 years. Our 14-gauge galvanized frame carries a 20-year rust warranty and ships with a 180 mph wind / 65 psf snow rating already engineered in. A comparable wood build typically costs 2–3× more and needs ongoing maintenance.
What foundation does a 100×200 indoor riding arena need?
A 4-inch concrete pad poured 1 foot wider and longer than the building is the standard. Steel and Stud also anchors to asphalt or compacted gravel for open or semi-enclosed configurations. A pad-pour bundle is offered at checkout if you don’t already have a slab.
How fast can I get a 100×200 indoor riding arena delivered?
Standard lead time is 3–5 weeks from order to install. Fabrication runs the first 2–3 weeks at our US plant; regional delivery + 1–2-day install by a certified Steel and Stud crew closes out the order. Rush builds are available, call 1-877-275-7048 for current capacity.
Can I finance a 100×200 indoor riding arena without a credit check?
Yes, Steel and Stud’s rent-to-own partner does not pull credit. Approvals close in about 8 minutes with proof of income and your first month’s payment. Terms run 36–60 months with no early-payoff penalty, and the monthly works out to roughly $6223/month on a 100×200 indoor riding arena.
What warranty comes with the 100×200 indoor riding arena?
Steel and Stud backs every building with a 20-year rust-through warranty on the galvanized frame and a 10-year sheeting warranty on the 29-gauge panels (upgradeable to 26-gauge or 12-gauge). Workmanship on the install is warrantied for 1 year. Full warranty terms ship with your order packet.
Can I customize the 100×200 indoor riding arena in 3D before I order?
Yes, our free Sensei3D Designer lets you drag and drop doors, windows, and walk-ins; swap 16 roof + trim colors live; and rotate the building in 3D from every angle. No login required. The design saves directly to a quote so what you build is exactly what we price.
Will the 100×200 indoor riding arena stand up to livestock and Midwest weather?
The 14-gauge galvanized frame is the same spec Steel and Stud uses for commercial barns, rated to 65 psf snow and 180 mph wind. Ventilation packages (ridge vent + soffit) ship standard on agricultural orders to prevent moisture buildup that would warp a wood barn.
Ready to build?
Your Indoor Riding Arena quote takes one minute.
Tell us your zip and the options you want. We’ll send back a same-day, all-in price.
20,000 sq ft for industrial warehouse, hangar, or distribution facility
100′ x 200′14 GaugeLocal Certification Available
Pre-engineered 100×200 steel building delivers 20,000 sq ft of column-free space. Galvanized 14-gauge tubular frame, vertical roof, and certified wind and snow load ratings. Customize doors, windows, colors, eave height, and certifications in our free 3D builder.
Leg height adjustable up to 20'
$298,700.00
Free Delivery & Install RTO from /mo — No credit check
20,000 sq ft for industrial warehouse, hangar, or distribution facility
100′ x 200′14 GaugeLocal Certification Available
Pre-engineered 100×200 steel building delivers 20,000 sq ft of column-free space. Galvanized 14-gauge tubular frame, vertical roof, and certified wind and snow load ratings. Customize doors, windows, colors, eave height, and certifications in our free 3D builder.
100×200 Retail & Showroom | Steel and Stud, From $299,900
100×200 Retail & Showroom, engineered for code-compliant business use.
100×200 delivers 20000 sq ft of code-compliant retail & showroom space. Commercial real estate buyers building auto, RV, or boat showrooms use this size to display 30+ vehicles with a customer lounge and service.
Starting from your selected configuration$299,900$341,900Save $42,000
or as low as $6248/mo · 0% APR · No credit RTO
ℹ️This is an estimate. Final pricing is locked after our sales team reviews your complete requirements (site access, ground type, county-specific certifications, optional upgrades). You’ll receive a written all-in quote within one business day of your request, no surprises, no hidden fees.
Full-glass storefront at the front, showroom + demo floor in the middle, stockroom + receiving + office at the rear. Capacity: ~12000 sf showroom, 6000 sf stock. Commercial real estate buyers building auto, RV, or boat showrooms use this size to display 30+ vehicles with a customer lounge and service write-up area.
Design your building yourself in our free Sensei3D Designer, drag doors and windows where you want them, swap roof + trim colors, and see your spec from every angle. Save your design and email it to yourself for later.
Drag-and-drop doors, windows, walk-ins anywhere on the building
16 colors applied live to roof, walls, and trim, mix & match
Interior + exterior views of your spec, with measurements
Save your design and share it with your contractor or family
Auto-syncs to quote, what you build is what we price
All variants ship with free delivery, installation, drawings, 20-year warranty.
🏗️
20,000 sq ft enclosed
Fully-enclosed 100×200 vertical-roof structure.
🚪
Roll-up + walk-in doors
Standard configuration door package.
🔩
14-gauge steel frame
American-rolled galvanized tubing.
🎨
1 standard color
Pick from 16 factory-baked finishes.
TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS
Retail & Showroom spec sheet.
Width100′
Length200′ + 6" overhang
Side height9′ standard
Floor space20,000 sq ft
Doors1 × 9×8 roll-up
Walk-inOptional (+$345)
WindowsOptional
Windup to 180 mph
Snowup to 65 psf
RoofVertical 3:12
Frame14 ga (12 ga upgrade)
Sheeting29 ga (26 ga upgrade)
AnchoringConcrete · Asphalt · Ground
Lead time3 – 5 weeks
USE CASE EXAMPLES
How real buyers use Retail & Showroom.
DAILY USE
Everyday retail & showroom
20,000 sq ft is the right size for daily use of a retail & showroom.
STORAGE OVERFLOW
retail & showroom + seasonal storage
Park or store equipment in the front half, leave the rear for seasonal storage and overflow.
FLEX ROOM
Expansion-ready
Stud-framed interior makes it easy to add a partition, electrical, or insulation later.
FULL PRODUCT DETAILS
100×200 Retail & Showroom, what makes it different.
20,000sq ft
Floor Space
180mph
Wind Rated
65psf
Snow Load
20yr
Rust Warranty
40yr
Paint Warranty
$6248/mo
From RTO
🏗️
Engineered for your county
Every 100×200 retail & showroom is fabricated from American-rolled galvanized steel and engineered against the exact wind and snow loads your jurisdiction requires.
Standard: 140 mph wind / 35 psf snow
12-ga upgrade: 180 mph / 65 psf
Permit drawings stamped and emailed free
🔩
Construction details
The same materials commercial fabricators use, not residential-grade. Hot-dip galvanized fasteners, factory-baked siliconized polyester paint, Hilti-grade anchors.
Frame: 14-ga (12-ga upgrade) galvanized tubing
Panels: 29-ga G-90 (26-ga upgrade)
Fasteners: #14 self-drilling with EPDM washer
🚚
Free delivery & install, really free
Regional-route delivery plus 1–2 day on-site installation by a certified crew, bundled into your headline price. No hidden unloading fees, fuel surcharges, or site-prep charges.
$0 deposit · pay only after walkthrough sign-off
3–5 week lead time on regional routes
All 48 states · rush option available
🛡️
Warranty & lifespan
Engineered for a 50-year service life with industry-leading warranties on every wear surface.
20-yr rust-through warranty on frame & panels
40-yr paint warranty against fading + chalking
1-yr craftsmanship on installation
💳
$0-down financing
Three financing paths to fit any credit situation. The rent-to-own option requires no credit pull at all, fastest path to a closed deal.
RTO: $6248/mo, no credit check, 36–60 mo
Financing: 0% promo APR · 84 mo term
Cash discount: 4% on $10K+ orders
⚡
Why 100×200?
20,000 sq ft sits in the sweet spot for residential and light-commercial, fits standard quarter-acre setbacks, comfortably below the 1,000 sq ft municipal threshold that triggers extra inspections.
100′ × 200′ footprint with 20,000 sq ft interior
Permit-friendly in 96% of US counties
Resale ROI $160,000–$240,000 added home value
PEOPLE ALSO ASK
Common questions from Retail & Showroom shoppers.
The questions our team hears every week. Click any to expand the short answer.
How thick is the steel on a Steel and Stud 100×200 metal building?
Standard frame: 14-gauge (1.5 mm) galvanized tubing. Optional 12-gauge upgrade (2.5 mm) for high-wind/snow zones. Roof and wall sheeting ships 29-gauge standard, 26-gauge upgrade available on order.
Does Steel and Stud deliver and install in my state?
Yes, free delivery and free installation in all 48 continental states, performed by certified Steel and Stud crews. Hawaii and Alaska use custom freight quotes; call 1-877-275-7048 for either.
What’s the typical lead time for a 100×200 building?
Standard: 3–5 weeks from order confirmation to install completion. Fabrication runs the first 2–3 weeks at our US plant; regional delivery and 1-2 day install close it out. Rush builds available for $345.
Can I finance a Steel and Stud building without a credit check?
Yes, Steel and Stud’s rent-to-own partner does not pull credit. Approvals typically run 8 minutes with proof of income and first month’s payment. 36–60 month terms, no early-payoff penalty.
What’s covered under the 20-year warranty?
Steel and Stud’s 20-year rust-through warranty covers the galvanized frame against perforation, plus a 20-year paint-finish warranty against fade and chalk. Workmanship on the install is warrantied for 1 year. Warranty transfers to the next owner on resale.
CUSTOMER REVIEWS
What real 100×200 Retail & Showroom buyers say.
⭐
No reviews yet for the 100×200 Retail & Showroom
Be the first verified buyer to share your experience. Honest reviews help other steel-building shoppers make a confident decision.
A 100×200 retail & showroom from Steel and Stud starts at $299,900 with free delivery and free installation across all 48 states. Most buyers pick the rent-to-own option at about $6248/month with $0 down and no credit check. Call 1-877-275-7048 for a same-day price lock.
Is delivery and installation included in the 100×200 retail & showroom price?
Yes, every Steel and Stud retail & showroom ships with free delivery + free installation by a certified crew, included in the listed price. Anchored to a concrete pad, asphalt, or compacted gravel, your building is fully erected in 1–2 days after the truck arrives.
Do I need a permit for a 100×200 retail & showroom?
Almost always for 20,000+ sq ft enclosed buildings. Steel and Stud emails engineered drawings stamped for your wind zone (up to 180 mph) and snow zone (up to 65 psf) at no charge, so your local building department has everything it needs. Permit timing typically runs 2–6 weeks by jurisdiction.
How is a Steel and Stud retail & showroom different from a wood-frame build?
Steel solves the problems wood creates, no rotting, no termites, no warping, no painting every 3 years. Our 14-gauge galvanized frame carries a 20-year rust warranty and ships with a 180 mph wind / 65 psf snow rating already engineered in. A comparable wood build typically costs 2–3× more and needs ongoing maintenance.
What foundation does a 100×200 retail & showroom need?
A 4-inch concrete pad poured 1 foot wider and longer than the building is the standard. Steel and Stud also anchors to asphalt or compacted gravel for open or semi-enclosed configurations. A pad-pour bundle is offered at checkout if you don’t already have a slab.
How fast can I get a 100×200 retail & showroom delivered?
Standard lead time is 3–5 weeks from order to install. Fabrication runs the first 2–3 weeks at our US plant; regional delivery + 1–2-day install by a certified Steel and Stud crew closes out the order. Rush builds are available, call 1-877-275-7048 for current capacity.
Can I finance a 100×200 retail & showroom without a credit check?
Yes, Steel and Stud’s rent-to-own partner does not pull credit. Approvals close in about 8 minutes with proof of income and your first month’s payment. Terms run 36–60 months with no early-payoff penalty, and the monthly works out to roughly $6248/month on a 100×200 retail & showroom.
What warranty comes with the 100×200 retail & showroom?
Steel and Stud backs every building with a 20-year rust-through warranty on the galvanized frame and a 10-year sheeting warranty on the 29-gauge panels (upgradeable to 26-gauge or 12-gauge). Workmanship on the install is warrantied for 1 year. Full warranty terms ship with your order packet.
Can I customize the 100×200 retail & showroom in 3D before I order?
Yes, our free Sensei3D Designer lets you drag and drop doors, windows, and walk-ins; swap 16 roof + trim colors live; and rotate the building in 3D from every angle. No login required. The design saves directly to a quote so what you build is exactly what we price.
Does the 100×200 retail & showroom meet IBC commercial code?
Yes. Steel and Stud’s 12-gauge frame upgrade and 26-gauge sheeting both meet IBC commercial standards, and most counties accept our stamped drawings without revision. Engineered loads ship with the order, typical certified specs are 180 mph wind / 65 psf snow.
Ready to build?
Your Retail & Showroom quote takes one minute.
Tell us your zip and the options you want. We’ll send back a same-day, all-in price.
20,000 sq ft for industrial warehouse, hangar, or distribution facility
100′ x 200′14 GaugeLocal Certification Available
Pre-engineered 100×200 steel building delivers 20,000 sq ft of column-free space. Galvanized 14-gauge tubular frame, vertical roof, and certified wind and snow load ratings. Customize doors, windows, colors, eave height, and certifications in our free 3D builder.
Leg height adjustable up to 20'
$299,900.00
Free Delivery & Install RTO from /mo — No credit check
20,000 sq ft for industrial warehouse, hangar, or distribution facility
100′ x 200′14 GaugeLocal Certification Available
Pre-engineered 100×200 steel building delivers 20,000 sq ft of column-free space. Galvanized 14-gauge tubular frame, vertical roof, and certified wind and snow load ratings. Customize doors, windows, colors, eave height, and certifications in our free 3D builder.
100×200 Truck & Fleet Service Center | Steel and Stud, From $300,300
100×200 Truck & Fleet Service Center, rated for heavy-duty industrial loads.
100×200 delivers 20000 sq ft of heavy-duty truck & fleet service center space. Fleet operators spec 100×200 for a 6-bay heavy-duty service shop with pull-through bays for tractors and 53-foot trailers. The 100-foot.
You’re viewing:Truck & Fleet Service Center·Size100×200·Slate Gray
Starting from your selected configuration$300,300$342,350Save $42,050
or as low as $6256/mo · 0% APR · No credit RTO
ℹ️This is an estimate. Final pricing is locked after our sales team reviews your complete requirements (site access, ground type, county-specific certifications, optional upgrades). You’ll receive a written all-in quote within one business day of your request, no surprises, no hidden fees.
FREE delivery & installation in all 48 states. Concrete, asphalt, or compacted gravel.
SKU:SS-100X200-TRUCK-FLEET-SERVBuilt:1,847+Since: 2002Made in: 🇺🇸 USA
🛡️
A+
BBB Accredited
★
4.8/5
customer rating
⏱
Since 2004
In Business
🏠
15,000+
Buildings
🇺🇸
48
States Served
We’ve provided builds for
SPATIAL LAYOUT
See how 800 sq ft fits your multi-bay garage + shop.
100 feet wide × 200 feet long. Engineered for clear-span over multiple doors. 100×200 delivers 20000 sq ft of heavy-duty truck & fleet service center space.
10 vehicle bays · Workshop area · Storage + lift bay
10 vehicle bays at the front, workshop area in the middle, storage + lift bay at the rear. Capacity: 10 vehicles + full hobby shop. Fleet operators spec 100×200 for a 6-bay heavy-duty service shop with pull-through bays for tractors and 53-foot trailers.
Build your 100×200 Truck & Fleet Service Center in 3D.
Design your building yourself in our free Sensei3D Designer, drag doors and windows where you want them, swap roof + trim colors, and see your spec from every angle. Save your design and email it to yourself for later.
Drag-and-drop doors, windows, walk-ins anywhere on the building
16 colors applied live to roof, walls, and trim, mix & match
Interior + exterior views of your spec, with measurements
Save your design and share it with your contractor or family
Auto-syncs to quote, what you build is what we price
All variants ship with free delivery, installation, drawings, 20-year warranty.
🏗️
20,000 sq ft enclosed
Fully-enclosed 100×200 vertical-roof structure.
🚪
Roll-up + walk-in doors
Standard configuration door package.
🔩
14-gauge steel frame
American-rolled galvanized tubing.
🎨
1 standard color
Pick from 16 factory-baked finishes.
TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS
Truck & Fleet Service Center spec sheet.
Width100′
Length200′ + 6" overhang
Side height9′ standard
Floor space20,000 sq ft
Doors1 × 9×8 roll-up
Walk-inOptional (+$345)
WindowsOptional
Windup to 180 mph
Snowup to 65 psf
RoofVertical 3:12
Frame14 ga (12 ga upgrade)
Sheeting29 ga (26 ga upgrade)
AnchoringConcrete · Asphalt · Ground
Lead time3 – 5 weeks
USE CASE EXAMPLES
How real buyers use Truck & Fleet Service Center.
DAILY USE
Everyday truck & fleet service center
20,000 sq ft is the right size for daily use of a truck & fleet service center.
STORAGE OVERFLOW
truck & fleet service center + seasonal storage
Park or store equipment in the front half, leave the rear for seasonal storage and overflow.
FLEX ROOM
Expansion-ready
Stud-framed interior makes it easy to add a partition, electrical, or insulation later.
FULL PRODUCT DETAILS
100×200 Truck & Fleet Service Center, what makes it different.
20,000sq ft
Floor Space
180mph
Wind Rated
65psf
Snow Load
20yr
Rust Warranty
40yr
Paint Warranty
$6256/mo
From RTO
🏗️
Engineered for your county
Every 100×200 truck & fleet service center is fabricated from American-rolled galvanized steel and engineered against the exact wind and snow loads your jurisdiction requires.
Standard: 140 mph wind / 35 psf snow
12-ga upgrade: 180 mph / 65 psf
Permit drawings stamped and emailed free
🔩
Construction details
The same materials commercial fabricators use, not residential-grade. Hot-dip galvanized fasteners, factory-baked siliconized polyester paint, Hilti-grade anchors.
Frame: 14-ga (12-ga upgrade) galvanized tubing
Panels: 29-ga G-90 (26-ga upgrade)
Fasteners: #14 self-drilling with EPDM washer
🚚
Free delivery & install, really free
Regional-route delivery plus 1–2 day on-site installation by a certified crew, bundled into your headline price. No hidden unloading fees, fuel surcharges, or site-prep charges.
$0 deposit · pay only after walkthrough sign-off
3–5 week lead time on regional routes
All 48 states · rush option available
🛡️
Warranty & lifespan
Engineered for a 50-year service life with industry-leading warranties on every wear surface.
20-yr rust-through warranty on frame & panels
40-yr paint warranty against fading + chalking
1-yr craftsmanship on installation
💳
$0-down financing
Three financing paths to fit any credit situation. The rent-to-own option requires no credit pull at all, fastest path to a closed deal.
RTO: $6256/mo, no credit check, 36–60 mo
Financing: 0% promo APR · 84 mo term
Cash discount: 4% on $10K+ orders
⚡
Why 100×200?
20,000 sq ft sits in the sweet spot for residential and light-commercial, fits standard quarter-acre setbacks, comfortably below the 1,000 sq ft municipal threshold that triggers extra inspections.
100′ × 200′ footprint with 20,000 sq ft interior
Permit-friendly in 96% of US counties
Resale ROI $160,000–$240,000 added home value
PEOPLE ALSO ASK
Common questions from Truck & Fleet Service Center shoppers.
The questions our team hears every week. Click any to expand the short answer.
How thick is the steel on a Steel and Stud 100×200 metal building?
Standard frame: 14-gauge (1.5 mm) galvanized tubing. Optional 12-gauge upgrade (2.5 mm) for high-wind/snow zones. Roof and wall sheeting ships 29-gauge standard, 26-gauge upgrade available on order.
Does Steel and Stud deliver and install in my state?
Yes, free delivery and free installation in all 48 continental states, performed by certified Steel and Stud crews. Hawaii and Alaska use custom freight quotes; call 1-877-275-7048 for either.
What’s the typical lead time for a 100×200 building?
Standard: 3–5 weeks from order confirmation to install completion. Fabrication runs the first 2–3 weeks at our US plant; regional delivery and 1-2 day install close it out. Rush builds available for $345.
Can I finance a Steel and Stud building without a credit check?
Yes, Steel and Stud’s rent-to-own partner does not pull credit. Approvals typically run 8 minutes with proof of income and first month’s payment. 36–60 month terms, no early-payoff penalty.
What’s covered under the 20-year warranty?
Steel and Stud’s 20-year rust-through warranty covers the galvanized frame against perforation, plus a 20-year paint-finish warranty against fade and chalk. Workmanship on the install is warrantied for 1 year. Warranty transfers to the next owner on resale.
CUSTOMER REVIEWS
What real 100×200 Truck & Fleet Service Center buyers say.
⭐
No reviews yet for the 100×200 Truck & Fleet Service Center
Be the first verified buyer to share your experience. Honest reviews help other steel-building shoppers make a confident decision.
How much does a 100×200 truck & fleet service center cost?
A 100×200 truck & fleet service center from Steel and Stud starts at $300,300 with free delivery and free installation across all 48 states. Most buyers pick the rent-to-own option at about $6256/month with $0 down and no credit check. Call 1-877-275-7048 for a same-day price lock.
Is delivery and installation included in the 100×200 truck & fleet service center price?
Yes, every Steel and Stud truck & fleet service center ships with free delivery + free installation by a certified crew, included in the listed price. Anchored to a concrete pad, asphalt, or compacted gravel, your building is fully erected in 1–2 days after the truck arrives.
Do I need a permit for a 100×200 truck & fleet service center?
Almost always for 20,000+ sq ft enclosed buildings. Steel and Stud emails engineered drawings stamped for your wind zone (up to 180 mph) and snow zone (up to 65 psf) at no charge, so your local building department has everything it needs. Permit timing typically runs 2–6 weeks by jurisdiction.
How is a Steel and Stud truck & fleet service center different from a wood-frame build?
Steel solves the problems wood creates, no rotting, no termites, no warping, no painting every 3 years. Our 14-gauge galvanized frame carries a 20-year rust warranty and ships with a 180 mph wind / 65 psf snow rating already engineered in. A comparable wood build typically costs 2–3× more and needs ongoing maintenance.
What foundation does a 100×200 truck & fleet service center need?
A 4-inch concrete pad poured 1 foot wider and longer than the building is the standard. Steel and Stud also anchors to asphalt or compacted gravel for open or semi-enclosed configurations. A pad-pour bundle is offered at checkout if you don’t already have a slab.
How fast can I get a 100×200 truck & fleet service center delivered?
Standard lead time is 3–5 weeks from order to install. Fabrication runs the first 2–3 weeks at our US plant; regional delivery + 1–2-day install by a certified Steel and Stud crew closes out the order. Rush builds are available, call 1-877-275-7048 for current capacity.
Can I finance a 100×200 truck & fleet service center without a credit check?
Yes, Steel and Stud’s rent-to-own partner does not pull credit. Approvals close in about 8 minutes with proof of income and your first month’s payment. Terms run 36–60 months with no early-payoff penalty, and the monthly works out to roughly $6256/month on a 100×200 truck & fleet service center.
What warranty comes with the 100×200 truck & fleet service center?
Steel and Stud backs every building with a 20-year rust-through warranty on the galvanized frame and a 10-year sheeting warranty on the 29-gauge panels (upgradeable to 26-gauge or 12-gauge). Workmanship on the install is warrantied for 1 year. Full warranty terms ship with your order packet.
Can I customize the 100×200 truck & fleet service center in 3D before I order?
Yes, our free Sensei3D Designer lets you drag and drop doors, windows, and walk-ins; swap 16 roof + trim colors live; and rotate the building in 3D from every angle. No login required. The design saves directly to a quote so what you build is exactly what we price.
Will the 100×200 truck & fleet service center handle heavy equipment and forklifts?
Standard 100×200 truck & fleet service center ships rated for 35 psf live load on the floor (over concrete pad), and the 12-gauge frame upgrade supports trolley- and jib-crane mounts up to 1-ton capacity. Steel and Stud engineers will spec heavier rigging on request, call 1-877-275-7048.
Ready to build?
Your Truck & Fleet Service Center quote takes one minute.
Tell us your zip and the options you want. We’ll send back a same-day, all-in price.
20,000 sq ft for industrial warehouse, hangar, or distribution facility
100′ x 200′14 GaugeLocal Certification Available
Pre-engineered 100×200 steel building delivers 20,000 sq ft of column-free space. Galvanized 14-gauge tubular frame, vertical roof, and certified wind and snow load ratings. Customize doors, windows, colors, eave height, and certifications in our free 3D builder.
Leg height adjustable up to 20'
$300,300.00
Free Delivery & Install RTO from /mo — No credit check
20,000 sq ft for industrial warehouse, hangar, or distribution facility
100′ x 200′14 GaugeLocal Certification Available
Pre-engineered 100×200 steel building delivers 20,000 sq ft of column-free space. Galvanized 14-gauge tubular frame, vertical roof, and certified wind and snow load ratings. Customize doors, windows, colors, eave height, and certifications in our free 3D builder.
100×200 Sports & Recreation Facility | Steel and Stud, From $300,000
100×200 Sports & Recreation Facility, engineered to code for assembly use.
Looking for a 100×200 sports & recreation facility? At 20000 sq ft, this footprint suits public assembly, community use, or worship space. Schools and parks departments build indoor practice facilities, batting cages.
Starting from your selected configuration$300,000$342,000Save $42,000
or as low as $6250/mo · 0% APR · No credit RTO
ℹ️This is an estimate. Final pricing is locked after our sales team reviews your complete requirements (site access, ground type, county-specific certifications, optional upgrades). You’ll receive a written all-in quote within one business day of your request, no surprises, no hidden fees.
FREE delivery & installation in all 48 states. Concrete, asphalt, or compacted gravel.
SKU:SS-100X200-SPORTS-RECREATIOBuilt:1,847+Since: 2002Made in: 🇺🇸 USA
🛡️
A+
BBB Accredited
★
4.8/5
customer rating
⏱
Since 2004
In Business
🏠
15,000+
Buildings
🇺🇸
48
States Served
We’ve provided builds for
SPATIAL LAYOUT
See how 800 sq ft fits your sports & recreation facility layout.
100 feet wide × 200 feet long. Looking for a 100×200 sports & recreation facility? At 20000 sq ft, this footprint suits public assembly, community use, or worship space.
Sports & Recreation Facility layout.
Looking for a 100×200 sports & recreation facility? At 20000 sq ft, this footprint suits public assembly, community use, or worship space. Schools and parks departments build indoor practice facilities, batting cages, or pickleball courts at this footprint. 12,12500 sq ft fits four full pickleball courts plus spectator seating, or a regulation basketball half-court with a turf practice area. 24-foot eaves clear lobbed shots and ceiling lighting.
💡 Pro tip:Court-Height Clearance.
🎨 FREE 3D BUILDER
Build your 100×200 Sports & Recreation Facility in 3D.
Design your building yourself in our free Sensei3D Designer, drag doors and windows where you want them, swap roof + trim colors, and see your spec from every angle. Save your design and email it to yourself for later.
Drag-and-drop doors, windows, walk-ins anywhere on the building
16 colors applied live to roof, walls, and trim, mix & match
Interior + exterior views of your spec, with measurements
Save your design and share it with your contractor or family
Auto-syncs to quote, what you build is what we price
All variants ship with free delivery, installation, drawings, 20-year warranty.
🏗️
20,000 sq ft enclosed
Fully-enclosed 100×200 vertical-roof structure.
🚪
Roll-up + walk-in doors
Standard configuration door package.
🔩
14-gauge steel frame
American-rolled galvanized tubing.
🎨
1 standard color
Pick from 16 factory-baked finishes.
TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS
Sports & Recreation Facility spec sheet.
Width100′
Length200′ + 6" overhang
Side height9′ standard
Floor space20,000 sq ft
Doors1 × 9×8 roll-up
Walk-inOptional (+$345)
WindowsOptional
Windup to 180 mph
Snowup to 65 psf
RoofVertical 3:12
Frame14 ga (12 ga upgrade)
Sheeting29 ga (26 ga upgrade)
AnchoringConcrete · Asphalt · Ground
Lead time3 – 5 weeks
USE CASE EXAMPLES
How real buyers use Sports & Recreation Facility.
DAILY USE
Everyday sports & recreation facility
20,000 sq ft is the right size for daily use of a sports & recreation facility.
STORAGE OVERFLOW
sports & recreation facility + seasonal storage
Park or store equipment in the front half, leave the rear for seasonal storage and overflow.
FLEX ROOM
Expansion-ready
Stud-framed interior makes it easy to add a partition, electrical, or insulation later.
FULL PRODUCT DETAILS
100×200 Sports & Recreation Facility, what makes it different.
20,000sq ft
Floor Space
180mph
Wind Rated
65psf
Snow Load
20yr
Rust Warranty
40yr
Paint Warranty
$6250/mo
From RTO
🏗️
Engineered for your county
Every 100×200 sports & recreation facility is fabricated from American-rolled galvanized steel and engineered against the exact wind and snow loads your jurisdiction requires.
Standard: 140 mph wind / 35 psf snow
12-ga upgrade: 180 mph / 65 psf
Permit drawings stamped and emailed free
🔩
Construction details
The same materials commercial fabricators use, not residential-grade. Hot-dip galvanized fasteners, factory-baked siliconized polyester paint, Hilti-grade anchors.
Frame: 14-ga (12-ga upgrade) galvanized tubing
Panels: 29-ga G-90 (26-ga upgrade)
Fasteners: #14 self-drilling with EPDM washer
🚚
Free delivery & install, really free
Regional-route delivery plus 1–2 day on-site installation by a certified crew, bundled into your headline price. No hidden unloading fees, fuel surcharges, or site-prep charges.
$0 deposit · pay only after walkthrough sign-off
3–5 week lead time on regional routes
All 48 states · rush option available
🛡️
Warranty & lifespan
Engineered for a 50-year service life with industry-leading warranties on every wear surface.
20-yr rust-through warranty on frame & panels
40-yr paint warranty against fading + chalking
1-yr craftsmanship on installation
💳
$0-down financing
Three financing paths to fit any credit situation. The rent-to-own option requires no credit pull at all, fastest path to a closed deal.
RTO: $6250/mo, no credit check, 36–60 mo
Financing: 0% promo APR · 84 mo term
Cash discount: 4% on $10K+ orders
⚡
Why 100×200?
20,000 sq ft sits in the sweet spot for residential and light-commercial, fits standard quarter-acre setbacks, comfortably below the 1,000 sq ft municipal threshold that triggers extra inspections.
100′ × 200′ footprint with 20,000 sq ft interior
Permit-friendly in 96% of US counties
Resale ROI $160,000–$240,000 added home value
PEOPLE ALSO ASK
Common questions from Sports & Recreation Facility shoppers.
The questions our team hears every week. Click any to expand the short answer.
How thick is the steel on a Steel and Stud 100×200 metal building?
Standard frame: 14-gauge (1.5 mm) galvanized tubing. Optional 12-gauge upgrade (2.5 mm) for high-wind/snow zones. Roof and wall sheeting ships 29-gauge standard, 26-gauge upgrade available on order.
Does Steel and Stud deliver and install in my state?
Yes, free delivery and free installation in all 48 continental states, performed by certified Steel and Stud crews. Hawaii and Alaska use custom freight quotes; call 1-877-275-7048 for either.
What’s the typical lead time for a 100×200 building?
Standard: 3–5 weeks from order confirmation to install completion. Fabrication runs the first 2–3 weeks at our US plant; regional delivery and 1-2 day install close it out. Rush builds available for $345.
Can I finance a Steel and Stud building without a credit check?
Yes, Steel and Stud’s rent-to-own partner does not pull credit. Approvals typically run 8 minutes with proof of income and first month’s payment. 36–60 month terms, no early-payoff penalty.
What’s covered under the 20-year warranty?
Steel and Stud’s 20-year rust-through warranty covers the galvanized frame against perforation, plus a 20-year paint-finish warranty against fade and chalk. Workmanship on the install is warrantied for 1 year. Warranty transfers to the next owner on resale.
CUSTOMER REVIEWS
What real 100×200 Sports & Recreation Facility buyers say.
⭐
No reviews yet for the 100×200 Sports & Recreation Facility
Be the first verified buyer to share your experience. Honest reviews help other steel-building shoppers make a confident decision.
How much does a 100×200 sports & recreation facility cost?
A 100×200 sports & recreation facility from Steel and Stud starts at $300,000 with free delivery and free installation across all 48 states. Most buyers pick the rent-to-own option at about $6250/month with $0 down and no credit check. Call 1-877-275-7048 for a same-day price lock.
Is delivery and installation included in the 100×200 sports & recreation facility price?
Yes, every Steel and Stud sports & recreation facility ships with free delivery + free installation by a certified crew, included in the listed price. Anchored to a concrete pad, asphalt, or compacted gravel, your building is fully erected in 1–2 days after the truck arrives.
Do I need a permit for a 100×200 sports & recreation facility?
Almost always for 20,000+ sq ft enclosed buildings. Steel and Stud emails engineered drawings stamped for your wind zone (up to 180 mph) and snow zone (up to 65 psf) at no charge, so your local building department has everything it needs. Permit timing typically runs 2–6 weeks by jurisdiction.
How is a Steel and Stud sports & recreation facility different from a wood-frame build?
Steel solves the problems wood creates, no rotting, no termites, no warping, no painting every 3 years. Our 14-gauge galvanized frame carries a 20-year rust warranty and ships with a 180 mph wind / 65 psf snow rating already engineered in. A comparable wood build typically costs 2–3× more and needs ongoing maintenance.
What foundation does a 100×200 sports & recreation facility need?
A 4-inch concrete pad poured 1 foot wider and longer than the building is the standard. Steel and Stud also anchors to asphalt or compacted gravel for open or semi-enclosed configurations. A pad-pour bundle is offered at checkout if you don’t already have a slab.
How fast can I get a 100×200 sports & recreation facility delivered?
Standard lead time is 3–5 weeks from order to install. Fabrication runs the first 2–3 weeks at our US plant; regional delivery + 1–2-day install by a certified Steel and Stud crew closes out the order. Rush builds are available, call 1-877-275-7048 for current capacity.
Can I finance a 100×200 sports & recreation facility without a credit check?
Yes, Steel and Stud’s rent-to-own partner does not pull credit. Approvals close in about 8 minutes with proof of income and your first month’s payment. Terms run 36–60 months with no early-payoff penalty, and the monthly works out to roughly $6250/month on a 100×200 sports & recreation facility.
What warranty comes with the 100×200 sports & recreation facility?
Steel and Stud backs every building with a 20-year rust-through warranty on the galvanized frame and a 10-year sheeting warranty on the 29-gauge panels (upgradeable to 26-gauge or 12-gauge). Workmanship on the install is warrantied for 1 year. Full warranty terms ship with your order packet.
Can I customize the 100×200 sports & recreation facility in 3D before I order?
Yes, our free Sensei3D Designer lets you drag and drop doors, windows, and walk-ins; swap 16 roof + trim colors live; and rotate the building in 3D from every angle. No login required. The design saves directly to a quote so what you build is exactly what we price.
Will the 100×200 sports & recreation facility pass community-use and assembly inspections?
Yes. Steel and Stud’s engineered drawings include load calculations, accessibility paths, and egress widths required by most jurisdictions for assembly and institutional use. Stamped, sealed PE drawings are included free with every order.
Ready to build?
Your Sports & Recreation Facility quote takes one minute.
Tell us your zip and the options you want. We’ll send back a same-day, all-in price.
20,000 sq ft for industrial warehouse, hangar, or distribution facility
100′ x 200′14 GaugeLocal Certification Available
Pre-engineered 100×200 steel building delivers 20,000 sq ft of column-free space. Galvanized 14-gauge tubular frame, vertical roof, and certified wind and snow load ratings. Customize doors, windows, colors, eave height, and certifications in our free 3D builder.
Leg height adjustable up to 20'
$300,000.00
Free Delivery & Install RTO from /mo — No credit check
20,000 sq ft for industrial warehouse, hangar, or distribution facility
100′ x 200′14 GaugeLocal Certification Available
Pre-engineered 100×200 steel building delivers 20,000 sq ft of column-free space. Galvanized 14-gauge tubular frame, vertical roof, and certified wind and snow load ratings. Customize doors, windows, colors, eave height, and certifications in our free 3D builder.
100×200 Livestock & Dairy Building | Steel and Stud, From $298,700
100×200 Livestock & Dairy Building, built for farm and ranch demands.
100×200 delivers 20000 sq ft of rugged livestock & dairy building space. Dairy operators and feedlot managers use 100×200 to house 80-120 head with feed alley, milking parlor, and a maternity pen under one roof. Open.
Starting from your selected configuration$298,700$340,500Save $41,800
or as low as $6223/mo · 0% APR · No credit RTO
ℹ️This is an estimate. Final pricing is locked after our sales team reviews your complete requirements (site access, ground type, county-specific certifications, optional upgrades). You’ll receive a written all-in quote within one business day of your request, no surprises, no hidden fees.
FREE delivery & installation in all 48 states. Concrete, asphalt, or compacted gravel.
SKU:SS-100X200-LIVESTOCK-DAIRY-Built:1,847+Since: 2002Made in: 🇺🇸 USA
🛡️
A+
BBB Accredited
★
4.8/5
customer rating
⏱
Since 2004
In Business
🏠
15,000+
Buildings
🇺🇸
48
States Served
We’ve provided builds for
SPATIAL LAYOUT
See how 800 sq ft fits your livestock-barn layout.
100 feet wide × 200 feet long. 100×200 delivers 20000 sq ft of rugged livestock & dairy building space.
Livestock area · Center alley · Feed / Storage
Livestock area at the front, center alley in the middle, feed / storage at the rear. Dairy operators and feedlot managers use 100×200 to house 80-120 head with feed alley, milking parlor, and a maternity pen under one roof.
💡 Pro tip:Livestock-Ready Vent.
🎨 FREE 3D BUILDER
Build your 100×200 Livestock & Dairy Building in 3D.
Design your building yourself in our free Sensei3D Designer, drag doors and windows where you want them, swap roof + trim colors, and see your spec from every angle. Save your design and email it to yourself for later.
Drag-and-drop doors, windows, walk-ins anywhere on the building
16 colors applied live to roof, walls, and trim, mix & match
Interior + exterior views of your spec, with measurements
Save your design and share it with your contractor or family
Auto-syncs to quote, what you build is what we price
All variants ship with free delivery, installation, drawings, 20-year warranty.
🏗️
20,000 sq ft enclosed
Fully-enclosed 100×200 vertical-roof structure.
🚪
Roll-up + walk-in doors
Standard configuration door package.
🔩
14-gauge steel frame
American-rolled galvanized tubing.
🎨
1 standard color
Pick from 16 factory-baked finishes.
TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS
Livestock & Dairy Building spec sheet.
Width100′
Length200′ + 6" overhang
Side height9′ standard
Floor space20,000 sq ft
Doors1 × 9×8 roll-up
Walk-inOptional (+$345)
WindowsOptional
Windup to 180 mph
Snowup to 65 psf
RoofVertical 3:12
Frame14 ga (12 ga upgrade)
Sheeting29 ga (26 ga upgrade)
AnchoringConcrete · Asphalt · Ground
Lead time3 – 5 weeks
USE CASE EXAMPLES
How real buyers use Livestock & Dairy Building.
DAILY USE
Everyday livestock & dairy building
20,000 sq ft is the right size for daily use of a livestock & dairy building.
STORAGE OVERFLOW
livestock & dairy building + seasonal storage
Park or store equipment in the front half, leave the rear for seasonal storage and overflow.
FLEX ROOM
Expansion-ready
Stud-framed interior makes it easy to add a partition, electrical, or insulation later.
FULL PRODUCT DETAILS
100×200 Livestock & Dairy Building, what makes it different.
20,000sq ft
Floor Space
180mph
Wind Rated
65psf
Snow Load
20yr
Rust Warranty
40yr
Paint Warranty
$6223/mo
From RTO
🏗️
Engineered for your county
Every 100×200 livestock & dairy building is fabricated from American-rolled galvanized steel and engineered against the exact wind and snow loads your jurisdiction requires.
Standard: 140 mph wind / 35 psf snow
12-ga upgrade: 180 mph / 65 psf
Permit drawings stamped and emailed free
🔩
Construction details
The same materials commercial fabricators use, not residential-grade. Hot-dip galvanized fasteners, factory-baked siliconized polyester paint, Hilti-grade anchors.
Frame: 14-ga (12-ga upgrade) galvanized tubing
Panels: 29-ga G-90 (26-ga upgrade)
Fasteners: #14 self-drilling with EPDM washer
🚚
Free delivery & install, really free
Regional-route delivery plus 1–2 day on-site installation by a certified crew, bundled into your headline price. No hidden unloading fees, fuel surcharges, or site-prep charges.
$0 deposit · pay only after walkthrough sign-off
3–5 week lead time on regional routes
All 48 states · rush option available
🛡️
Warranty & lifespan
Engineered for a 50-year service life with industry-leading warranties on every wear surface.
20-yr rust-through warranty on frame & panels
40-yr paint warranty against fading + chalking
1-yr craftsmanship on installation
💳
$0-down financing
Three financing paths to fit any credit situation. The rent-to-own option requires no credit pull at all, fastest path to a closed deal.
RTO: $6223/mo, no credit check, 36–60 mo
Financing: 0% promo APR · 84 mo term
Cash discount: 4% on $10K+ orders
⚡
Why 100×200?
20,000 sq ft sits in the sweet spot for residential and light-commercial, fits standard quarter-acre setbacks, comfortably below the 1,000 sq ft municipal threshold that triggers extra inspections.
100′ × 200′ footprint with 20,000 sq ft interior
Permit-friendly in 96% of US counties
Resale ROI $160,000–$240,000 added home value
PEOPLE ALSO ASK
Common questions from Livestock & Dairy Building shoppers.
The questions our team hears every week. Click any to expand the short answer.
How thick is the steel on a Steel and Stud 100×200 metal building?
Standard frame: 14-gauge (1.5 mm) galvanized tubing. Optional 12-gauge upgrade (2.5 mm) for high-wind/snow zones. Roof and wall sheeting ships 29-gauge standard, 26-gauge upgrade available on order.
Does Steel and Stud deliver and install in my state?
Yes, free delivery and free installation in all 48 continental states, performed by certified Steel and Stud crews. Hawaii and Alaska use custom freight quotes; call 1-877-275-7048 for either.
What’s the typical lead time for a 100×200 building?
Standard: 3–5 weeks from order confirmation to install completion. Fabrication runs the first 2–3 weeks at our US plant; regional delivery and 1-2 day install close it out. Rush builds available for $345.
Can I finance a Steel and Stud building without a credit check?
Yes, Steel and Stud’s rent-to-own partner does not pull credit. Approvals typically run 8 minutes with proof of income and first month’s payment. 36–60 month terms, no early-payoff penalty.
What’s covered under the 20-year warranty?
Steel and Stud’s 20-year rust-through warranty covers the galvanized frame against perforation, plus a 20-year paint-finish warranty against fade and chalk. Workmanship on the install is warrantied for 1 year. Warranty transfers to the next owner on resale.
CUSTOMER REVIEWS
What real 100×200 Livestock & Dairy Building buyers say.
⭐
No reviews yet for the 100×200 Livestock & Dairy Building
Be the first verified buyer to share your experience. Honest reviews help other steel-building shoppers make a confident decision.
How much does a 100×200 livestock & dairy building cost?
A 100×200 livestock & dairy building from Steel and Stud starts at $298,700 with free delivery and free installation across all 48 states. Most buyers pick the rent-to-own option at about $6223/month with $0 down and no credit check. Call 1-877-275-7048 for a same-day price lock.
Is delivery and installation included in the 100×200 livestock & dairy building price?
Yes, every Steel and Stud livestock & dairy building ships with free delivery + free installation by a certified crew, included in the listed price. Anchored to a concrete pad, asphalt, or compacted gravel, your building is fully erected in 1–2 days after the truck arrives.
Do I need a permit for a 100×200 livestock & dairy building?
Almost always for 20,000+ sq ft enclosed buildings. Steel and Stud emails engineered drawings stamped for your wind zone (up to 180 mph) and snow zone (up to 65 psf) at no charge, so your local building department has everything it needs. Permit timing typically runs 2–6 weeks by jurisdiction.
How is a Steel and Stud livestock & dairy building different from a wood-frame build?
Steel solves the problems wood creates, no rotting, no termites, no warping, no painting every 3 years. Our 14-gauge galvanized frame carries a 20-year rust warranty and ships with a 180 mph wind / 65 psf snow rating already engineered in. A comparable wood build typically costs 2–3× more and needs ongoing maintenance.
What foundation does a 100×200 livestock & dairy building need?
A 4-inch concrete pad poured 1 foot wider and longer than the building is the standard. Steel and Stud also anchors to asphalt or compacted gravel for open or semi-enclosed configurations. A pad-pour bundle is offered at checkout if you don’t already have a slab.
How fast can I get a 100×200 livestock & dairy building delivered?
Standard lead time is 3–5 weeks from order to install. Fabrication runs the first 2–3 weeks at our US plant; regional delivery + 1–2-day install by a certified Steel and Stud crew closes out the order. Rush builds are available, call 1-877-275-7048 for current capacity.
Can I finance a 100×200 livestock & dairy building without a credit check?
Yes, Steel and Stud’s rent-to-own partner does not pull credit. Approvals close in about 8 minutes with proof of income and your first month’s payment. Terms run 36–60 months with no early-payoff penalty, and the monthly works out to roughly $6223/month on a 100×200 livestock & dairy building.
What warranty comes with the 100×200 livestock & dairy building?
Steel and Stud backs every building with a 20-year rust-through warranty on the galvanized frame and a 10-year sheeting warranty on the 29-gauge panels (upgradeable to 26-gauge or 12-gauge). Workmanship on the install is warrantied for 1 year. Full warranty terms ship with your order packet.
Can I customize the 100×200 livestock & dairy building in 3D before I order?
Yes, our free Sensei3D Designer lets you drag and drop doors, windows, and walk-ins; swap 16 roof + trim colors live; and rotate the building in 3D from every angle. No login required. The design saves directly to a quote so what you build is exactly what we price.
Will the 100×200 livestock & dairy building stand up to livestock and Midwest weather?
The 14-gauge galvanized frame is the same spec Steel and Stud uses for commercial barns, rated to 65 psf snow and 180 mph wind. Ventilation packages (ridge vent + soffit) ship standard on agricultural orders to prevent moisture buildup that would warp a wood barn.
Ready to build?
Your Livestock & Dairy Building quote takes one minute.
Tell us your zip and the options you want. We’ll send back a same-day, all-in price.
20,000 sq ft for industrial warehouse, hangar, or distribution facility
100′ x 200′14 GaugeLocal Certification Available
Pre-engineered 100×200 steel building delivers 20,000 sq ft of column-free space. Galvanized 14-gauge tubular frame, vertical roof, and certified wind and snow load ratings. Customize doors, windows, colors, eave height, and certifications in our free 3D builder.
Leg height adjustable up to 20'
$298,700.00
Free Delivery & Install RTO from /mo — No credit check
20,000 sq ft for industrial warehouse, hangar, or distribution facility
100′ x 200′14 GaugeLocal Certification Available
Pre-engineered 100×200 steel building delivers 20,000 sq ft of column-free space. Galvanized 14-gauge tubular frame, vertical roof, and certified wind and snow load ratings. Customize doors, windows, colors, eave height, and certifications in our free 3D builder.
100×200 Self-Storage Facility | Steel and Stud, From $299,900
100×200 Self-Storage Facility, engineered for code-compliant business use.
100×200 delivers 20000 sq ft of code-compliant self-storage facility space. Self-storage developers carve this footprint into 60-80 climate-controlled units with a central drive aisle. Pre-framed openings on 10-foot.
Starting from your selected configuration$299,900$341,900Save $42,000
or as low as $6248/mo · 0% APR · No credit RTO
ℹ️This is an estimate. Final pricing is locked after our sales team reviews your complete requirements (site access, ground type, county-specific certifications, optional upgrades). You’ll receive a written all-in quote within one business day of your request, no surprises, no hidden fees.
FREE delivery & installation in all 48 states. Concrete, asphalt, or compacted gravel.
SKU:SS-100X200-SELF-STORAGE-FACBuilt:1,847+Since: 2002Made in: 🇺🇸 USA
🛡️
A+
BBB Accredited
★
4.8/5
customer rating
⏱
Since 2004
In Business
🏠
15,000+
Buildings
🇺🇸
48
States Served
We’ve provided builds for
SPATIAL LAYOUT
See how 800 sq ft fits your self-storage layout.
100 feet wide × 200 feet long. 100×200 delivers 20000 sq ft of code-compliant self-storage facility space.
Unit row A · Unit row B · Hallway / Office
Unit row A at the front, unit row b in the middle, hallway / office at the rear. Self-storage developers carve this footprint into 60-80 climate-controlled units with a central drive aisle.
💡 Pro tip:60-80 Unit Capacity.
🎨 FREE 3D BUILDER
Build your 100×200 Self-Storage Facility in 3D.
Design your building yourself in our free Sensei3D Designer, drag doors and windows where you want them, swap roof + trim colors, and see your spec from every angle. Save your design and email it to yourself for later.
Drag-and-drop doors, windows, walk-ins anywhere on the building
16 colors applied live to roof, walls, and trim, mix & match
Interior + exterior views of your spec, with measurements
Save your design and share it with your contractor or family
Auto-syncs to quote, what you build is what we price
All variants ship with free delivery, installation, drawings, 20-year warranty.
🏗️
20,000 sq ft enclosed
Fully-enclosed 100×200 vertical-roof structure.
🚪
Roll-up + walk-in doors
Standard configuration door package.
🔩
14-gauge steel frame
American-rolled galvanized tubing.
🎨
1 standard color
Pick from 16 factory-baked finishes.
TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS
Self-Storage Facility spec sheet.
Width100′
Length200′ + 6" overhang
Side height9′ standard
Floor space20,000 sq ft
Doors1 × 9×8 roll-up
Walk-inOptional (+$345)
WindowsOptional
Windup to 180 mph
Snowup to 65 psf
RoofVertical 3:12
Frame14 ga (12 ga upgrade)
Sheeting29 ga (26 ga upgrade)
AnchoringConcrete · Asphalt · Ground
Lead time3 – 5 weeks
USE CASE EXAMPLES
How real buyers use Self-Storage Facility.
DAILY USE
Everyday self-storage facility
20,000 sq ft is the right size for daily use of a self-storage facility.
STORAGE OVERFLOW
self-storage facility + seasonal storage
Park or store equipment in the front half, leave the rear for seasonal storage and overflow.
FLEX ROOM
Expansion-ready
Stud-framed interior makes it easy to add a partition, electrical, or insulation later.
FULL PRODUCT DETAILS
100×200 Self-Storage Facility, what makes it different.
20,000sq ft
Floor Space
180mph
Wind Rated
65psf
Snow Load
20yr
Rust Warranty
40yr
Paint Warranty
$6248/mo
From RTO
🏗️
Engineered for your county
Every 100×200 self-storage facility is fabricated from American-rolled galvanized steel and engineered against the exact wind and snow loads your jurisdiction requires.
Standard: 140 mph wind / 35 psf snow
12-ga upgrade: 180 mph / 65 psf
Permit drawings stamped and emailed free
🔩
Construction details
The same materials commercial fabricators use, not residential-grade. Hot-dip galvanized fasteners, factory-baked siliconized polyester paint, Hilti-grade anchors.
Frame: 14-ga (12-ga upgrade) galvanized tubing
Panels: 29-ga G-90 (26-ga upgrade)
Fasteners: #14 self-drilling with EPDM washer
🚚
Free delivery & install, really free
Regional-route delivery plus 1–2 day on-site installation by a certified crew, bundled into your headline price. No hidden unloading fees, fuel surcharges, or site-prep charges.
$0 deposit · pay only after walkthrough sign-off
3–5 week lead time on regional routes
All 48 states · rush option available
🛡️
Warranty & lifespan
Engineered for a 50-year service life with industry-leading warranties on every wear surface.
20-yr rust-through warranty on frame & panels
40-yr paint warranty against fading + chalking
1-yr craftsmanship on installation
💳
$0-down financing
Three financing paths to fit any credit situation. The rent-to-own option requires no credit pull at all, fastest path to a closed deal.
RTO: $6248/mo, no credit check, 36–60 mo
Financing: 0% promo APR · 84 mo term
Cash discount: 4% on $10K+ orders
⚡
Why 100×200?
20,000 sq ft sits in the sweet spot for residential and light-commercial, fits standard quarter-acre setbacks, comfortably below the 1,000 sq ft municipal threshold that triggers extra inspections.
100′ × 200′ footprint with 20,000 sq ft interior
Permit-friendly in 96% of US counties
Resale ROI $160,000–$240,000 added home value
PEOPLE ALSO ASK
Common questions from Self-Storage Facility shoppers.
The questions our team hears every week. Click any to expand the short answer.
How thick is the steel on a Steel and Stud 100×200 metal building?
Standard frame: 14-gauge (1.5 mm) galvanized tubing. Optional 12-gauge upgrade (2.5 mm) for high-wind/snow zones. Roof and wall sheeting ships 29-gauge standard, 26-gauge upgrade available on order.
Does Steel and Stud deliver and install in my state?
Yes, free delivery and free installation in all 48 continental states, performed by certified Steel and Stud crews. Hawaii and Alaska use custom freight quotes; call 1-877-275-7048 for either.
What’s the typical lead time for a 100×200 building?
Standard: 3–5 weeks from order confirmation to install completion. Fabrication runs the first 2–3 weeks at our US plant; regional delivery and 1-2 day install close it out. Rush builds available for $345.
Can I finance a Steel and Stud building without a credit check?
Yes, Steel and Stud’s rent-to-own partner does not pull credit. Approvals typically run 8 minutes with proof of income and first month’s payment. 36–60 month terms, no early-payoff penalty.
What’s covered under the 20-year warranty?
Steel and Stud’s 20-year rust-through warranty covers the galvanized frame against perforation, plus a 20-year paint-finish warranty against fade and chalk. Workmanship on the install is warrantied for 1 year. Warranty transfers to the next owner on resale.
CUSTOMER REVIEWS
What real 100×200 Self-Storage Facility buyers say.
⭐
No reviews yet for the 100×200 Self-Storage Facility
Be the first verified buyer to share your experience. Honest reviews help other steel-building shoppers make a confident decision.
How much does a 100×200 self-storage facility cost?
A 100×200 self-storage facility from Steel and Stud starts at $299,900 with free delivery and free installation across all 48 states. Most buyers pick the rent-to-own option at about $6248/month with $0 down and no credit check. Call 1-877-275-7048 for a same-day price lock.
Is delivery and installation included in the 100×200 self-storage facility price?
Yes, every Steel and Stud self-storage facility ships with free delivery + free installation by a certified crew, included in the listed price. Anchored to a concrete pad, asphalt, or compacted gravel, your building is fully erected in 1–2 days after the truck arrives.
Do I need a permit for a 100×200 self-storage facility?
Almost always for 20,000+ sq ft enclosed buildings. Steel and Stud emails engineered drawings stamped for your wind zone (up to 180 mph) and snow zone (up to 65 psf) at no charge, so your local building department has everything it needs. Permit timing typically runs 2–6 weeks by jurisdiction.
How is a Steel and Stud self-storage facility different from a wood-frame build?
Steel solves the problems wood creates, no rotting, no termites, no warping, no painting every 3 years. Our 14-gauge galvanized frame carries a 20-year rust warranty and ships with a 180 mph wind / 65 psf snow rating already engineered in. A comparable wood build typically costs 2–3× more and needs ongoing maintenance.
What foundation does a 100×200 self-storage facility need?
A 4-inch concrete pad poured 1 foot wider and longer than the building is the standard. Steel and Stud also anchors to asphalt or compacted gravel for open or semi-enclosed configurations. A pad-pour bundle is offered at checkout if you don’t already have a slab.
How fast can I get a 100×200 self-storage facility delivered?
Standard lead time is 3–5 weeks from order to install. Fabrication runs the first 2–3 weeks at our US plant; regional delivery + 1–2-day install by a certified Steel and Stud crew closes out the order. Rush builds are available, call 1-877-275-7048 for current capacity.
Can I finance a 100×200 self-storage facility without a credit check?
Yes, Steel and Stud’s rent-to-own partner does not pull credit. Approvals close in about 8 minutes with proof of income and your first month’s payment. Terms run 36–60 months with no early-payoff penalty, and the monthly works out to roughly $6248/month on a 100×200 self-storage facility.
What warranty comes with the 100×200 self-storage facility?
Steel and Stud backs every building with a 20-year rust-through warranty on the galvanized frame and a 10-year sheeting warranty on the 29-gauge panels (upgradeable to 26-gauge or 12-gauge). Workmanship on the install is warrantied for 1 year. Full warranty terms ship with your order packet.
Can I customize the 100×200 self-storage facility in 3D before I order?
Yes, our free Sensei3D Designer lets you drag and drop doors, windows, and walk-ins; swap 16 roof + trim colors live; and rotate the building in 3D from every angle. No login required. The design saves directly to a quote so what you build is exactly what we price.
Does the 100×200 self-storage facility meet IBC commercial code?
Yes. Steel and Stud’s 12-gauge frame upgrade and 26-gauge sheeting both meet IBC commercial standards, and most counties accept our stamped drawings without revision. Engineered loads ship with the order, typical certified specs are 180 mph wind / 65 psf snow.
Ready to build?
Your Self-Storage Facility quote takes one minute.
Tell us your zip and the options you want. We’ll send back a same-day, all-in price.
20,000 sq ft for industrial warehouse, hangar, or distribution facility
100′ x 200′14 GaugeLocal Certification Available
Pre-engineered 100×200 steel building delivers 20,000 sq ft of column-free space. Galvanized 14-gauge tubular frame, vertical roof, and certified wind and snow load ratings. Customize doors, windows, colors, eave height, and certifications in our free 3D builder.
Leg height adjustable up to 20'
$299,900.00
Free Delivery & Install RTO from /mo — No credit check
6,000 sq ft for commercial warehouse, hay barn, or fabrication shop
100′ x 60′14 GaugeLocal Certification Available
Pre-engineered 100×60 steel building delivers 6,000 sq ft of column-free space. Galvanized 14-gauge tubular frame, vertical roof, and certified wind and snow load ratings. Customize doors, windows, colors, eave height, and certifications in our free 3D builder.
100×60 Commercial Warehouse | Steel and Stud, From $111,650
100×60 Commercial Warehouse, engineered for code-compliant business use.
Our 100×60 commercial warehouse fits 100-foot widths and 60-foot lengths to give you a code-passing shell delivered in 4–6 weeks. Looking for a 100×60 commercial warehouse? At 6000 sq ft, this footprint suits small.
Starting from your selected configuration$111,650$127,300Save $15,650
or as low as $2326/mo · 0% APR · No credit RTO
ℹ️This is an estimate. Final pricing is locked after our sales team reviews your complete requirements (site access, ground type, county-specific certifications, optional upgrades). You’ll receive a written all-in quote within one business day of your request, no surprises, no hidden fees.
FREE delivery & installation in all 48 states. Concrete, asphalt, or compacted gravel.
SKU:SS-100X60-COMMERCIAL-WAREHBuilt:1,847+Since: 2002Made in: 🇺🇸 USA
🛡️
A+
BBB Accredited
★
4.8/5
customer rating
⏱
Since 2004
In Business
🏠
15,000+
Buildings
🇺🇸
48
States Served
We’ve provided builds for
SPATIAL LAYOUT
See how 800 sq ft fits your distribution facility.
100 feet wide × 60 feet long. Column-free clear span; 18-ft+ height for 5-tier racking. Our 100×60 commercial warehouse fits 100-foot widths and 60-foot lengths to give you a code-passing shell delivered in 4–6 weeks.
Multi-dock loading bays at the front, high-bay racking aisles in the middle, office mezzanine + break + restrooms at the rear. Capacity: ~120 pallet positions, full forklift ops. Looking for a 100×60 commercial warehouse? At 6000 sq ft, this footprint suits small businesses, retail, or service shops.
💡 Pro tip:Certified to 140 MPH. Size affords: multiple dock doors, mezzanine office, in-rack sprinklers.
🎨 FREE 3D BUILDER
Build your 100×60 Commercial Warehouse in 3D.
Design your building yourself in our free Sensei3D Designer, drag doors and windows where you want them, swap roof + trim colors, and see your spec from every angle. Save your design and email it to yourself for later.
Drag-and-drop doors, windows, walk-ins anywhere on the building
16 colors applied live to roof, walls, and trim, mix & match
Interior + exterior views of your spec, with measurements
Save your design and share it with your contractor or family
Auto-syncs to quote, what you build is what we price
All variants ship with free delivery, installation, drawings, 20-year warranty.
🏗️
6,000 sq ft enclosed
Fully-enclosed 100×60 vertical-roof structure.
🚪
Roll-up + walk-in doors
Standard configuration door package.
🔩
14-gauge steel frame
American-rolled galvanized tubing.
🎨
1 standard color
Pick from 16 factory-baked finishes.
TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS
Commercial Warehouse spec sheet.
Width100′
Length60′ + 6" overhang
Side height9′ standard
Floor space6,000 sq ft
Doors1 × 9×8 roll-up
Walk-inOptional (+$345)
WindowsOptional
Windup to 180 mph
Snowup to 65 psf
RoofVertical 3:12
Frame14 ga (12 ga upgrade)
Sheeting29 ga (26 ga upgrade)
AnchoringConcrete · Asphalt · Ground
Lead time3 – 5 weeks
USE CASE EXAMPLES
How real buyers use Commercial Warehouse.
DAILY USE
Everyday commercial warehouse
6,000 sq ft is the right size for daily use of a commercial warehouse.
STORAGE OVERFLOW
commercial warehouse + seasonal storage
Park or store equipment in the front half, leave the rear for seasonal storage and overflow.
FLEX ROOM
Expansion-ready
Stud-framed interior makes it easy to add a partition, electrical, or insulation later.
FULL PRODUCT DETAILS
100×60 Commercial Warehouse, what makes it different.
6,000sq ft
Floor Space
180mph
Wind Rated
65psf
Snow Load
20yr
Rust Warranty
40yr
Paint Warranty
$2326/mo
From RTO
🏗️
Engineered for your county
Every 100×60 commercial warehouse is fabricated from American-rolled galvanized steel and engineered against the exact wind and snow loads your jurisdiction requires.
Standard: 140 mph wind / 35 psf snow
12-ga upgrade: 180 mph / 65 psf
Permit drawings stamped and emailed free
🔩
Construction details
The same materials commercial fabricators use, not residential-grade. Hot-dip galvanized fasteners, factory-baked siliconized polyester paint, Hilti-grade anchors.
Frame: 14-ga (12-ga upgrade) galvanized tubing
Panels: 29-ga G-90 (26-ga upgrade)
Fasteners: #14 self-drilling with EPDM washer
🚚
Free delivery & install, really free
Regional-route delivery plus 1–2 day on-site installation by a certified crew, bundled into your headline price. No hidden unloading fees, fuel surcharges, or site-prep charges.
$0 deposit · pay only after walkthrough sign-off
3–5 week lead time on regional routes
All 48 states · rush option available
🛡️
Warranty & lifespan
Engineered for a 50-year service life with industry-leading warranties on every wear surface.
20-yr rust-through warranty on frame & panels
40-yr paint warranty against fading + chalking
1-yr craftsmanship on installation
💳
$0-down financing
Three financing paths to fit any credit situation. The rent-to-own option requires no credit pull at all, fastest path to a closed deal.
RTO: $2326/mo, no credit check, 36–60 mo
Financing: 0% promo APR · 84 mo term
Cash discount: 4% on $10K+ orders
⚡
Why 100×60?
6,000 sq ft sits in the sweet spot for residential and light-commercial, fits standard quarter-acre setbacks, comfortably below the 1,000 sq ft municipal threshold that triggers extra inspections.
100′ × 60′ footprint with 6,000 sq ft interior
Permit-friendly in 96% of US counties
Resale ROI $48,000–$72,000 added home value
PEOPLE ALSO ASK
Common questions from Commercial Warehouse shoppers.
The questions our team hears every week. Click any to expand the short answer.
How thick is the steel on a Steel and Stud 100×60 metal building?
Standard frame: 14-gauge (1.5 mm) galvanized tubing. Optional 12-gauge upgrade (2.5 mm) for high-wind/snow zones. Roof and wall sheeting ships 29-gauge standard, 26-gauge upgrade available on order.
Does Steel and Stud deliver and install in my state?
Yes, free delivery and free installation in all 48 continental states, performed by certified Steel and Stud crews. Hawaii and Alaska use custom freight quotes; call 1-877-275-7048 for either.
What’s the typical lead time for a 100×60 building?
Standard: 3–5 weeks from order confirmation to install completion. Fabrication runs the first 2–3 weeks at our US plant; regional delivery and 1-2 day install close it out. Rush builds available for $345.
Can I finance a Steel and Stud building without a credit check?
Yes, Steel and Stud’s rent-to-own partner does not pull credit. Approvals typically run 8 minutes with proof of income and first month’s payment. 36–60 month terms, no early-payoff penalty.
What’s covered under the 20-year warranty?
Steel and Stud’s 20-year rust-through warranty covers the galvanized frame against perforation, plus a 20-year paint-finish warranty against fade and chalk. Workmanship on the install is warrantied for 1 year. Warranty transfers to the next owner on resale.
CUSTOMER REVIEWS
What real 100×60 Commercial Warehouse buyers say.
⭐
No reviews yet for the 100×60 Commercial Warehouse
Be the first verified buyer to share your experience. Honest reviews help other steel-building shoppers make a confident decision.
A 100×60 commercial warehouse from Steel and Stud starts at $111,650 with free delivery and free installation across all 48 states. Most buyers pick the rent-to-own option at about $2326/month with $0 down and no credit check. Call 1-877-275-7048 for a same-day price lock.
Is delivery and installation included in the 100×60 commercial warehouse price?
Yes, every Steel and Stud commercial warehouse ships with free delivery + free installation by a certified crew, included in the listed price. Anchored to a concrete pad, asphalt, or compacted gravel, your building is fully erected in 1–2 days after the truck arrives.
Do I need a permit for a 100×60 commercial warehouse?
Almost always for 6,000+ sq ft enclosed buildings. Steel and Stud emails engineered drawings stamped for your wind zone (up to 180 mph) and snow zone (up to 65 psf) at no charge, so your local building department has everything it needs. Permit timing typically runs 2–6 weeks by jurisdiction.
How is a Steel and Stud commercial warehouse different from a wood-frame build?
Steel solves the problems wood creates, no rotting, no termites, no warping, no painting every 3 years. Our 14-gauge galvanized frame carries a 20-year rust warranty and ships with a 180 mph wind / 65 psf snow rating already engineered in. A comparable wood build typically costs 2–3× more and needs ongoing maintenance.
What foundation does a 100×60 commercial warehouse need?
A 4-inch concrete pad poured 1 foot wider and longer than the building is the standard. Steel and Stud also anchors to asphalt or compacted gravel for open or semi-enclosed configurations. A pad-pour bundle is offered at checkout if you don’t already have a slab.
How fast can I get a 100×60 commercial warehouse delivered?
Standard lead time is 3–5 weeks from order to install. Fabrication runs the first 2–3 weeks at our US plant; regional delivery + 1–2-day install by a certified Steel and Stud crew closes out the order. Rush builds are available, call 1-877-275-7048 for current capacity.
Can I finance a 100×60 commercial warehouse without a credit check?
Yes, Steel and Stud’s rent-to-own partner does not pull credit. Approvals close in about 8 minutes with proof of income and your first month’s payment. Terms run 36–60 months with no early-payoff penalty, and the monthly works out to roughly $2326/month on a 100×60 commercial warehouse.
What warranty comes with the 100×60 commercial warehouse?
Steel and Stud backs every building with a 20-year rust-through warranty on the galvanized frame and a 10-year sheeting warranty on the 29-gauge panels (upgradeable to 26-gauge or 12-gauge). Workmanship on the install is warrantied for 1 year. Full warranty terms ship with your order packet.
Can I customize the 100×60 commercial warehouse in 3D before I order?
Yes, our free Sensei3D Designer lets you drag and drop doors, windows, and walk-ins; swap 16 roof + trim colors live; and rotate the building in 3D from every angle. No login required. The design saves directly to a quote so what you build is exactly what we price.
Does the 100×60 commercial warehouse meet IBC commercial code?
Yes. Steel and Stud’s 12-gauge frame upgrade and 26-gauge sheeting both meet IBC commercial standards, and most counties accept our stamped drawings without revision. Engineered loads ship with the order, typical certified specs are 180 mph wind / 65 psf snow.
Ready to build?
Your Commercial Warehouse quote takes one minute.
Tell us your zip and the options you want. We’ll send back a same-day, all-in price.
6,000 sq ft for commercial warehouse, hay barn, or fabrication shop
100′ x 60′14 GaugeLocal Certification Available
Pre-engineered 100×60 steel building delivers 6,000 sq ft of column-free space. Galvanized 14-gauge tubular frame, vertical roof, and certified wind and snow load ratings. Customize doors, windows, colors, eave height, and certifications in our free 3D builder.
Leg height adjustable up to 20'
$111,650.00
Free Delivery & Install RTO from /mo — No credit check
6,000 sq ft for commercial warehouse, hay barn, or fabrication shop
100′ x 60′14 GaugeLocal Certification Available
Pre-engineered 100×60 steel building delivers 6,000 sq ft of column-free space. Galvanized 14-gauge tubular frame, vertical roof, and certified wind and snow load ratings. Customize doors, windows, colors, eave height, and certifications in our free 3D builder.
100×60 Equipment & Hay Barn | Steel and Stud, From $110,450
100×60 Equipment & Hay Barn, built for farm and ranch demands.
Our 100×60 equipment & hay barn fits 100-foot widths and 60-foot lengths to give you durable cover that handles snow, wind, and feed loads. Looking for a 100×60 equipment & hay barn? At 6000 sq ft, this footprint suits.
You’re viewing:Equipment & Hay Barn·Size100×60·Slate Gray
Starting from your selected configuration$110,450$125,900Save $15,450
or as low as $2301/mo · 0% APR · No credit RTO
ℹ️This is an estimate. Final pricing is locked after our sales team reviews your complete requirements (site access, ground type, county-specific certifications, optional upgrades). You’ll receive a written all-in quote within one business day of your request, no surprises, no hidden fees.
FREE delivery & installation in all 48 states. Concrete, asphalt, or compacted gravel.
SKU:SS-100X60-EQUIPMENT-HAY-BABuilt:1,847+Since: 2002Made in: 🇺🇸 USA
🛡️
A+
BBB Accredited
★
4.8/5
customer rating
⏱
Since 2004
In Business
🏠
15,000+
Buildings
🇺🇸
48
States Served
We’ve provided builds for
SPATIAL LAYOUT
See how 800 sq ft fits your hay-barn layout.
100 feet wide × 60 feet long. Our 100×60 equipment & hay barn fits 100-foot widths and 60-foot lengths to give you durable cover that handles snow, wind, and feed loads.
Hay storage · Feed alley · Equipment
Hay storage at the front, feed alley in the middle, equipment at the rear. Looking for a 100×60 equipment & hay barn? At 6000 sq ft, this footprint suits farm storage, tractor cover, or tack rooms.
💡 Pro tip:Clear-Span 40 ft.
🎨 FREE 3D BUILDER
Build your 100×60 Equipment & Hay Barn in 3D.
Design your building yourself in our free Sensei3D Designer, drag doors and windows where you want them, swap roof + trim colors, and see your spec from every angle. Save your design and email it to yourself for later.
Drag-and-drop doors, windows, walk-ins anywhere on the building
16 colors applied live to roof, walls, and trim, mix & match
Interior + exterior views of your spec, with measurements
Save your design and share it with your contractor or family
Auto-syncs to quote, what you build is what we price
All variants ship with free delivery, installation, drawings, 20-year warranty.
🏗️
6,000 sq ft enclosed
Fully-enclosed 100×60 vertical-roof structure.
🚪
Roll-up + walk-in doors
Standard configuration door package.
🔩
14-gauge steel frame
American-rolled galvanized tubing.
🎨
1 standard color
Pick from 16 factory-baked finishes.
TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS
Equipment & Hay Barn spec sheet.
Width100′
Length60′ + 6" overhang
Side height9′ standard
Floor space6,000 sq ft
Doors1 × 9×8 roll-up
Walk-inOptional (+$345)
WindowsOptional
Windup to 180 mph
Snowup to 65 psf
RoofVertical 3:12
Frame14 ga (12 ga upgrade)
Sheeting29 ga (26 ga upgrade)
AnchoringConcrete · Asphalt · Ground
Lead time3 – 5 weeks
USE CASE EXAMPLES
How real buyers use Equipment & Hay Barn.
DAILY USE
Everyday equipment & hay barn
6,000 sq ft is the right size for daily use of a equipment & hay barn.
STORAGE OVERFLOW
equipment & hay barn + seasonal storage
Park or store equipment in the front half, leave the rear for seasonal storage and overflow.
FLEX ROOM
Expansion-ready
Stud-framed interior makes it easy to add a partition, electrical, or insulation later.
FULL PRODUCT DETAILS
100×60 Equipment & Hay Barn, what makes it different.
6,000sq ft
Floor Space
180mph
Wind Rated
65psf
Snow Load
20yr
Rust Warranty
40yr
Paint Warranty
$2301/mo
From RTO
🏗️
Engineered for your county
Every 100×60 equipment & hay barn is fabricated from American-rolled galvanized steel and engineered against the exact wind and snow loads your jurisdiction requires.
Standard: 140 mph wind / 35 psf snow
12-ga upgrade: 180 mph / 65 psf
Permit drawings stamped and emailed free
🔩
Construction details
The same materials commercial fabricators use, not residential-grade. Hot-dip galvanized fasteners, factory-baked siliconized polyester paint, Hilti-grade anchors.
Frame: 14-ga (12-ga upgrade) galvanized tubing
Panels: 29-ga G-90 (26-ga upgrade)
Fasteners: #14 self-drilling with EPDM washer
🚚
Free delivery & install, really free
Regional-route delivery plus 1–2 day on-site installation by a certified crew, bundled into your headline price. No hidden unloading fees, fuel surcharges, or site-prep charges.
$0 deposit · pay only after walkthrough sign-off
3–5 week lead time on regional routes
All 48 states · rush option available
🛡️
Warranty & lifespan
Engineered for a 50-year service life with industry-leading warranties on every wear surface.
20-yr rust-through warranty on frame & panels
40-yr paint warranty against fading + chalking
1-yr craftsmanship on installation
💳
$0-down financing
Three financing paths to fit any credit situation. The rent-to-own option requires no credit pull at all, fastest path to a closed deal.
RTO: $2301/mo, no credit check, 36–60 mo
Financing: 0% promo APR · 84 mo term
Cash discount: 4% on $10K+ orders
⚡
Why 100×60?
6,000 sq ft sits in the sweet spot for residential and light-commercial, fits standard quarter-acre setbacks, comfortably below the 1,000 sq ft municipal threshold that triggers extra inspections.
100′ × 60′ footprint with 6,000 sq ft interior
Permit-friendly in 96% of US counties
Resale ROI $48,000–$72,000 added home value
PEOPLE ALSO ASK
Common questions from Equipment & Hay Barn shoppers.
The questions our team hears every week. Click any to expand the short answer.
How thick is the steel on a Steel and Stud 100×60 metal building?
Standard frame: 14-gauge (1.5 mm) galvanized tubing. Optional 12-gauge upgrade (2.5 mm) for high-wind/snow zones. Roof and wall sheeting ships 29-gauge standard, 26-gauge upgrade available on order.
Does Steel and Stud deliver and install in my state?
Yes, free delivery and free installation in all 48 continental states, performed by certified Steel and Stud crews. Hawaii and Alaska use custom freight quotes; call 1-877-275-7048 for either.
What’s the typical lead time for a 100×60 building?
Standard: 3–5 weeks from order confirmation to install completion. Fabrication runs the first 2–3 weeks at our US plant; regional delivery and 1-2 day install close it out. Rush builds available for $345.
Can I finance a Steel and Stud building without a credit check?
Yes, Steel and Stud’s rent-to-own partner does not pull credit. Approvals typically run 8 minutes with proof of income and first month’s payment. 36–60 month terms, no early-payoff penalty.
What’s covered under the 20-year warranty?
Steel and Stud’s 20-year rust-through warranty covers the galvanized frame against perforation, plus a 20-year paint-finish warranty against fade and chalk. Workmanship on the install is warrantied for 1 year. Warranty transfers to the next owner on resale.
CUSTOMER REVIEWS
What real 100×60 Equipment & Hay Barn buyers say.
⭐
No reviews yet for the 100×60 Equipment & Hay Barn
Be the first verified buyer to share your experience. Honest reviews help other steel-building shoppers make a confident decision.
A 100×60 equipment & hay barn from Steel and Stud starts at $110,450 with free delivery and free installation across all 48 states. Most buyers pick the rent-to-own option at about $2301/month with $0 down and no credit check. Call 1-877-275-7048 for a same-day price lock.
Is delivery and installation included in the 100×60 equipment & hay barn price?
Yes, every Steel and Stud equipment & hay barn ships with free delivery + free installation by a certified crew, included in the listed price. Anchored to a concrete pad, asphalt, or compacted gravel, your building is fully erected in 1–2 days after the truck arrives.
Do I need a permit for a 100×60 equipment & hay barn?
Almost always for 6,000+ sq ft enclosed buildings. Steel and Stud emails engineered drawings stamped for your wind zone (up to 180 mph) and snow zone (up to 65 psf) at no charge, so your local building department has everything it needs. Permit timing typically runs 2–6 weeks by jurisdiction.
How is a Steel and Stud equipment & hay barn different from a wood-frame build?
Steel solves the problems wood creates, no rotting, no termites, no warping, no painting every 3 years. Our 14-gauge galvanized frame carries a 20-year rust warranty and ships with a 180 mph wind / 65 psf snow rating already engineered in. A comparable wood build typically costs 2–3× more and needs ongoing maintenance.
What foundation does a 100×60 equipment & hay barn need?
A 4-inch concrete pad poured 1 foot wider and longer than the building is the standard. Steel and Stud also anchors to asphalt or compacted gravel for open or semi-enclosed configurations. A pad-pour bundle is offered at checkout if you don’t already have a slab.
How fast can I get a 100×60 equipment & hay barn delivered?
Standard lead time is 3–5 weeks from order to install. Fabrication runs the first 2–3 weeks at our US plant; regional delivery + 1–2-day install by a certified Steel and Stud crew closes out the order. Rush builds are available, call 1-877-275-7048 for current capacity.
Can I finance a 100×60 equipment & hay barn without a credit check?
Yes, Steel and Stud’s rent-to-own partner does not pull credit. Approvals close in about 8 minutes with proof of income and your first month’s payment. Terms run 36–60 months with no early-payoff penalty, and the monthly works out to roughly $2301/month on a 100×60 equipment & hay barn.
What warranty comes with the 100×60 equipment & hay barn?
Steel and Stud backs every building with a 20-year rust-through warranty on the galvanized frame and a 10-year sheeting warranty on the 29-gauge panels (upgradeable to 26-gauge or 12-gauge). Workmanship on the install is warrantied for 1 year. Full warranty terms ship with your order packet.
Can I customize the 100×60 equipment & hay barn in 3D before I order?
Yes, our free Sensei3D Designer lets you drag and drop doors, windows, and walk-ins; swap 16 roof + trim colors live; and rotate the building in 3D from every angle. No login required. The design saves directly to a quote so what you build is exactly what we price.
Will the 100×60 equipment & hay barn stand up to livestock and Midwest weather?
The 14-gauge galvanized frame is the same spec Steel and Stud uses for commercial barns, rated to 65 psf snow and 180 mph wind. Ventilation packages (ridge vent + soffit) ship standard on agricultural orders to prevent moisture buildup that would warp a wood barn.
Ready to build?
Your Equipment & Hay Barn quote takes one minute.
Tell us your zip and the options you want. We’ll send back a same-day, all-in price.
6,000 sq ft for commercial warehouse, hay barn, or fabrication shop
100′ x 60′14 GaugeLocal Certification Available
Pre-engineered 100×60 steel building delivers 6,000 sq ft of column-free space. Galvanized 14-gauge tubular frame, vertical roof, and certified wind and snow load ratings. Customize doors, windows, colors, eave height, and certifications in our free 3D builder.
Leg height adjustable up to 20'
$110,450.00
Free Delivery & Install RTO from /mo — No credit check
6,000 sq ft for commercial warehouse, hay barn, or fabrication shop
100′ x 60′14 GaugeLocal Certification Available
Pre-engineered 100×60 steel building delivers 6,000 sq ft of column-free space. Galvanized 14-gauge tubular frame, vertical roof, and certified wind and snow load ratings. Customize doors, windows, colors, eave height, and certifications in our free 3D builder.
100×60 Barndominium | Steel and Stud, From $109,800
100×60 Barndominium, built for daily backyard use.
100×60 delivers 6000 sq ft of everyday barndominium space. Barndo buyers split the 100×60 into 2,6000 sq ft of living space on one end and a 2,6000 sq ft shop on the other. A 12-foot wall height leaves room for vaulted.
You’re viewing:Barndominium·Size100×60·Slate Gray
Starting from your selected configuration$109,800$125,150Save $15,350
or as low as $2288/mo · 0% APR · No credit RTO
ℹ️This is an estimate. Final pricing is locked after our sales team reviews your complete requirements (site access, ground type, county-specific certifications, optional upgrades). You’ll receive a written all-in quote within one business day of your request, no surprises, no hidden fees.
FREE delivery & installation in all 48 states. Concrete, asphalt, or compacted gravel.
SKU:SS-100X60-BARNDOMINIUMBuilt:1,847+Since: 2002Made in: 🇺🇸 USA
🛡️
A+
BBB Accredited
★
4.8/5
customer rating
⏱
Since 2004
In Business
🏠
15,000+
Buildings
🇺🇸
48
States Served
We’ve provided builds for
SPATIAL LAYOUT
See how 800 sq ft fits your barndominium shell.
100 feet wide × 60 feet long. 100×60 delivers 6000 sq ft of everyday barndominium space.
Bedroom(s) · Great room / Kitchen · Bath / Mech
Bedroom(s) at the front, great room / kitchen in the middle, bath / mech at the rear. Barndo buyers split the 100×60 into 2,6000 sq ft of living space on one end and a 2,6000 sq ft shop on the other.
💡 Pro tip:Barndo-Ready Framing.
🎨 FREE 3D BUILDER
Build your 100×60 Barndominium in 3D.
Design your building yourself in our free Sensei3D Designer, drag doors and windows where you want them, swap roof + trim colors, and see your spec from every angle. Save your design and email it to yourself for later.
Drag-and-drop doors, windows, walk-ins anywhere on the building
16 colors applied live to roof, walls, and trim, mix & match
Interior + exterior views of your spec, with measurements
Save your design and share it with your contractor or family
Auto-syncs to quote, what you build is what we price
All variants ship with free delivery, installation, drawings, 20-year warranty.
🏗️
6,000 sq ft enclosed
Fully-enclosed 100×60 vertical-roof structure.
🚪
Roll-up + walk-in doors
Standard configuration door package.
🔩
14-gauge steel frame
American-rolled galvanized tubing.
🎨
1 standard color
Pick from 16 factory-baked finishes.
TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS
Barndominium spec sheet.
Width100′
Length60′ + 6" overhang
Side height9′ standard
Floor space6,000 sq ft
Doors1 × 9×8 roll-up
Walk-inOptional (+$345)
WindowsOptional
Windup to 180 mph
Snowup to 65 psf
RoofVertical 3:12
Frame14 ga (12 ga upgrade)
Sheeting29 ga (26 ga upgrade)
AnchoringConcrete · Asphalt · Ground
Lead time3 – 5 weeks
USE CASE EXAMPLES
How real buyers use Barndominium.
DAILY USE
Everyday barndominium
6,000 sq ft is the right size for daily use of a barndominium.
STORAGE OVERFLOW
barndominium + seasonal storage
Park or store equipment in the front half, leave the rear for seasonal storage and overflow.
FLEX ROOM
Expansion-ready
Stud-framed interior makes it easy to add a partition, electrical, or insulation later.
FULL PRODUCT DETAILS
100×60 Barndominium, what makes it different.
6,000sq ft
Floor Space
180mph
Wind Rated
65psf
Snow Load
20yr
Rust Warranty
40yr
Paint Warranty
$2288/mo
From RTO
🏗️
Engineered for your county
Every 100×60 barndominium is fabricated from American-rolled galvanized steel and engineered against the exact wind and snow loads your jurisdiction requires.
Standard: 140 mph wind / 35 psf snow
12-ga upgrade: 180 mph / 65 psf
Permit drawings stamped and emailed free
🔩
Construction details
The same materials commercial fabricators use, not residential-grade. Hot-dip galvanized fasteners, factory-baked siliconized polyester paint, Hilti-grade anchors.
Frame: 14-ga (12-ga upgrade) galvanized tubing
Panels: 29-ga G-90 (26-ga upgrade)
Fasteners: #14 self-drilling with EPDM washer
🚚
Free delivery & install, really free
Regional-route delivery plus 1–2 day on-site installation by a certified crew, bundled into your headline price. No hidden unloading fees, fuel surcharges, or site-prep charges.
$0 deposit · pay only after walkthrough sign-off
3–5 week lead time on regional routes
All 48 states · rush option available
🛡️
Warranty & lifespan
Engineered for a 50-year service life with industry-leading warranties on every wear surface.
20-yr rust-through warranty on frame & panels
40-yr paint warranty against fading + chalking
1-yr craftsmanship on installation
💳
$0-down financing
Three financing paths to fit any credit situation. The rent-to-own option requires no credit pull at all, fastest path to a closed deal.
RTO: $2288/mo, no credit check, 36–60 mo
Financing: 0% promo APR · 84 mo term
Cash discount: 4% on $10K+ orders
⚡
Why 100×60?
6,000 sq ft sits in the sweet spot for residential and light-commercial, fits standard quarter-acre setbacks, comfortably below the 1,000 sq ft municipal threshold that triggers extra inspections.
100′ × 60′ footprint with 6,000 sq ft interior
Permit-friendly in 96% of US counties
Resale ROI $48,000–$72,000 added home value
PEOPLE ALSO ASK
Common questions from Barndominium shoppers.
The questions our team hears every week. Click any to expand the short answer.
How thick is the steel on a Steel and Stud 100×60 metal building?
Standard frame: 14-gauge (1.5 mm) galvanized tubing. Optional 12-gauge upgrade (2.5 mm) for high-wind/snow zones. Roof and wall sheeting ships 29-gauge standard, 26-gauge upgrade available on order.
Does Steel and Stud deliver and install in my state?
Yes, free delivery and free installation in all 48 continental states, performed by certified Steel and Stud crews. Hawaii and Alaska use custom freight quotes; call 1-877-275-7048 for either.
What’s the typical lead time for a 100×60 building?
Standard: 3–5 weeks from order confirmation to install completion. Fabrication runs the first 2–3 weeks at our US plant; regional delivery and 1-2 day install close it out. Rush builds available for $345.
Can I finance a Steel and Stud building without a credit check?
Yes, Steel and Stud’s rent-to-own partner does not pull credit. Approvals typically run 8 minutes with proof of income and first month’s payment. 36–60 month terms, no early-payoff penalty.
What’s covered under the 20-year warranty?
Steel and Stud’s 20-year rust-through warranty covers the galvanized frame against perforation, plus a 20-year paint-finish warranty against fade and chalk. Workmanship on the install is warrantied for 1 year. Warranty transfers to the next owner on resale.
CUSTOMER REVIEWS
What real 100×60 Barndominium buyers say.
⭐
No reviews yet for the 100×60 Barndominium
Be the first verified buyer to share your experience. Honest reviews help other steel-building shoppers make a confident decision.
A 100×60 barndominium from Steel and Stud starts at $109,800 with free delivery and free installation across all 48 states. Most buyers pick the rent-to-own option at about $2288/month with $0 down and no credit check. Call 1-877-275-7048 for a same-day price lock.
Is delivery and installation included in the 100×60 barndominium price?
Yes, every Steel and Stud barndominium ships with free delivery + free installation by a certified crew, included in the listed price. Anchored to a concrete pad, asphalt, or compacted gravel, your building is fully erected in 1–2 days after the truck arrives.
Do I need a permit for a 100×60 barndominium?
Almost always for 6,000+ sq ft enclosed buildings. Steel and Stud emails engineered drawings stamped for your wind zone (up to 180 mph) and snow zone (up to 65 psf) at no charge, so your local building department has everything it needs. Permit timing typically runs 2–6 weeks by jurisdiction.
How is a Steel and Stud barndominium different from a wood-frame build?
Steel solves the problems wood creates, no rotting, no termites, no warping, no painting every 3 years. Our 14-gauge galvanized frame carries a 20-year rust warranty and ships with a 180 mph wind / 65 psf snow rating already engineered in. A comparable wood build typically costs 2–3× more and needs ongoing maintenance.
What foundation does a 100×60 barndominium need?
A 4-inch concrete pad poured 1 foot wider and longer than the building is the standard. Steel and Stud also anchors to asphalt or compacted gravel for open or semi-enclosed configurations. A pad-pour bundle is offered at checkout if you don’t already have a slab.
How fast can I get a 100×60 barndominium delivered?
Standard lead time is 3–5 weeks from order to install. Fabrication runs the first 2–3 weeks at our US plant; regional delivery + 1–2-day install by a certified Steel and Stud crew closes out the order. Rush builds are available, call 1-877-275-7048 for current capacity.
Can I finance a 100×60 barndominium without a credit check?
Yes, Steel and Stud’s rent-to-own partner does not pull credit. Approvals close in about 8 minutes with proof of income and your first month’s payment. Terms run 36–60 months with no early-payoff penalty, and the monthly works out to roughly $2288/month on a 100×60 barndominium.
What warranty comes with the 100×60 barndominium?
Steel and Stud backs every building with a 20-year rust-through warranty on the galvanized frame and a 10-year sheeting warranty on the 29-gauge panels (upgradeable to 26-gauge or 12-gauge). Workmanship on the install is warrantied for 1 year. Full warranty terms ship with your order packet.
Can I customize the 100×60 barndominium in 3D before I order?
Yes, our free Sensei3D Designer lets you drag and drop doors, windows, and walk-ins; swap 16 roof + trim colors live; and rotate the building in 3D from every angle. No login required. The design saves directly to a quote so what you build is exactly what we price.
Does a 100×60 barndominium add resale value to my home?
An enclosed 100×60 barndominium typically adds $48,000–$72,000 in resale value per regional comp data, and most insurance carriers reduce premiums for indoor vehicle / equipment storage. Steel and Stud’s 20-year rust warranty transfers to the next owner.
Ready to build?
Your Barndominium quote takes one minute.
Tell us your zip and the options you want. We’ll send back a same-day, all-in price.
6,000 sq ft for commercial warehouse, hay barn, or fabrication shop
100′ x 60′14 GaugeLocal Certification Available
Pre-engineered 100×60 steel building delivers 6,000 sq ft of column-free space. Galvanized 14-gauge tubular frame, vertical roof, and certified wind and snow load ratings. Customize doors, windows, colors, eave height, and certifications in our free 3D builder.
Leg height adjustable up to 20'
$109,800.00
Free Delivery & Install RTO from /mo — No credit check
6,000 sq ft for commercial warehouse, hay barn, or fabrication shop
100′ x 60′14 GaugeLocal Certification Available
Pre-engineered 100×60 steel building delivers 6,000 sq ft of column-free space. Galvanized 14-gauge tubular frame, vertical roof, and certified wind and snow load ratings. Customize doors, windows, colors, eave height, and certifications in our free 3D builder.
100×60 Fabrication Shop | Steel and Stud, From $112,050
100×60 Fabrication Shop, rated for heavy-duty industrial loads.
Built for industrial buyers managing equipment and inventory, this 100×60 fabrication shop packs 6000 sq ft into a code-compliant shell. Our 100×60 fabrication shop fits 100-foot widths and 50-foot lengths to give you a.
Starting from your selected configuration$112,050$127,750Save $15,700
or as low as $2334/mo · 0% APR · No credit RTO
ℹ️This is an estimate. Final pricing is locked after our sales team reviews your complete requirements (site access, ground type, county-specific certifications, optional upgrades). You’ll receive a written all-in quote within one business day of your request, no surprises, no hidden fees.
FREE delivery & installation in all 48 states. Concrete, asphalt, or compacted gravel.
SKU:SS-100X60-FABRICATION-SHOPBuilt:1,847+Since: 2002Made in: 🇺🇸 USA
🛡️
A+
BBB Accredited
★
4.8/5
customer rating
⏱
Since 2004
In Business
🏠
15,000+
Buildings
🇺🇸
48
States Served
We’ve provided builds for
SPATIAL LAYOUT
See how 800 sq ft fits your multi-station shop.
100 feet wide × 60 feet long. Separates dusty + clean operations. Built for industrial buyers managing equipment and inventory, this 100×60 fabrication shop packs 6000 sq ft into a code-compliant shell.
Wood + metal benches · CNC / table-saw center · Finishing room + Material storage
Wood + metal benches at the front, cnc / table-saw center in the middle, finishing room + material storage at the rear. Capacity: multi-craft shop / small business. Our 100×60 fabrication shop fits 100-foot widths and 50-foot lengths to give you a heavy-gauge frame rated for forklifts and machinery.
Design your building yourself in our free Sensei3D Designer, drag doors and windows where you want them, swap roof + trim colors, and see your spec from every angle. Save your design and email it to yourself for later.
Drag-and-drop doors, windows, walk-ins anywhere on the building
16 colors applied live to roof, walls, and trim, mix & match
Interior + exterior views of your spec, with measurements
Save your design and share it with your contractor or family
Auto-syncs to quote, what you build is what we price
All variants ship with free delivery, installation, drawings, 20-year warranty.
🏗️
6,000 sq ft enclosed
Fully-enclosed 100×60 vertical-roof structure.
🚪
Roll-up + walk-in doors
Standard configuration door package.
🔩
14-gauge steel frame
American-rolled galvanized tubing.
🎨
1 standard color
Pick from 16 factory-baked finishes.
TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS
Fabrication Shop spec sheet.
Width100′
Length60′ + 6" overhang
Side height9′ standard
Floor space6,000 sq ft
Doors1 × 9×8 roll-up
Walk-inOptional (+$345)
WindowsOptional
Windup to 180 mph
Snowup to 65 psf
RoofVertical 3:12
Frame14 ga (12 ga upgrade)
Sheeting29 ga (26 ga upgrade)
AnchoringConcrete · Asphalt · Ground
Lead time3 – 5 weeks
USE CASE EXAMPLES
How real buyers use Fabrication Shop.
DAILY USE
Everyday fabrication shop
6,000 sq ft is the right size for daily use of a fabrication shop.
STORAGE OVERFLOW
fabrication shop + seasonal storage
Park or store equipment in the front half, leave the rear for seasonal storage and overflow.
FLEX ROOM
Expansion-ready
Stud-framed interior makes it easy to add a partition, electrical, or insulation later.
FULL PRODUCT DETAILS
100×60 Fabrication Shop, what makes it different.
6,000sq ft
Floor Space
180mph
Wind Rated
65psf
Snow Load
20yr
Rust Warranty
40yr
Paint Warranty
$2334/mo
From RTO
🏗️
Engineered for your county
Every 100×60 fabrication shop is fabricated from American-rolled galvanized steel and engineered against the exact wind and snow loads your jurisdiction requires.
Standard: 140 mph wind / 35 psf snow
12-ga upgrade: 180 mph / 65 psf
Permit drawings stamped and emailed free
🔩
Construction details
The same materials commercial fabricators use, not residential-grade. Hot-dip galvanized fasteners, factory-baked siliconized polyester paint, Hilti-grade anchors.
Frame: 14-ga (12-ga upgrade) galvanized tubing
Panels: 29-ga G-90 (26-ga upgrade)
Fasteners: #14 self-drilling with EPDM washer
🚚
Free delivery & install, really free
Regional-route delivery plus 1–2 day on-site installation by a certified crew, bundled into your headline price. No hidden unloading fees, fuel surcharges, or site-prep charges.
$0 deposit · pay only after walkthrough sign-off
3–5 week lead time on regional routes
All 48 states · rush option available
🛡️
Warranty & lifespan
Engineered for a 50-year service life with industry-leading warranties on every wear surface.
20-yr rust-through warranty on frame & panels
40-yr paint warranty against fading + chalking
1-yr craftsmanship on installation
💳
$0-down financing
Three financing paths to fit any credit situation. The rent-to-own option requires no credit pull at all, fastest path to a closed deal.
RTO: $2334/mo, no credit check, 36–60 mo
Financing: 0% promo APR · 84 mo term
Cash discount: 4% on $10K+ orders
⚡
Why 100×60?
6,000 sq ft sits in the sweet spot for residential and light-commercial, fits standard quarter-acre setbacks, comfortably below the 1,000 sq ft municipal threshold that triggers extra inspections.
100′ × 60′ footprint with 6,000 sq ft interior
Permit-friendly in 96% of US counties
Resale ROI $48,000–$72,000 added home value
PEOPLE ALSO ASK
Common questions from Fabrication Shop shoppers.
The questions our team hears every week. Click any to expand the short answer.
How thick is the steel on a Steel and Stud 100×60 metal building?
Standard frame: 14-gauge (1.5 mm) galvanized tubing. Optional 12-gauge upgrade (2.5 mm) for high-wind/snow zones. Roof and wall sheeting ships 29-gauge standard, 26-gauge upgrade available on order.
Does Steel and Stud deliver and install in my state?
Yes, free delivery and free installation in all 48 continental states, performed by certified Steel and Stud crews. Hawaii and Alaska use custom freight quotes; call 1-877-275-7048 for either.
What’s the typical lead time for a 100×60 building?
Standard: 3–5 weeks from order confirmation to install completion. Fabrication runs the first 2–3 weeks at our US plant; regional delivery and 1-2 day install close it out. Rush builds available for $345.
Can I finance a Steel and Stud building without a credit check?
Yes, Steel and Stud’s rent-to-own partner does not pull credit. Approvals typically run 8 minutes with proof of income and first month’s payment. 36–60 month terms, no early-payoff penalty.
What’s covered under the 20-year warranty?
Steel and Stud’s 20-year rust-through warranty covers the galvanized frame against perforation, plus a 20-year paint-finish warranty against fade and chalk. Workmanship on the install is warrantied for 1 year. Warranty transfers to the next owner on resale.
CUSTOMER REVIEWS
What real 100×60 Fabrication Shop buyers say.
⭐
No reviews yet for the 100×60 Fabrication Shop
Be the first verified buyer to share your experience. Honest reviews help other steel-building shoppers make a confident decision.
A 100×60 fabrication shop from Steel and Stud starts at $112,050 with free delivery and free installation across all 48 states. Most buyers pick the rent-to-own option at about $2334/month with $0 down and no credit check. Call 1-877-275-7048 for a same-day price lock.
Is delivery and installation included in the 100×60 fabrication shop price?
Yes, every Steel and Stud fabrication shop ships with free delivery + free installation by a certified crew, included in the listed price. Anchored to a concrete pad, asphalt, or compacted gravel, your building is fully erected in 1–2 days after the truck arrives.
Do I need a permit for a 100×60 fabrication shop?
Almost always for 6,000+ sq ft enclosed buildings. Steel and Stud emails engineered drawings stamped for your wind zone (up to 180 mph) and snow zone (up to 65 psf) at no charge, so your local building department has everything it needs. Permit timing typically runs 2–6 weeks by jurisdiction.
How is a Steel and Stud fabrication shop different from a wood-frame build?
Steel solves the problems wood creates, no rotting, no termites, no warping, no painting every 3 years. Our 14-gauge galvanized frame carries a 20-year rust warranty and ships with a 180 mph wind / 65 psf snow rating already engineered in. A comparable wood build typically costs 2–3× more and needs ongoing maintenance.
What foundation does a 100×60 fabrication shop need?
A 4-inch concrete pad poured 1 foot wider and longer than the building is the standard. Steel and Stud also anchors to asphalt or compacted gravel for open or semi-enclosed configurations. A pad-pour bundle is offered at checkout if you don’t already have a slab.
How fast can I get a 100×60 fabrication shop delivered?
Standard lead time is 3–5 weeks from order to install. Fabrication runs the first 2–3 weeks at our US plant; regional delivery + 1–2-day install by a certified Steel and Stud crew closes out the order. Rush builds are available, call 1-877-275-7048 for current capacity.
Can I finance a 100×60 fabrication shop without a credit check?
Yes, Steel and Stud’s rent-to-own partner does not pull credit. Approvals close in about 8 minutes with proof of income and your first month’s payment. Terms run 36–60 months with no early-payoff penalty, and the monthly works out to roughly $2334/month on a 100×60 fabrication shop.
What warranty comes with the 100×60 fabrication shop?
Steel and Stud backs every building with a 20-year rust-through warranty on the galvanized frame and a 10-year sheeting warranty on the 29-gauge panels (upgradeable to 26-gauge or 12-gauge). Workmanship on the install is warrantied for 1 year. Full warranty terms ship with your order packet.
Can I customize the 100×60 fabrication shop in 3D before I order?
Yes, our free Sensei3D Designer lets you drag and drop doors, windows, and walk-ins; swap 16 roof + trim colors live; and rotate the building in 3D from every angle. No login required. The design saves directly to a quote so what you build is exactly what we price.
Will the 100×60 fabrication shop handle heavy equipment and forklifts?
Standard 100×60 fabrication shop ships rated for 35 psf live load on the floor (over concrete pad), and the 12-gauge frame upgrade supports trolley- and jib-crane mounts up to 1-ton capacity. Steel and Stud engineers will spec heavier rigging on request, call 1-877-275-7048.
Ready to build?
Your Fabrication Shop quote takes one minute.
Tell us your zip and the options you want. We’ll send back a same-day, all-in price.
6,000 sq ft for commercial warehouse, hay barn, or fabrication shop
100′ x 60′14 GaugeLocal Certification Available
Pre-engineered 100×60 steel building delivers 6,000 sq ft of column-free space. Galvanized 14-gauge tubular frame, vertical roof, and certified wind and snow load ratings. Customize doors, windows, colors, eave height, and certifications in our free 3D builder.
Leg height adjustable up to 20'
$112,050.00
Free Delivery & Install RTO from /mo — No credit check
6,000 sq ft for commercial warehouse, hay barn, or fabrication shop
100′ x 60′14 GaugeLocal Certification Available
Pre-engineered 100×60 steel building delivers 6,000 sq ft of column-free space. Galvanized 14-gauge tubular frame, vertical roof, and certified wind and snow load ratings. Customize doors, windows, colors, eave height, and certifications in our free 3D builder.
100×60 Horse Riding Arena | Steel and Stud, From $110,450
100×60 Horse Riding Arena, built for farm and ranch demands.
100×60 delivers 6000 sq ft of rugged horse riding arena space. The 100×60 is the entry-size covered riding arena, long enough for dressage patterns and wide enough for barrel turns. Clear-span trusses eliminate interior.
Starting from your selected configuration$110,450$125,900Save $15,450
or as low as $2301/mo · 0% APR · No credit RTO
ℹ️This is an estimate. Final pricing is locked after our sales team reviews your complete requirements (site access, ground type, county-specific certifications, optional upgrades). You’ll receive a written all-in quote within one business day of your request, no surprises, no hidden fees.
FREE delivery & installation in all 48 states. Concrete, asphalt, or compacted gravel.
SKU:SS-100X60-HORSE-RIDING-AREBuilt:1,847+Since: 2002Made in: 🇺🇸 USA
🛡️
A+
BBB Accredited
★
4.8/5
customer rating
⏱
Since 2004
In Business
🏠
15,000+
Buildings
🇺🇸
48
States Served
We’ve provided builds for
SPATIAL LAYOUT
See how 800 sq ft fits your multi-stall stable.
100 feet wide × 60 feet long. Full-height clearance supports hay loft (~160 bales). 100×60 delivers 6000 sq ft of rugged horse riding arena space.
4 stalls + tack · 12-ft center aisle · Hay loft + Wash bay
4 stalls + tack at the front, 12-ft center aisle in the middle, hay loft + wash bay at the rear. Capacity: 4 horses, full stable ops. The 100×60 is the entry-size covered riding arena, long enough for dressage patterns and wide enough for barrel turns.
💡 Pro tip:No Interior Posts. Size affords: hay loft, wash bay with hot water, feed room.
🎨 FREE 3D BUILDER
Build your 100×60 Horse Riding Arena in 3D.
Design your building yourself in our free Sensei3D Designer, drag doors and windows where you want them, swap roof + trim colors, and see your spec from every angle. Save your design and email it to yourself for later.
Drag-and-drop doors, windows, walk-ins anywhere on the building
16 colors applied live to roof, walls, and trim, mix & match
Interior + exterior views of your spec, with measurements
Save your design and share it with your contractor or family
Auto-syncs to quote, what you build is what we price
All variants ship with free delivery, installation, drawings, 20-year warranty.
🏗️
6,000 sq ft enclosed
Fully-enclosed 100×60 vertical-roof structure.
🚪
Roll-up + walk-in doors
Standard configuration door package.
🔩
14-gauge steel frame
American-rolled galvanized tubing.
🎨
1 standard color
Pick from 16 factory-baked finishes.
TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS
Horse Riding Arena spec sheet.
Width100′
Length60′ + 6" overhang
Side height9′ standard
Floor space6,000 sq ft
Doors1 × 9×8 roll-up
Walk-inOptional (+$345)
WindowsOptional
Windup to 180 mph
Snowup to 65 psf
RoofVertical 3:12
Frame14 ga (12 ga upgrade)
Sheeting29 ga (26 ga upgrade)
AnchoringConcrete · Asphalt · Ground
Lead time3 – 5 weeks
USE CASE EXAMPLES
How real buyers use Horse Riding Arena.
DAILY USE
Everyday horse riding arena
6,000 sq ft is the right size for daily use of a horse riding arena.
STORAGE OVERFLOW
horse riding arena + seasonal storage
Park or store equipment in the front half, leave the rear for seasonal storage and overflow.
FLEX ROOM
Expansion-ready
Stud-framed interior makes it easy to add a partition, electrical, or insulation later.
FULL PRODUCT DETAILS
100×60 Horse Riding Arena, what makes it different.
6,000sq ft
Floor Space
180mph
Wind Rated
65psf
Snow Load
20yr
Rust Warranty
40yr
Paint Warranty
$2301/mo
From RTO
🏗️
Engineered for your county
Every 100×60 horse riding arena is fabricated from American-rolled galvanized steel and engineered against the exact wind and snow loads your jurisdiction requires.
Standard: 140 mph wind / 35 psf snow
12-ga upgrade: 180 mph / 65 psf
Permit drawings stamped and emailed free
🔩
Construction details
The same materials commercial fabricators use, not residential-grade. Hot-dip galvanized fasteners, factory-baked siliconized polyester paint, Hilti-grade anchors.
Frame: 14-ga (12-ga upgrade) galvanized tubing
Panels: 29-ga G-90 (26-ga upgrade)
Fasteners: #14 self-drilling with EPDM washer
🚚
Free delivery & install, really free
Regional-route delivery plus 1–2 day on-site installation by a certified crew, bundled into your headline price. No hidden unloading fees, fuel surcharges, or site-prep charges.
$0 deposit · pay only after walkthrough sign-off
3–5 week lead time on regional routes
All 48 states · rush option available
🛡️
Warranty & lifespan
Engineered for a 50-year service life with industry-leading warranties on every wear surface.
20-yr rust-through warranty on frame & panels
40-yr paint warranty against fading + chalking
1-yr craftsmanship on installation
💳
$0-down financing
Three financing paths to fit any credit situation. The rent-to-own option requires no credit pull at all, fastest path to a closed deal.
RTO: $2301/mo, no credit check, 36–60 mo
Financing: 0% promo APR · 84 mo term
Cash discount: 4% on $10K+ orders
⚡
Why 100×60?
6,000 sq ft sits in the sweet spot for residential and light-commercial, fits standard quarter-acre setbacks, comfortably below the 1,000 sq ft municipal threshold that triggers extra inspections.
100′ × 60′ footprint with 6,000 sq ft interior
Permit-friendly in 96% of US counties
Resale ROI $48,000–$72,000 added home value
PEOPLE ALSO ASK
Common questions from Horse Riding Arena shoppers.
The questions our team hears every week. Click any to expand the short answer.
How thick is the steel on a Steel and Stud 100×60 metal building?
Standard frame: 14-gauge (1.5 mm) galvanized tubing. Optional 12-gauge upgrade (2.5 mm) for high-wind/snow zones. Roof and wall sheeting ships 29-gauge standard, 26-gauge upgrade available on order.
Does Steel and Stud deliver and install in my state?
Yes, free delivery and free installation in all 48 continental states, performed by certified Steel and Stud crews. Hawaii and Alaska use custom freight quotes; call 1-877-275-7048 for either.
What’s the typical lead time for a 100×60 building?
Standard: 3–5 weeks from order confirmation to install completion. Fabrication runs the first 2–3 weeks at our US plant; regional delivery and 1-2 day install close it out. Rush builds available for $345.
Can I finance a Steel and Stud building without a credit check?
Yes, Steel and Stud’s rent-to-own partner does not pull credit. Approvals typically run 8 minutes with proof of income and first month’s payment. 36–60 month terms, no early-payoff penalty.
What’s covered under the 20-year warranty?
Steel and Stud’s 20-year rust-through warranty covers the galvanized frame against perforation, plus a 20-year paint-finish warranty against fade and chalk. Workmanship on the install is warrantied for 1 year. Warranty transfers to the next owner on resale.
CUSTOMER REVIEWS
What real 100×60 Horse Riding Arena buyers say.
⭐
No reviews yet for the 100×60 Horse Riding Arena
Be the first verified buyer to share your experience. Honest reviews help other steel-building shoppers make a confident decision.
A 100×60 horse riding arena from Steel and Stud starts at $110,450 with free delivery and free installation across all 48 states. Most buyers pick the rent-to-own option at about $2301/month with $0 down and no credit check. Call 1-877-275-7048 for a same-day price lock.
Is delivery and installation included in the 100×60 horse riding arena price?
Yes, every Steel and Stud horse riding arena ships with free delivery + free installation by a certified crew, included in the listed price. Anchored to a concrete pad, asphalt, or compacted gravel, your building is fully erected in 1–2 days after the truck arrives.
Do I need a permit for a 100×60 horse riding arena?
Almost always for 6,000+ sq ft enclosed buildings. Steel and Stud emails engineered drawings stamped for your wind zone (up to 180 mph) and snow zone (up to 65 psf) at no charge, so your local building department has everything it needs. Permit timing typically runs 2–6 weeks by jurisdiction.
How is a Steel and Stud horse riding arena different from a wood-frame build?
Steel solves the problems wood creates, no rotting, no termites, no warping, no painting every 3 years. Our 14-gauge galvanized frame carries a 20-year rust warranty and ships with a 180 mph wind / 65 psf snow rating already engineered in. A comparable wood build typically costs 2–3× more and needs ongoing maintenance.
What foundation does a 100×60 horse riding arena need?
A 4-inch concrete pad poured 1 foot wider and longer than the building is the standard. Steel and Stud also anchors to asphalt or compacted gravel for open or semi-enclosed configurations. A pad-pour bundle is offered at checkout if you don’t already have a slab.
How fast can I get a 100×60 horse riding arena delivered?
Standard lead time is 3–5 weeks from order to install. Fabrication runs the first 2–3 weeks at our US plant; regional delivery + 1–2-day install by a certified Steel and Stud crew closes out the order. Rush builds are available, call 1-877-275-7048 for current capacity.
Can I finance a 100×60 horse riding arena without a credit check?
Yes, Steel and Stud’s rent-to-own partner does not pull credit. Approvals close in about 8 minutes with proof of income and your first month’s payment. Terms run 36–60 months with no early-payoff penalty, and the monthly works out to roughly $2301/month on a 100×60 horse riding arena.
What warranty comes with the 100×60 horse riding arena?
Steel and Stud backs every building with a 20-year rust-through warranty on the galvanized frame and a 10-year sheeting warranty on the 29-gauge panels (upgradeable to 26-gauge or 12-gauge). Workmanship on the install is warrantied for 1 year. Full warranty terms ship with your order packet.
Can I customize the 100×60 horse riding arena in 3D before I order?
Yes, our free Sensei3D Designer lets you drag and drop doors, windows, and walk-ins; swap 16 roof + trim colors live; and rotate the building in 3D from every angle. No login required. The design saves directly to a quote so what you build is exactly what we price.
Will the 100×60 horse riding arena stand up to livestock and Midwest weather?
The 14-gauge galvanized frame is the same spec Steel and Stud uses for commercial barns, rated to 65 psf snow and 180 mph wind. Ventilation packages (ridge vent + soffit) ship standard on agricultural orders to prevent moisture buildup that would warp a wood barn.
Ready to build?
Your Horse Riding Arena quote takes one minute.
Tell us your zip and the options you want. We’ll send back a same-day, all-in price.
6,000 sq ft for commercial warehouse, hay barn, or fabrication shop
100′ x 60′14 GaugeLocal Certification Available
Pre-engineered 100×60 steel building delivers 6,000 sq ft of column-free space. Galvanized 14-gauge tubular frame, vertical roof, and certified wind and snow load ratings. Customize doors, windows, colors, eave height, and certifications in our free 3D builder.
Leg height adjustable up to 20'
$110,450.00
Free Delivery & Install RTO from /mo — No credit check
6,000 sq ft for commercial warehouse, hay barn, or fabrication shop
100′ x 60′14 GaugeLocal Certification Available
Pre-engineered 100×60 steel building delivers 6,000 sq ft of column-free space. Galvanized 14-gauge tubular frame, vertical roof, and certified wind and snow load ratings. Customize doors, windows, colors, eave height, and certifications in our free 3D builder.
100×60 Auto Body & Repair Shop | Steel and Stud, From $111,650
100×60 Auto Body & Repair Shop, engineered for code-compliant business use.
Looking for a 100×60 auto body & repair shop? At 6000 sq ft, this footprint suits small businesses, retail, or service shops. 100×60 delivers 6000 sq ft of code-compliant auto body & repair shop space. Independent body.
You’re viewing:Auto Body & Repair Shop·Size100×60·Slate Gray
Starting from your selected configuration$111,650$127,300Save $15,650
or as low as $2326/mo · 0% APR · No credit RTO
ℹ️This is an estimate. Final pricing is locked after our sales team reviews your complete requirements (site access, ground type, county-specific certifications, optional upgrades). You’ll receive a written all-in quote within one business day of your request, no surprises, no hidden fees.
FREE delivery & installation in all 48 states. Concrete, asphalt, or compacted gravel.
SKU:SS-100X60-AUTO-BODY-REPAIRBuilt:1,847+Since: 2002Made in: 🇺🇸 USA
🛡️
A+
BBB Accredited
★
4.8/5
customer rating
⏱
Since 2004
In Business
🏠
15,000+
Buildings
🇺🇸
48
States Served
We’ve provided builds for
SPATIAL LAYOUT
See how 800 sq ft fits your auto body & repair shop layout.
100 feet wide × 60 feet long. Looking for a 100×60 auto body & repair shop? At 6000 sq ft, this footprint suits small businesses, retail, or service shops.
Auto Body & Repair Shop layout.
Looking for a 100×60 auto body & repair shop? At 6000 sq ft, this footprint suits small businesses, retail, or service shops. 100×60 delivers 6000 sq ft of code-compliant auto body & repair shop space. Independent body shops fit four to six lifts, a paint booth, and a parts office into a 100×60 with a 14-foot ceiling. The length allows a drive-through layout where cars enter one short wall and exit the other. Insulated walls and a sealed slab meet most municipal paint-booth codes.
💡 Pro tip:Drive-Through Layout.
🎨 FREE 3D BUILDER
Build your 100×60 Auto Body & Repair Shop in 3D.
Design your building yourself in our free Sensei3D Designer, drag doors and windows where you want them, swap roof + trim colors, and see your spec from every angle. Save your design and email it to yourself for later.
Drag-and-drop doors, windows, walk-ins anywhere on the building
16 colors applied live to roof, walls, and trim, mix & match
Interior + exterior views of your spec, with measurements
Save your design and share it with your contractor or family
Auto-syncs to quote, what you build is what we price
All variants ship with free delivery, installation, drawings, 20-year warranty.
🏗️
6,000 sq ft enclosed
Fully-enclosed 100×60 vertical-roof structure.
🚪
Roll-up + walk-in doors
Standard configuration door package.
🔩
14-gauge steel frame
American-rolled galvanized tubing.
🎨
1 standard color
Pick from 16 factory-baked finishes.
TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS
Auto Body & Repair Shop spec sheet.
Width100′
Length60′ + 6" overhang
Side height9′ standard
Floor space6,000 sq ft
Doors1 × 9×8 roll-up
Walk-inOptional (+$345)
WindowsOptional
Windup to 180 mph
Snowup to 65 psf
RoofVertical 3:12
Frame14 ga (12 ga upgrade)
Sheeting29 ga (26 ga upgrade)
AnchoringConcrete · Asphalt · Ground
Lead time3 – 5 weeks
USE CASE EXAMPLES
How real buyers use Auto Body & Repair Shop.
DAILY USE
Everyday auto body & repair shop
6,000 sq ft is the right size for daily use of a auto body & repair shop.
STORAGE OVERFLOW
auto body & repair shop + seasonal storage
Park or store equipment in the front half, leave the rear for seasonal storage and overflow.
FLEX ROOM
Expansion-ready
Stud-framed interior makes it easy to add a partition, electrical, or insulation later.
FULL PRODUCT DETAILS
100×60 Auto Body & Repair Shop, what makes it different.
6,000sq ft
Floor Space
180mph
Wind Rated
65psf
Snow Load
20yr
Rust Warranty
40yr
Paint Warranty
$2326/mo
From RTO
🏗️
Engineered for your county
Every 100×60 auto body & repair shop is fabricated from American-rolled galvanized steel and engineered against the exact wind and snow loads your jurisdiction requires.
Standard: 140 mph wind / 35 psf snow
12-ga upgrade: 180 mph / 65 psf
Permit drawings stamped and emailed free
🔩
Construction details
The same materials commercial fabricators use, not residential-grade. Hot-dip galvanized fasteners, factory-baked siliconized polyester paint, Hilti-grade anchors.
Frame: 14-ga (12-ga upgrade) galvanized tubing
Panels: 29-ga G-90 (26-ga upgrade)
Fasteners: #14 self-drilling with EPDM washer
🚚
Free delivery & install, really free
Regional-route delivery plus 1–2 day on-site installation by a certified crew, bundled into your headline price. No hidden unloading fees, fuel surcharges, or site-prep charges.
$0 deposit · pay only after walkthrough sign-off
3–5 week lead time on regional routes
All 48 states · rush option available
🛡️
Warranty & lifespan
Engineered for a 50-year service life with industry-leading warranties on every wear surface.
20-yr rust-through warranty on frame & panels
40-yr paint warranty against fading + chalking
1-yr craftsmanship on installation
💳
$0-down financing
Three financing paths to fit any credit situation. The rent-to-own option requires no credit pull at all, fastest path to a closed deal.
RTO: $2326/mo, no credit check, 36–60 mo
Financing: 0% promo APR · 84 mo term
Cash discount: 4% on $10K+ orders
⚡
Why 100×60?
6,000 sq ft sits in the sweet spot for residential and light-commercial, fits standard quarter-acre setbacks, comfortably below the 1,000 sq ft municipal threshold that triggers extra inspections.
100′ × 60′ footprint with 6,000 sq ft interior
Permit-friendly in 96% of US counties
Resale ROI $48,000–$72,000 added home value
PEOPLE ALSO ASK
Common questions from Auto Body & Repair Shop shoppers.
The questions our team hears every week. Click any to expand the short answer.
How thick is the steel on a Steel and Stud 100×60 metal building?
Standard frame: 14-gauge (1.5 mm) galvanized tubing. Optional 12-gauge upgrade (2.5 mm) for high-wind/snow zones. Roof and wall sheeting ships 29-gauge standard, 26-gauge upgrade available on order.
Does Steel and Stud deliver and install in my state?
Yes, free delivery and free installation in all 48 continental states, performed by certified Steel and Stud crews. Hawaii and Alaska use custom freight quotes; call 1-877-275-7048 for either.
What’s the typical lead time for a 100×60 building?
Standard: 3–5 weeks from order confirmation to install completion. Fabrication runs the first 2–3 weeks at our US plant; regional delivery and 1-2 day install close it out. Rush builds available for $345.
Can I finance a Steel and Stud building without a credit check?
Yes, Steel and Stud’s rent-to-own partner does not pull credit. Approvals typically run 8 minutes with proof of income and first month’s payment. 36–60 month terms, no early-payoff penalty.
What’s covered under the 20-year warranty?
Steel and Stud’s 20-year rust-through warranty covers the galvanized frame against perforation, plus a 20-year paint-finish warranty against fade and chalk. Workmanship on the install is warrantied for 1 year. Warranty transfers to the next owner on resale.
CUSTOMER REVIEWS
What real 100×60 Auto Body & Repair Shop buyers say.
⭐
No reviews yet for the 100×60 Auto Body & Repair Shop
Be the first verified buyer to share your experience. Honest reviews help other steel-building shoppers make a confident decision.
How much does a 100×60 auto body & repair shop cost?
A 100×60 auto body & repair shop from Steel and Stud starts at $111,650 with free delivery and free installation across all 48 states. Most buyers pick the rent-to-own option at about $2326/month with $0 down and no credit check. Call 1-877-275-7048 for a same-day price lock.
Is delivery and installation included in the 100×60 auto body & repair shop price?
Yes, every Steel and Stud auto body & repair shop ships with free delivery + free installation by a certified crew, included in the listed price. Anchored to a concrete pad, asphalt, or compacted gravel, your building is fully erected in 1–2 days after the truck arrives.
Do I need a permit for a 100×60 auto body & repair shop?
Almost always for 6,000+ sq ft enclosed buildings. Steel and Stud emails engineered drawings stamped for your wind zone (up to 180 mph) and snow zone (up to 65 psf) at no charge, so your local building department has everything it needs. Permit timing typically runs 2–6 weeks by jurisdiction.
How is a Steel and Stud auto body & repair shop different from a wood-frame build?
Steel solves the problems wood creates, no rotting, no termites, no warping, no painting every 3 years. Our 14-gauge galvanized frame carries a 20-year rust warranty and ships with a 180 mph wind / 65 psf snow rating already engineered in. A comparable wood build typically costs 2–3× more and needs ongoing maintenance.
What foundation does a 100×60 auto body & repair shop need?
A 4-inch concrete pad poured 1 foot wider and longer than the building is the standard. Steel and Stud also anchors to asphalt or compacted gravel for open or semi-enclosed configurations. A pad-pour bundle is offered at checkout if you don’t already have a slab.
How fast can I get a 100×60 auto body & repair shop delivered?
Standard lead time is 3–5 weeks from order to install. Fabrication runs the first 2–3 weeks at our US plant; regional delivery + 1–2-day install by a certified Steel and Stud crew closes out the order. Rush builds are available, call 1-877-275-7048 for current capacity.
Can I finance a 100×60 auto body & repair shop without a credit check?
Yes, Steel and Stud’s rent-to-own partner does not pull credit. Approvals close in about 8 minutes with proof of income and your first month’s payment. Terms run 36–60 months with no early-payoff penalty, and the monthly works out to roughly $2326/month on a 100×60 auto body & repair shop.
What warranty comes with the 100×60 auto body & repair shop?
Steel and Stud backs every building with a 20-year rust-through warranty on the galvanized frame and a 10-year sheeting warranty on the 29-gauge panels (upgradeable to 26-gauge or 12-gauge). Workmanship on the install is warrantied for 1 year. Full warranty terms ship with your order packet.
Can I customize the 100×60 auto body & repair shop in 3D before I order?
Yes, our free Sensei3D Designer lets you drag and drop doors, windows, and walk-ins; swap 16 roof + trim colors live; and rotate the building in 3D from every angle. No login required. The design saves directly to a quote so what you build is exactly what we price.
Does the 100×60 auto body & repair shop meet IBC commercial code?
Yes. Steel and Stud’s 12-gauge frame upgrade and 26-gauge sheeting both meet IBC commercial standards, and most counties accept our stamped drawings without revision. Engineered loads ship with the order, typical certified specs are 180 mph wind / 65 psf snow.
Ready to build?
Your Auto Body & Repair Shop quote takes one minute.
Tell us your zip and the options you want. We’ll send back a same-day, all-in price.
6,000 sq ft for commercial warehouse, hay barn, or fabrication shop
100′ x 60′14 GaugeLocal Certification Available
Pre-engineered 100×60 steel building delivers 6,000 sq ft of column-free space. Galvanized 14-gauge tubular frame, vertical roof, and certified wind and snow load ratings. Customize doors, windows, colors, eave height, and certifications in our free 3D builder.
Leg height adjustable up to 20'
$111,650.00
Free Delivery & Install RTO from /mo — No credit check
6,000 sq ft for commercial warehouse, hay barn, or fabrication shop
100′ x 60′14 GaugeLocal Certification Available
Pre-engineered 100×60 steel building delivers 6,000 sq ft of column-free space. Galvanized 14-gauge tubular frame, vertical roof, and certified wind and snow load ratings. Customize doors, windows, colors, eave height, and certifications in our free 3D builder.
100×60 RV & Boat Storage | Steel and Stud, From $109,800
100×60 RV & Boat Storage, built for hobby and recreational use.
100×60 delivers 6000 sq ft of hobby-ready rv & boat storage space. Storage operators and HOAs use the 100×60 for enclosed RV and boat bays. At 16-20 foot eave height, Class A motorhomes and wake boats on trailers roll.
Starting from your selected configuration$109,800$125,150Save $15,350
or as low as $2288/mo · 0% APR · No credit RTO
ℹ️This is an estimate. Final pricing is locked after our sales team reviews your complete requirements (site access, ground type, county-specific certifications, optional upgrades). You’ll receive a written all-in quote within one business day of your request, no surprises, no hidden fees.
FREE delivery & installation in all 48 states. Concrete, asphalt, or compacted gravel.
SKU:SS-100X60-RV-BOAT-STORAGEBuilt:1,847+Since: 2002Made in: 🇺🇸 USA
🛡️
A+
BBB Accredited
★
4.8/5
customer rating
⏱
Since 2004
In Business
🏠
15,000+
Buildings
🇺🇸
48
States Served
We’ve provided builds for
SPATIAL LAYOUT
See how 800 sq ft fits your multi-RV garage.
100 feet wide × 60 feet long. 16-ft+ clear height for tall slides + roof AC. 100×60 delivers 6000 sq ft of hobby-ready rv & boat storage space.
Multiple RV bays · Service / wash bay · Storage + workshop
Multiple RV bays at the front, service / wash bay in the middle, storage + workshop at the rear. Capacity: 2 Class A’s or RV + boat + daily driver. Storage operators and HOAs use the 100×60 for enclosed RV and boat bays.
💡 Pro tip:Class A Clearance. Size affords: multiple hookups, wash + dump, tool wall.
🎨 FREE 3D BUILDER
Build your 100×60 RV & Boat Storage in 3D.
Design your building yourself in our free Sensei3D Designer, drag doors and windows where you want them, swap roof + trim colors, and see your spec from every angle. Save your design and email it to yourself for later.
Drag-and-drop doors, windows, walk-ins anywhere on the building
16 colors applied live to roof, walls, and trim, mix & match
Interior + exterior views of your spec, with measurements
Save your design and share it with your contractor or family
Auto-syncs to quote, what you build is what we price
All variants ship with free delivery, installation, drawings, 20-year warranty.
🏗️
6,000 sq ft enclosed
Fully-enclosed 100×60 vertical-roof structure.
🚪
Roll-up + walk-in doors
Standard configuration door package.
🔩
14-gauge steel frame
American-rolled galvanized tubing.
🎨
1 standard color
Pick from 16 factory-baked finishes.
TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS
RV & Boat Storage spec sheet.
Width100′
Length60′ + 6" overhang
Side height9′ standard
Floor space6,000 sq ft
Doors1 × 9×8 roll-up
Walk-inOptional (+$345)
WindowsOptional
Windup to 180 mph
Snowup to 65 psf
RoofVertical 3:12
Frame14 ga (12 ga upgrade)
Sheeting29 ga (26 ga upgrade)
AnchoringConcrete · Asphalt · Ground
Lead time3 – 5 weeks
USE CASE EXAMPLES
How real buyers use RV & Boat Storage.
DAILY USE
Everyday rv & boat storage
6,000 sq ft is the right size for daily use of a rv & boat storage.
STORAGE OVERFLOW
rv & boat storage + seasonal storage
Park or store equipment in the front half, leave the rear for seasonal storage and overflow.
FLEX ROOM
Expansion-ready
Stud-framed interior makes it easy to add a partition, electrical, or insulation later.
FULL PRODUCT DETAILS
100×60 RV & Boat Storage, what makes it different.
6,000sq ft
Floor Space
180mph
Wind Rated
65psf
Snow Load
20yr
Rust Warranty
40yr
Paint Warranty
$2288/mo
From RTO
🏗️
Engineered for your county
Every 100×60 rv & boat storage is fabricated from American-rolled galvanized steel and engineered against the exact wind and snow loads your jurisdiction requires.
Standard: 140 mph wind / 35 psf snow
12-ga upgrade: 180 mph / 65 psf
Permit drawings stamped and emailed free
🔩
Construction details
The same materials commercial fabricators use, not residential-grade. Hot-dip galvanized fasteners, factory-baked siliconized polyester paint, Hilti-grade anchors.
Frame: 14-ga (12-ga upgrade) galvanized tubing
Panels: 29-ga G-90 (26-ga upgrade)
Fasteners: #14 self-drilling with EPDM washer
🚚
Free delivery & install, really free
Regional-route delivery plus 1–2 day on-site installation by a certified crew, bundled into your headline price. No hidden unloading fees, fuel surcharges, or site-prep charges.
$0 deposit · pay only after walkthrough sign-off
3–5 week lead time on regional routes
All 48 states · rush option available
🛡️
Warranty & lifespan
Engineered for a 50-year service life with industry-leading warranties on every wear surface.
20-yr rust-through warranty on frame & panels
40-yr paint warranty against fading + chalking
1-yr craftsmanship on installation
💳
$0-down financing
Three financing paths to fit any credit situation. The rent-to-own option requires no credit pull at all, fastest path to a closed deal.
RTO: $2288/mo, no credit check, 36–60 mo
Financing: 0% promo APR · 84 mo term
Cash discount: 4% on $10K+ orders
⚡
Why 100×60?
6,000 sq ft sits in the sweet spot for residential and light-commercial, fits standard quarter-acre setbacks, comfortably below the 1,000 sq ft municipal threshold that triggers extra inspections.
100′ × 60′ footprint with 6,000 sq ft interior
Permit-friendly in 96% of US counties
Resale ROI $48,000–$72,000 added home value
PEOPLE ALSO ASK
Common questions from RV & Boat Storage shoppers.
The questions our team hears every week. Click any to expand the short answer.
How thick is the steel on a Steel and Stud 100×60 metal building?
Standard frame: 14-gauge (1.5 mm) galvanized tubing. Optional 12-gauge upgrade (2.5 mm) for high-wind/snow zones. Roof and wall sheeting ships 29-gauge standard, 26-gauge upgrade available on order.
Does Steel and Stud deliver and install in my state?
Yes, free delivery and free installation in all 48 continental states, performed by certified Steel and Stud crews. Hawaii and Alaska use custom freight quotes; call 1-877-275-7048 for either.
What’s the typical lead time for a 100×60 building?
Standard: 3–5 weeks from order confirmation to install completion. Fabrication runs the first 2–3 weeks at our US plant; regional delivery and 1-2 day install close it out. Rush builds available for $345.
Can I finance a Steel and Stud building without a credit check?
Yes, Steel and Stud’s rent-to-own partner does not pull credit. Approvals typically run 8 minutes with proof of income and first month’s payment. 36–60 month terms, no early-payoff penalty.
What’s covered under the 20-year warranty?
Steel and Stud’s 20-year rust-through warranty covers the galvanized frame against perforation, plus a 20-year paint-finish warranty against fade and chalk. Workmanship on the install is warrantied for 1 year. Warranty transfers to the next owner on resale.
CUSTOMER REVIEWS
What real 100×60 RV & Boat Storage buyers say.
⭐
No reviews yet for the 100×60 RV & Boat Storage
Be the first verified buyer to share your experience. Honest reviews help other steel-building shoppers make a confident decision.
A 100×60 rv & boat storage from Steel and Stud starts at $109,800 with free delivery and free installation across all 48 states. Most buyers pick the rent-to-own option at about $2288/month with $0 down and no credit check. Call 1-877-275-7048 for a same-day price lock.
Is delivery and installation included in the 100×60 rv & boat storage price?
Yes, every Steel and Stud rv & boat storage ships with free delivery + free installation by a certified crew, included in the listed price. Anchored to a concrete pad, asphalt, or compacted gravel, your building is fully erected in 1–2 days after the truck arrives.
Do I need a permit for a 100×60 rv & boat storage?
Almost always for 6,000+ sq ft enclosed buildings. Steel and Stud emails engineered drawings stamped for your wind zone (up to 180 mph) and snow zone (up to 65 psf) at no charge, so your local building department has everything it needs. Permit timing typically runs 2–6 weeks by jurisdiction.
How is a Steel and Stud rv & boat storage different from a wood-frame build?
Steel solves the problems wood creates, no rotting, no termites, no warping, no painting every 3 years. Our 14-gauge galvanized frame carries a 20-year rust warranty and ships with a 180 mph wind / 65 psf snow rating already engineered in. A comparable wood build typically costs 2–3× more and needs ongoing maintenance.
What foundation does a 100×60 rv & boat storage need?
A 4-inch concrete pad poured 1 foot wider and longer than the building is the standard. Steel and Stud also anchors to asphalt or compacted gravel for open or semi-enclosed configurations. A pad-pour bundle is offered at checkout if you don’t already have a slab.
How fast can I get a 100×60 rv & boat storage delivered?
Standard lead time is 3–5 weeks from order to install. Fabrication runs the first 2–3 weeks at our US plant; regional delivery + 1–2-day install by a certified Steel and Stud crew closes out the order. Rush builds are available, call 1-877-275-7048 for current capacity.
Can I finance a 100×60 rv & boat storage without a credit check?
Yes, Steel and Stud’s rent-to-own partner does not pull credit. Approvals close in about 8 minutes with proof of income and your first month’s payment. Terms run 36–60 months with no early-payoff penalty, and the monthly works out to roughly $2288/month on a 100×60 rv & boat storage.
What warranty comes with the 100×60 rv & boat storage?
Steel and Stud backs every building with a 20-year rust-through warranty on the galvanized frame and a 10-year sheeting warranty on the 29-gauge panels (upgradeable to 26-gauge or 12-gauge). Workmanship on the install is warrantied for 1 year. Full warranty terms ship with your order packet.
Can I customize the 100×60 rv & boat storage in 3D before I order?
Yes, our free Sensei3D Designer lets you drag and drop doors, windows, and walk-ins; swap 16 roof + trim colors live; and rotate the building in 3D from every angle. No login required. The design saves directly to a quote so what you build is exactly what we price.
Can I insulate the 100×60 rv & boat storage for year-round use?
Yes, Steel and Stud offers R-13 wall + R-19 ceiling insulation packages, and the interior is drywall-ready. Most owners finish a rv & boat storage to a livable retreat in 2–3 weekends. Add a mini-split HVAC at checkout for full four-season comfort.
Ready to build?
Your RV & Boat Storage quote takes one minute.
Tell us your zip and the options you want. We’ll send back a same-day, all-in price.
6,000 sq ft for commercial warehouse, hay barn, or fabrication shop
100′ x 60′14 GaugeLocal Certification Available
Pre-engineered 100×60 steel building delivers 6,000 sq ft of column-free space. Galvanized 14-gauge tubular frame, vertical roof, and certified wind and snow load ratings. Customize doors, windows, colors, eave height, and certifications in our free 3D builder.
Leg height adjustable up to 20'
$109,800.00
Free Delivery & Install RTO from /mo — No credit check
6,000 sq ft for commercial warehouse, hay barn, or fabrication shop
100′ x 60′14 GaugeLocal Certification Available
Pre-engineered 100×60 steel building delivers 6,000 sq ft of column-free space. Galvanized 14-gauge tubular frame, vertical roof, and certified wind and snow load ratings. Customize doors, windows, colors, eave height, and certifications in our free 3D builder.
100×60 Self-Storage Facility | Steel and Stud, From $111,650
100×60 Self-Storage Facility, engineered for code-compliant business use.
100×60 delivers 6000 sq ft of code-compliant self-storage facility space. Self-storage developers divide the 100×60 into roughly 30-40 climate-controlled units ranging from 100×60 to 100×60. Interior partitions drop in.
Starting from your selected configuration$111,650$127,300Save $15,650
or as low as $2326/mo · 0% APR · No credit RTO
ℹ️This is an estimate. Final pricing is locked after our sales team reviews your complete requirements (site access, ground type, county-specific certifications, optional upgrades). You’ll receive a written all-in quote within one business day of your request, no surprises, no hidden fees.
FREE delivery & installation in all 48 states. Concrete, asphalt, or compacted gravel.
SKU:SS-100X60-SELF-STORAGE-FACBuilt:1,847+Since: 2002Made in: 🇺🇸 USA
🛡️
A+
BBB Accredited
★
4.8/5
customer rating
⏱
Since 2004
In Business
🏠
15,000+
Buildings
🇺🇸
48
States Served
We’ve provided builds for
SPATIAL LAYOUT
See how 800 sq ft fits your self-storage layout.
100 feet wide × 60 feet long. 100×60 delivers 6000 sq ft of code-compliant self-storage facility space.
Unit row A · Unit row B · Hallway / Office
Unit row A at the front, unit row b in the middle, hallway / office at the rear. Self-storage developers divide the 100×60 into roughly 30-40 climate-controlled units ranging from 100×60 to 100×60.
💡 Pro tip:30+ Rental Units.
🎨 FREE 3D BUILDER
Build your 100×60 Self-Storage Facility in 3D.
Design your building yourself in our free Sensei3D Designer, drag doors and windows where you want them, swap roof + trim colors, and see your spec from every angle. Save your design and email it to yourself for later.
Drag-and-drop doors, windows, walk-ins anywhere on the building
16 colors applied live to roof, walls, and trim, mix & match
Interior + exterior views of your spec, with measurements
Save your design and share it with your contractor or family
Auto-syncs to quote, what you build is what we price
All variants ship with free delivery, installation, drawings, 20-year warranty.
🏗️
6,000 sq ft enclosed
Fully-enclosed 100×60 vertical-roof structure.
🚪
Roll-up + walk-in doors
Standard configuration door package.
🔩
14-gauge steel frame
American-rolled galvanized tubing.
🎨
1 standard color
Pick from 16 factory-baked finishes.
TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS
Self-Storage Facility spec sheet.
Width100′
Length60′ + 6" overhang
Side height9′ standard
Floor space6,000 sq ft
Doors1 × 9×8 roll-up
Walk-inOptional (+$345)
WindowsOptional
Windup to 180 mph
Snowup to 65 psf
RoofVertical 3:12
Frame14 ga (12 ga upgrade)
Sheeting29 ga (26 ga upgrade)
AnchoringConcrete · Asphalt · Ground
Lead time3 – 5 weeks
USE CASE EXAMPLES
How real buyers use Self-Storage Facility.
DAILY USE
Everyday self-storage facility
6,000 sq ft is the right size for daily use of a self-storage facility.
STORAGE OVERFLOW
self-storage facility + seasonal storage
Park or store equipment in the front half, leave the rear for seasonal storage and overflow.
FLEX ROOM
Expansion-ready
Stud-framed interior makes it easy to add a partition, electrical, or insulation later.
FULL PRODUCT DETAILS
100×60 Self-Storage Facility, what makes it different.
6,000sq ft
Floor Space
180mph
Wind Rated
65psf
Snow Load
20yr
Rust Warranty
40yr
Paint Warranty
$2326/mo
From RTO
🏗️
Engineered for your county
Every 100×60 self-storage facility is fabricated from American-rolled galvanized steel and engineered against the exact wind and snow loads your jurisdiction requires.
Standard: 140 mph wind / 35 psf snow
12-ga upgrade: 180 mph / 65 psf
Permit drawings stamped and emailed free
🔩
Construction details
The same materials commercial fabricators use, not residential-grade. Hot-dip galvanized fasteners, factory-baked siliconized polyester paint, Hilti-grade anchors.
Frame: 14-ga (12-ga upgrade) galvanized tubing
Panels: 29-ga G-90 (26-ga upgrade)
Fasteners: #14 self-drilling with EPDM washer
🚚
Free delivery & install, really free
Regional-route delivery plus 1–2 day on-site installation by a certified crew, bundled into your headline price. No hidden unloading fees, fuel surcharges, or site-prep charges.
$0 deposit · pay only after walkthrough sign-off
3–5 week lead time on regional routes
All 48 states · rush option available
🛡️
Warranty & lifespan
Engineered for a 50-year service life with industry-leading warranties on every wear surface.
20-yr rust-through warranty on frame & panels
40-yr paint warranty against fading + chalking
1-yr craftsmanship on installation
💳
$0-down financing
Three financing paths to fit any credit situation. The rent-to-own option requires no credit pull at all, fastest path to a closed deal.
RTO: $2326/mo, no credit check, 36–60 mo
Financing: 0% promo APR · 84 mo term
Cash discount: 4% on $10K+ orders
⚡
Why 100×60?
6,000 sq ft sits in the sweet spot for residential and light-commercial, fits standard quarter-acre setbacks, comfortably below the 1,000 sq ft municipal threshold that triggers extra inspections.
100′ × 60′ footprint with 6,000 sq ft interior
Permit-friendly in 96% of US counties
Resale ROI $48,000–$72,000 added home value
PEOPLE ALSO ASK
Common questions from Self-Storage Facility shoppers.
The questions our team hears every week. Click any to expand the short answer.
How thick is the steel on a Steel and Stud 100×60 metal building?
Standard frame: 14-gauge (1.5 mm) galvanized tubing. Optional 12-gauge upgrade (2.5 mm) for high-wind/snow zones. Roof and wall sheeting ships 29-gauge standard, 26-gauge upgrade available on order.
Does Steel and Stud deliver and install in my state?
Yes, free delivery and free installation in all 48 continental states, performed by certified Steel and Stud crews. Hawaii and Alaska use custom freight quotes; call 1-877-275-7048 for either.
What’s the typical lead time for a 100×60 building?
Standard: 3–5 weeks from order confirmation to install completion. Fabrication runs the first 2–3 weeks at our US plant; regional delivery and 1-2 day install close it out. Rush builds available for $345.
Can I finance a Steel and Stud building without a credit check?
Yes, Steel and Stud’s rent-to-own partner does not pull credit. Approvals typically run 8 minutes with proof of income and first month’s payment. 36–60 month terms, no early-payoff penalty.
What’s covered under the 20-year warranty?
Steel and Stud’s 20-year rust-through warranty covers the galvanized frame against perforation, plus a 20-year paint-finish warranty against fade and chalk. Workmanship on the install is warrantied for 1 year. Warranty transfers to the next owner on resale.
CUSTOMER REVIEWS
What real 100×60 Self-Storage Facility buyers say.
⭐
No reviews yet for the 100×60 Self-Storage Facility
Be the first verified buyer to share your experience. Honest reviews help other steel-building shoppers make a confident decision.
How much does a 100×60 self-storage facility cost?
A 100×60 self-storage facility from Steel and Stud starts at $111,650 with free delivery and free installation across all 48 states. Most buyers pick the rent-to-own option at about $2326/month with $0 down and no credit check. Call 1-877-275-7048 for a same-day price lock.
Is delivery and installation included in the 100×60 self-storage facility price?
Yes, every Steel and Stud self-storage facility ships with free delivery + free installation by a certified crew, included in the listed price. Anchored to a concrete pad, asphalt, or compacted gravel, your building is fully erected in 1–2 days after the truck arrives.
Do I need a permit for a 100×60 self-storage facility?
Almost always for 6,000+ sq ft enclosed buildings. Steel and Stud emails engineered drawings stamped for your wind zone (up to 180 mph) and snow zone (up to 65 psf) at no charge, so your local building department has everything it needs. Permit timing typically runs 2–6 weeks by jurisdiction.
How is a Steel and Stud self-storage facility different from a wood-frame build?
Steel solves the problems wood creates, no rotting, no termites, no warping, no painting every 3 years. Our 14-gauge galvanized frame carries a 20-year rust warranty and ships with a 180 mph wind / 65 psf snow rating already engineered in. A comparable wood build typically costs 2–3× more and needs ongoing maintenance.
What foundation does a 100×60 self-storage facility need?
A 4-inch concrete pad poured 1 foot wider and longer than the building is the standard. Steel and Stud also anchors to asphalt or compacted gravel for open or semi-enclosed configurations. A pad-pour bundle is offered at checkout if you don’t already have a slab.
How fast can I get a 100×60 self-storage facility delivered?
Standard lead time is 3–5 weeks from order to install. Fabrication runs the first 2–3 weeks at our US plant; regional delivery + 1–2-day install by a certified Steel and Stud crew closes out the order. Rush builds are available, call 1-877-275-7048 for current capacity.
Can I finance a 100×60 self-storage facility without a credit check?
Yes, Steel and Stud’s rent-to-own partner does not pull credit. Approvals close in about 8 minutes with proof of income and your first month’s payment. Terms run 36–60 months with no early-payoff penalty, and the monthly works out to roughly $2326/month on a 100×60 self-storage facility.
What warranty comes with the 100×60 self-storage facility?
Steel and Stud backs every building with a 20-year rust-through warranty on the galvanized frame and a 10-year sheeting warranty on the 29-gauge panels (upgradeable to 26-gauge or 12-gauge). Workmanship on the install is warrantied for 1 year. Full warranty terms ship with your order packet.
Can I customize the 100×60 self-storage facility in 3D before I order?
Yes, our free Sensei3D Designer lets you drag and drop doors, windows, and walk-ins; swap 16 roof + trim colors live; and rotate the building in 3D from every angle. No login required. The design saves directly to a quote so what you build is exactly what we price.
Does the 100×60 self-storage facility meet IBC commercial code?
Yes. Steel and Stud’s 12-gauge frame upgrade and 26-gauge sheeting both meet IBC commercial standards, and most counties accept our stamped drawings without revision. Engineered loads ship with the order, typical certified specs are 180 mph wind / 65 psf snow.
Ready to build?
Your Self-Storage Facility quote takes one minute.
Tell us your zip and the options you want. We’ll send back a same-day, all-in price.
6,000 sq ft for commercial warehouse, hay barn, or fabrication shop
100′ x 60′14 GaugeLocal Certification Available
Pre-engineered 100×60 steel building delivers 6,000 sq ft of column-free space. Galvanized 14-gauge tubular frame, vertical roof, and certified wind and snow load ratings. Customize doors, windows, colors, eave height, and certifications in our free 3D builder.
Leg height adjustable up to 20'
$111,650.00
Free Delivery & Install RTO from /mo — No credit check
6,000 sq ft for commercial warehouse, hay barn, or fabrication shop
100′ x 60′14 GaugeLocal Certification Available
Pre-engineered 100×60 steel building delivers 6,000 sq ft of column-free space. Galvanized 14-gauge tubular frame, vertical roof, and certified wind and snow load ratings. Customize doors, windows, colors, eave height, and certifications in our free 3D builder.
100×60 Church & Event Hall | Steel and Stud, From $111,750
100×60 Church & Event Hall, engineered to code for assembly use.
Looking for a 100×60 church & event hall? At 6000 sq ft, this footprint suits public assembly, community use, or worship space. Small congregations and community groups use the 100×60 as sanctuary and fellowship space.
Starting from your selected configuration$111,750$127,400Save $15,650
or as low as $2328/mo · 0% APR · No credit RTO
ℹ️This is an estimate. Final pricing is locked after our sales team reviews your complete requirements (site access, ground type, county-specific certifications, optional upgrades). You’ll receive a written all-in quote within one business day of your request, no surprises, no hidden fees.
FREE delivery & installation in all 48 states. Concrete, asphalt, or compacted gravel.
SKU:SS-100X60-CHURCH-EVENT-HALBuilt:1,847+Since: 2002Made in: 🇺🇸 USA
🛡️
A+
BBB Accredited
★
4.8/5
customer rating
⏱
Since 2004
In Business
🏠
15,000+
Buildings
🇺🇸
48
States Served
We’ve provided builds for
SPATIAL LAYOUT
See how 800 sq ft fits your worship-hall layout.
100 feet wide × 60 feet long. Center aisle + side aisles, fellowship space at rear. Looking for a 100×60 church & event hall? At 6000 sq ft, this footprint suits public assembly, community use, or worship space.
Sanctuary / Altar at the front, pew seating in the middle, foyer + restrooms + classrooms at the rear. Capacity: seats ~600 in main sanctuary. Small congregations and community groups use the 100×60 as sanctuary and fellowship space combined.
Design your building yourself in our free Sensei3D Designer, drag doors and windows where you want them, swap roof + trim colors, and see your spec from every angle. Save your design and email it to yourself for later.
Drag-and-drop doors, windows, walk-ins anywhere on the building
16 colors applied live to roof, walls, and trim, mix & match
Interior + exterior views of your spec, with measurements
Save your design and share it with your contractor or family
Auto-syncs to quote, what you build is what we price
All variants ship with free delivery, installation, drawings, 20-year warranty.
🏗️
6,000 sq ft enclosed
Fully-enclosed 100×60 vertical-roof structure.
🚪
Roll-up + walk-in doors
Standard configuration door package.
🔩
14-gauge steel frame
American-rolled galvanized tubing.
🎨
1 standard color
Pick from 16 factory-baked finishes.
TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS
Church & Event Hall spec sheet.
Width100′
Length60′ + 6" overhang
Side height9′ standard
Floor space6,000 sq ft
Doors1 × 9×8 roll-up
Walk-inOptional (+$345)
WindowsOptional
Windup to 180 mph
Snowup to 65 psf
RoofVertical 3:12
Frame14 ga (12 ga upgrade)
Sheeting29 ga (26 ga upgrade)
AnchoringConcrete · Asphalt · Ground
Lead time3 – 5 weeks
USE CASE EXAMPLES
How real buyers use Church & Event Hall.
DAILY USE
Everyday church & event hall
6,000 sq ft is the right size for daily use of a church & event hall.
STORAGE OVERFLOW
church & event hall + seasonal storage
Park or store equipment in the front half, leave the rear for seasonal storage and overflow.
FLEX ROOM
Expansion-ready
Stud-framed interior makes it easy to add a partition, electrical, or insulation later.
FULL PRODUCT DETAILS
100×60 Church & Event Hall, what makes it different.
6,000sq ft
Floor Space
180mph
Wind Rated
65psf
Snow Load
20yr
Rust Warranty
40yr
Paint Warranty
$2328/mo
From RTO
🏗️
Engineered for your county
Every 100×60 church & event hall is fabricated from American-rolled galvanized steel and engineered against the exact wind and snow loads your jurisdiction requires.
Standard: 140 mph wind / 35 psf snow
12-ga upgrade: 180 mph / 65 psf
Permit drawings stamped and emailed free
🔩
Construction details
The same materials commercial fabricators use, not residential-grade. Hot-dip galvanized fasteners, factory-baked siliconized polyester paint, Hilti-grade anchors.
Frame: 14-ga (12-ga upgrade) galvanized tubing
Panels: 29-ga G-90 (26-ga upgrade)
Fasteners: #14 self-drilling with EPDM washer
🚚
Free delivery & install, really free
Regional-route delivery plus 1–2 day on-site installation by a certified crew, bundled into your headline price. No hidden unloading fees, fuel surcharges, or site-prep charges.
$0 deposit · pay only after walkthrough sign-off
3–5 week lead time on regional routes
All 48 states · rush option available
🛡️
Warranty & lifespan
Engineered for a 50-year service life with industry-leading warranties on every wear surface.
20-yr rust-through warranty on frame & panels
40-yr paint warranty against fading + chalking
1-yr craftsmanship on installation
💳
$0-down financing
Three financing paths to fit any credit situation. The rent-to-own option requires no credit pull at all, fastest path to a closed deal.
RTO: $2328/mo, no credit check, 36–60 mo
Financing: 0% promo APR · 84 mo term
Cash discount: 4% on $10K+ orders
⚡
Why 100×60?
6,000 sq ft sits in the sweet spot for residential and light-commercial, fits standard quarter-acre setbacks, comfortably below the 1,000 sq ft municipal threshold that triggers extra inspections.
100′ × 60′ footprint with 6,000 sq ft interior
Permit-friendly in 96% of US counties
Resale ROI $48,000–$72,000 added home value
PEOPLE ALSO ASK
Common questions from Church & Event Hall shoppers.
The questions our team hears every week. Click any to expand the short answer.
How thick is the steel on a Steel and Stud 100×60 metal building?
Standard frame: 14-gauge (1.5 mm) galvanized tubing. Optional 12-gauge upgrade (2.5 mm) for high-wind/snow zones. Roof and wall sheeting ships 29-gauge standard, 26-gauge upgrade available on order.
Does Steel and Stud deliver and install in my state?
Yes, free delivery and free installation in all 48 continental states, performed by certified Steel and Stud crews. Hawaii and Alaska use custom freight quotes; call 1-877-275-7048 for either.
What’s the typical lead time for a 100×60 building?
Standard: 3–5 weeks from order confirmation to install completion. Fabrication runs the first 2–3 weeks at our US plant; regional delivery and 1-2 day install close it out. Rush builds available for $345.
Can I finance a Steel and Stud building without a credit check?
Yes, Steel and Stud’s rent-to-own partner does not pull credit. Approvals typically run 8 minutes with proof of income and first month’s payment. 36–60 month terms, no early-payoff penalty.
What’s covered under the 20-year warranty?
Steel and Stud’s 20-year rust-through warranty covers the galvanized frame against perforation, plus a 20-year paint-finish warranty against fade and chalk. Workmanship on the install is warrantied for 1 year. Warranty transfers to the next owner on resale.
CUSTOMER REVIEWS
What real 100×60 Church & Event Hall buyers say.
⭐
No reviews yet for the 100×60 Church & Event Hall
Be the first verified buyer to share your experience. Honest reviews help other steel-building shoppers make a confident decision.
A 100×60 church & event hall from Steel and Stud starts at $111,750 with free delivery and free installation across all 48 states. Most buyers pick the rent-to-own option at about $2328/month with $0 down and no credit check. Call 1-877-275-7048 for a same-day price lock.
Is delivery and installation included in the 100×60 church & event hall price?
Yes, every Steel and Stud church & event hall ships with free delivery + free installation by a certified crew, included in the listed price. Anchored to a concrete pad, asphalt, or compacted gravel, your building is fully erected in 1–2 days after the truck arrives.
Do I need a permit for a 100×60 church & event hall?
Almost always for 6,000+ sq ft enclosed buildings. Steel and Stud emails engineered drawings stamped for your wind zone (up to 180 mph) and snow zone (up to 65 psf) at no charge, so your local building department has everything it needs. Permit timing typically runs 2–6 weeks by jurisdiction.
How is a Steel and Stud church & event hall different from a wood-frame build?
Steel solves the problems wood creates, no rotting, no termites, no warping, no painting every 3 years. Our 14-gauge galvanized frame carries a 20-year rust warranty and ships with a 180 mph wind / 65 psf snow rating already engineered in. A comparable wood build typically costs 2–3× more and needs ongoing maintenance.
What foundation does a 100×60 church & event hall need?
A 4-inch concrete pad poured 1 foot wider and longer than the building is the standard. Steel and Stud also anchors to asphalt or compacted gravel for open or semi-enclosed configurations. A pad-pour bundle is offered at checkout if you don’t already have a slab.
How fast can I get a 100×60 church & event hall delivered?
Standard lead time is 3–5 weeks from order to install. Fabrication runs the first 2–3 weeks at our US plant; regional delivery + 1–2-day install by a certified Steel and Stud crew closes out the order. Rush builds are available, call 1-877-275-7048 for current capacity.
Can I finance a 100×60 church & event hall without a credit check?
Yes, Steel and Stud’s rent-to-own partner does not pull credit. Approvals close in about 8 minutes with proof of income and your first month’s payment. Terms run 36–60 months with no early-payoff penalty, and the monthly works out to roughly $2328/month on a 100×60 church & event hall.
What warranty comes with the 100×60 church & event hall?
Steel and Stud backs every building with a 20-year rust-through warranty on the galvanized frame and a 10-year sheeting warranty on the 29-gauge panels (upgradeable to 26-gauge or 12-gauge). Workmanship on the install is warrantied for 1 year. Full warranty terms ship with your order packet.
Can I customize the 100×60 church & event hall in 3D before I order?
Yes, our free Sensei3D Designer lets you drag and drop doors, windows, and walk-ins; swap 16 roof + trim colors live; and rotate the building in 3D from every angle. No login required. The design saves directly to a quote so what you build is exactly what we price.
Will the 100×60 church & event hall pass community-use and assembly inspections?
Yes. Steel and Stud’s engineered drawings include load calculations, accessibility paths, and egress widths required by most jurisdictions for assembly and institutional use. Stamped, sealed PE drawings are included free with every order.
Ready to build?
Your Church & Event Hall quote takes one minute.
Tell us your zip and the options you want. We’ll send back a same-day, all-in price.
6,000 sq ft for commercial warehouse, hay barn, or fabrication shop
100′ x 60′14 GaugeLocal Certification Available
Pre-engineered 100×60 steel building delivers 6,000 sq ft of column-free space. Galvanized 14-gauge tubular frame, vertical roof, and certified wind and snow load ratings. Customize doors, windows, colors, eave height, and certifications in our free 3D builder.
Leg height adjustable up to 20'
$111,750.00
Free Delivery & Install RTO from /mo — No credit check
6,000 sq ft for commercial warehouse, hay barn, or fabrication shop
100′ x 60′14 GaugeLocal Certification Available
Pre-engineered 100×60 steel building delivers 6,000 sq ft of column-free space. Galvanized 14-gauge tubular frame, vertical roof, and certified wind and snow load ratings. Customize doors, windows, colors, eave height, and certifications in our free 3D builder.
100×60 Livestock Barn | Steel and Stud, From $110,450
100×60 Livestock Barn, built for farm and ranch demands.
Our 100×60 livestock barn fits 100-foot widths and 60-foot lengths to give you durable cover that handles snow, wind, and feed loads. Looking for a 100×60 livestock barn? At 6000 sq ft, this footprint suits farm.
Starting from your selected configuration$110,450$125,900Save $15,450
or as low as $2301/mo · 0% APR · No credit RTO
ℹ️This is an estimate. Final pricing is locked after our sales team reviews your complete requirements (site access, ground type, county-specific certifications, optional upgrades). You’ll receive a written all-in quote within one business day of your request, no surprises, no hidden fees.
FREE delivery & installation in all 48 states. Concrete, asphalt, or compacted gravel.
SKU:SS-100X60-LIVESTOCK-BARNBuilt:1,847+Since: 2002Made in: 🇺🇸 USA
🛡️
A+
BBB Accredited
★
4.8/5
customer rating
⏱
Since 2004
In Business
🏠
15,000+
Buildings
🇺🇸
48
States Served
We’ve provided builds for
SPATIAL LAYOUT
See how 800 sq ft fits your livestock-barn layout.
100 feet wide × 60 feet long. Our 100×60 livestock barn fits 100-foot widths and 60-foot lengths to give you durable cover that handles snow, wind, and feed loads.
Livestock area · Center alley · Feed / Storage
Livestock area at the front, center alley in the middle, feed / storage at the rear. Looking for a 100×60 livestock barn? At 6000 sq ft, this footprint suits farm storage, tractor cover, or tack rooms.
💡 Pro tip:40-50 Head Capacity.
🎨 FREE 3D BUILDER
Build your 100×60 Livestock Barn in 3D.
Design your building yourself in our free Sensei3D Designer, drag doors and windows where you want them, swap roof + trim colors, and see your spec from every angle. Save your design and email it to yourself for later.
Drag-and-drop doors, windows, walk-ins anywhere on the building
16 colors applied live to roof, walls, and trim, mix & match
Interior + exterior views of your spec, with measurements
Save your design and share it with your contractor or family
Auto-syncs to quote, what you build is what we price
All variants ship with free delivery, installation, drawings, 20-year warranty.
🏗️
6,000 sq ft enclosed
Fully-enclosed 100×60 vertical-roof structure.
🚪
Roll-up + walk-in doors
Standard configuration door package.
🔩
14-gauge steel frame
American-rolled galvanized tubing.
🎨
1 standard color
Pick from 16 factory-baked finishes.
TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS
Livestock Barn spec sheet.
Width100′
Length60′ + 6" overhang
Side height9′ standard
Floor space6,000 sq ft
Doors1 × 9×8 roll-up
Walk-inOptional (+$345)
WindowsOptional
Windup to 180 mph
Snowup to 65 psf
RoofVertical 3:12
Frame14 ga (12 ga upgrade)
Sheeting29 ga (26 ga upgrade)
AnchoringConcrete · Asphalt · Ground
Lead time3 – 5 weeks
USE CASE EXAMPLES
How real buyers use Livestock Barn.
DAILY USE
Everyday livestock barn
6,000 sq ft is the right size for daily use of a livestock barn.
STORAGE OVERFLOW
livestock barn + seasonal storage
Park or store equipment in the front half, leave the rear for seasonal storage and overflow.
FLEX ROOM
Expansion-ready
Stud-framed interior makes it easy to add a partition, electrical, or insulation later.
FULL PRODUCT DETAILS
100×60 Livestock Barn, what makes it different.
6,000sq ft
Floor Space
180mph
Wind Rated
65psf
Snow Load
20yr
Rust Warranty
40yr
Paint Warranty
$2301/mo
From RTO
🏗️
Engineered for your county
Every 100×60 livestock barn is fabricated from American-rolled galvanized steel and engineered against the exact wind and snow loads your jurisdiction requires.
Standard: 140 mph wind / 35 psf snow
12-ga upgrade: 180 mph / 65 psf
Permit drawings stamped and emailed free
🔩
Construction details
The same materials commercial fabricators use, not residential-grade. Hot-dip galvanized fasteners, factory-baked siliconized polyester paint, Hilti-grade anchors.
Frame: 14-ga (12-ga upgrade) galvanized tubing
Panels: 29-ga G-90 (26-ga upgrade)
Fasteners: #14 self-drilling with EPDM washer
🚚
Free delivery & install, really free
Regional-route delivery plus 1–2 day on-site installation by a certified crew, bundled into your headline price. No hidden unloading fees, fuel surcharges, or site-prep charges.
$0 deposit · pay only after walkthrough sign-off
3–5 week lead time on regional routes
All 48 states · rush option available
🛡️
Warranty & lifespan
Engineered for a 50-year service life with industry-leading warranties on every wear surface.
20-yr rust-through warranty on frame & panels
40-yr paint warranty against fading + chalking
1-yr craftsmanship on installation
💳
$0-down financing
Three financing paths to fit any credit situation. The rent-to-own option requires no credit pull at all, fastest path to a closed deal.
RTO: $2301/mo, no credit check, 36–60 mo
Financing: 0% promo APR · 84 mo term
Cash discount: 4% on $10K+ orders
⚡
Why 100×60?
6,000 sq ft sits in the sweet spot for residential and light-commercial, fits standard quarter-acre setbacks, comfortably below the 1,000 sq ft municipal threshold that triggers extra inspections.
100′ × 60′ footprint with 6,000 sq ft interior
Permit-friendly in 96% of US counties
Resale ROI $48,000–$72,000 added home value
PEOPLE ALSO ASK
Common questions from Livestock Barn shoppers.
The questions our team hears every week. Click any to expand the short answer.
How thick is the steel on a Steel and Stud 100×60 metal building?
Standard frame: 14-gauge (1.5 mm) galvanized tubing. Optional 12-gauge upgrade (2.5 mm) for high-wind/snow zones. Roof and wall sheeting ships 29-gauge standard, 26-gauge upgrade available on order.
Does Steel and Stud deliver and install in my state?
Yes, free delivery and free installation in all 48 continental states, performed by certified Steel and Stud crews. Hawaii and Alaska use custom freight quotes; call 1-877-275-7048 for either.
What’s the typical lead time for a 100×60 building?
Standard: 3–5 weeks from order confirmation to install completion. Fabrication runs the first 2–3 weeks at our US plant; regional delivery and 1-2 day install close it out. Rush builds available for $345.
Can I finance a Steel and Stud building without a credit check?
Yes, Steel and Stud’s rent-to-own partner does not pull credit. Approvals typically run 8 minutes with proof of income and first month’s payment. 36–60 month terms, no early-payoff penalty.
What’s covered under the 20-year warranty?
Steel and Stud’s 20-year rust-through warranty covers the galvanized frame against perforation, plus a 20-year paint-finish warranty against fade and chalk. Workmanship on the install is warrantied for 1 year. Warranty transfers to the next owner on resale.
CUSTOMER REVIEWS
What real 100×60 Livestock Barn buyers say.
⭐
No reviews yet for the 100×60 Livestock Barn
Be the first verified buyer to share your experience. Honest reviews help other steel-building shoppers make a confident decision.
A 100×60 livestock barn from Steel and Stud starts at $110,450 with free delivery and free installation across all 48 states. Most buyers pick the rent-to-own option at about $2301/month with $0 down and no credit check. Call 1-877-275-7048 for a same-day price lock.
Is delivery and installation included in the 100×60 livestock barn price?
Yes, every Steel and Stud livestock barn ships with free delivery + free installation by a certified crew, included in the listed price. Anchored to a concrete pad, asphalt, or compacted gravel, your building is fully erected in 1–2 days after the truck arrives.
Do I need a permit for a 100×60 livestock barn?
Almost always for 6,000+ sq ft enclosed buildings. Steel and Stud emails engineered drawings stamped for your wind zone (up to 180 mph) and snow zone (up to 65 psf) at no charge, so your local building department has everything it needs. Permit timing typically runs 2–6 weeks by jurisdiction.
How is a Steel and Stud livestock barn different from a wood-frame build?
Steel solves the problems wood creates, no rotting, no termites, no warping, no painting every 3 years. Our 14-gauge galvanized frame carries a 20-year rust warranty and ships with a 180 mph wind / 65 psf snow rating already engineered in. A comparable wood build typically costs 2–3× more and needs ongoing maintenance.
What foundation does a 100×60 livestock barn need?
A 4-inch concrete pad poured 1 foot wider and longer than the building is the standard. Steel and Stud also anchors to asphalt or compacted gravel for open or semi-enclosed configurations. A pad-pour bundle is offered at checkout if you don’t already have a slab.
How fast can I get a 100×60 livestock barn delivered?
Standard lead time is 3–5 weeks from order to install. Fabrication runs the first 2–3 weeks at our US plant; regional delivery + 1–2-day install by a certified Steel and Stud crew closes out the order. Rush builds are available, call 1-877-275-7048 for current capacity.
Can I finance a 100×60 livestock barn without a credit check?
Yes, Steel and Stud’s rent-to-own partner does not pull credit. Approvals close in about 8 minutes with proof of income and your first month’s payment. Terms run 36–60 months with no early-payoff penalty, and the monthly works out to roughly $2301/month on a 100×60 livestock barn.
What warranty comes with the 100×60 livestock barn?
Steel and Stud backs every building with a 20-year rust-through warranty on the galvanized frame and a 10-year sheeting warranty on the 29-gauge panels (upgradeable to 26-gauge or 12-gauge). Workmanship on the install is warrantied for 1 year. Full warranty terms ship with your order packet.
Can I customize the 100×60 livestock barn in 3D before I order?
Yes, our free Sensei3D Designer lets you drag and drop doors, windows, and walk-ins; swap 16 roof + trim colors live; and rotate the building in 3D from every angle. No login required. The design saves directly to a quote so what you build is exactly what we price.
Will the 100×60 livestock barn stand up to livestock and Midwest weather?
The 14-gauge galvanized frame is the same spec Steel and Stud uses for commercial barns, rated to 65 psf snow and 180 mph wind. Ventilation packages (ridge vent + soffit) ship standard on agricultural orders to prevent moisture buildup that would warp a wood barn.
Ready to build?
Your Livestock Barn quote takes one minute.
Tell us your zip and the options you want. We’ll send back a same-day, all-in price.
6,000 sq ft for commercial warehouse, hay barn, or fabrication shop
100′ x 60′14 GaugeLocal Certification Available
Pre-engineered 100×60 steel building delivers 6,000 sq ft of column-free space. Galvanized 14-gauge tubular frame, vertical roof, and certified wind and snow load ratings. Customize doors, windows, colors, eave height, and certifications in our free 3D builder.
Leg height adjustable up to 20'
$110,450.00
Free Delivery & Install RTO from /mo — No credit check
6,000 sq ft for commercial warehouse, hay barn, or fabrication shop
100′ x 60′14 GaugeLocal Certification Available
Pre-engineered 100×60 steel building delivers 6,000 sq ft of column-free space. Galvanized 14-gauge tubular frame, vertical roof, and certified wind and snow load ratings. Customize doors, windows, colors, eave height, and certifications in our free 3D builder.
100×60 Indoor Sports Facility | Steel and Stud, From $109,800
100×60 Indoor Sports Facility, built for hobby and recreational use.
Our 100×60 indoor sports facility fits 100-foot widths and 60-foot lengths to give you a comfortable hobby retreat with sidewall room to spare. Youth sports clubs and training gyms fit batting cages, pitching tunnels.
Starting from your selected configuration$109,800$125,150Save $15,350
or as low as $2288/mo · 0% APR · No credit RTO
ℹ️This is an estimate. Final pricing is locked after our sales team reviews your complete requirements (site access, ground type, county-specific certifications, optional upgrades). You’ll receive a written all-in quote within one business day of your request, no surprises, no hidden fees.
FREE delivery & installation in all 48 states. Concrete, asphalt, or compacted gravel.
SKU:SS-100X60-INDOOR-SPORTS-FABuilt:1,847+Since: 2002Made in: 🇺🇸 USA
🛡️
A+
BBB Accredited
★
4.8/5
customer rating
⏱
Since 2004
In Business
🏠
15,000+
Buildings
🇺🇸
48
States Served
We’ve provided builds for
SPATIAL LAYOUT
See how 800 sq ft fits your open-arena layout.
100 feet wide × 60 feet long. Our 100×60 indoor sports facility fits 100-foot widths and 60-foot lengths to give you a comfortable hobby retreat with sidewall room to spare.
Court / Field · Sideline / Bench · Equipment storage
Court / Field at the front, sideline / bench in the middle, equipment storage at the rear. Youth sports clubs and training gyms fit batting cages, pitching tunnels, or a single basketball half-court plus training space into a 100×60.
💡 Pro tip:3 Cages End-to-End.
🎨 FREE 3D BUILDER
Build your 100×60 Indoor Sports Facility in 3D.
Design your building yourself in our free Sensei3D Designer, drag doors and windows where you want them, swap roof + trim colors, and see your spec from every angle. Save your design and email it to yourself for later.
Drag-and-drop doors, windows, walk-ins anywhere on the building
16 colors applied live to roof, walls, and trim, mix & match
Interior + exterior views of your spec, with measurements
Save your design and share it with your contractor or family
Auto-syncs to quote, what you build is what we price
All variants ship with free delivery, installation, drawings, 20-year warranty.
🏗️
6,000 sq ft enclosed
Fully-enclosed 100×60 vertical-roof structure.
🚪
Roll-up + walk-in doors
Standard configuration door package.
🔩
14-gauge steel frame
American-rolled galvanized tubing.
🎨
1 standard color
Pick from 16 factory-baked finishes.
TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS
Indoor Sports Facility spec sheet.
Width100′
Length60′ + 6" overhang
Side height9′ standard
Floor space6,000 sq ft
Doors1 × 9×8 roll-up
Walk-inOptional (+$345)
WindowsOptional
Windup to 180 mph
Snowup to 65 psf
RoofVertical 3:12
Frame14 ga (12 ga upgrade)
Sheeting29 ga (26 ga upgrade)
AnchoringConcrete · Asphalt · Ground
Lead time3 – 5 weeks
USE CASE EXAMPLES
How real buyers use Indoor Sports Facility.
DAILY USE
Everyday indoor sports facility
6,000 sq ft is the right size for daily use of a indoor sports facility.
STORAGE OVERFLOW
indoor sports facility + seasonal storage
Park or store equipment in the front half, leave the rear for seasonal storage and overflow.
FLEX ROOM
Expansion-ready
Stud-framed interior makes it easy to add a partition, electrical, or insulation later.
FULL PRODUCT DETAILS
100×60 Indoor Sports Facility, what makes it different.
6,000sq ft
Floor Space
180mph
Wind Rated
65psf
Snow Load
20yr
Rust Warranty
40yr
Paint Warranty
$2288/mo
From RTO
🏗️
Engineered for your county
Every 100×60 indoor sports facility is fabricated from American-rolled galvanized steel and engineered against the exact wind and snow loads your jurisdiction requires.
Standard: 140 mph wind / 35 psf snow
12-ga upgrade: 180 mph / 65 psf
Permit drawings stamped and emailed free
🔩
Construction details
The same materials commercial fabricators use, not residential-grade. Hot-dip galvanized fasteners, factory-baked siliconized polyester paint, Hilti-grade anchors.
Frame: 14-ga (12-ga upgrade) galvanized tubing
Panels: 29-ga G-90 (26-ga upgrade)
Fasteners: #14 self-drilling with EPDM washer
🚚
Free delivery & install, really free
Regional-route delivery plus 1–2 day on-site installation by a certified crew, bundled into your headline price. No hidden unloading fees, fuel surcharges, or site-prep charges.
$0 deposit · pay only after walkthrough sign-off
3–5 week lead time on regional routes
All 48 states · rush option available
🛡️
Warranty & lifespan
Engineered for a 50-year service life with industry-leading warranties on every wear surface.
20-yr rust-through warranty on frame & panels
40-yr paint warranty against fading + chalking
1-yr craftsmanship on installation
💳
$0-down financing
Three financing paths to fit any credit situation. The rent-to-own option requires no credit pull at all, fastest path to a closed deal.
RTO: $2288/mo, no credit check, 36–60 mo
Financing: 0% promo APR · 84 mo term
Cash discount: 4% on $10K+ orders
⚡
Why 100×60?
6,000 sq ft sits in the sweet spot for residential and light-commercial, fits standard quarter-acre setbacks, comfortably below the 1,000 sq ft municipal threshold that triggers extra inspections.
100′ × 60′ footprint with 6,000 sq ft interior
Permit-friendly in 96% of US counties
Resale ROI $48,000–$72,000 added home value
PEOPLE ALSO ASK
Common questions from Indoor Sports Facility shoppers.
The questions our team hears every week. Click any to expand the short answer.
How thick is the steel on a Steel and Stud 100×60 metal building?
Standard frame: 14-gauge (1.5 mm) galvanized tubing. Optional 12-gauge upgrade (2.5 mm) for high-wind/snow zones. Roof and wall sheeting ships 29-gauge standard, 26-gauge upgrade available on order.
Does Steel and Stud deliver and install in my state?
Yes, free delivery and free installation in all 48 continental states, performed by certified Steel and Stud crews. Hawaii and Alaska use custom freight quotes; call 1-877-275-7048 for either.
What’s the typical lead time for a 100×60 building?
Standard: 3–5 weeks from order confirmation to install completion. Fabrication runs the first 2–3 weeks at our US plant; regional delivery and 1-2 day install close it out. Rush builds available for $345.
Can I finance a Steel and Stud building without a credit check?
Yes, Steel and Stud’s rent-to-own partner does not pull credit. Approvals typically run 8 minutes with proof of income and first month’s payment. 36–60 month terms, no early-payoff penalty.
What’s covered under the 20-year warranty?
Steel and Stud’s 20-year rust-through warranty covers the galvanized frame against perforation, plus a 20-year paint-finish warranty against fade and chalk. Workmanship on the install is warrantied for 1 year. Warranty transfers to the next owner on resale.
CUSTOMER REVIEWS
What real 100×60 Indoor Sports Facility buyers say.
⭐
No reviews yet for the 100×60 Indoor Sports Facility
Be the first verified buyer to share your experience. Honest reviews help other steel-building shoppers make a confident decision.
How much does a 100×60 indoor sports facility cost?
A 100×60 indoor sports facility from Steel and Stud starts at $109,800 with free delivery and free installation across all 48 states. Most buyers pick the rent-to-own option at about $2288/month with $0 down and no credit check. Call 1-877-275-7048 for a same-day price lock.
Is delivery and installation included in the 100×60 indoor sports facility price?
Yes, every Steel and Stud indoor sports facility ships with free delivery + free installation by a certified crew, included in the listed price. Anchored to a concrete pad, asphalt, or compacted gravel, your building is fully erected in 1–2 days after the truck arrives.
Do I need a permit for a 100×60 indoor sports facility?
Almost always for 6,000+ sq ft enclosed buildings. Steel and Stud emails engineered drawings stamped for your wind zone (up to 180 mph) and snow zone (up to 65 psf) at no charge, so your local building department has everything it needs. Permit timing typically runs 2–6 weeks by jurisdiction.
How is a Steel and Stud indoor sports facility different from a wood-frame build?
Steel solves the problems wood creates, no rotting, no termites, no warping, no painting every 3 years. Our 14-gauge galvanized frame carries a 20-year rust warranty and ships with a 180 mph wind / 65 psf snow rating already engineered in. A comparable wood build typically costs 2–3× more and needs ongoing maintenance.
What foundation does a 100×60 indoor sports facility need?
A 4-inch concrete pad poured 1 foot wider and longer than the building is the standard. Steel and Stud also anchors to asphalt or compacted gravel for open or semi-enclosed configurations. A pad-pour bundle is offered at checkout if you don’t already have a slab.
How fast can I get a 100×60 indoor sports facility delivered?
Standard lead time is 3–5 weeks from order to install. Fabrication runs the first 2–3 weeks at our US plant; regional delivery + 1–2-day install by a certified Steel and Stud crew closes out the order. Rush builds are available, call 1-877-275-7048 for current capacity.
Can I finance a 100×60 indoor sports facility without a credit check?
Yes, Steel and Stud’s rent-to-own partner does not pull credit. Approvals close in about 8 minutes with proof of income and your first month’s payment. Terms run 36–60 months with no early-payoff penalty, and the monthly works out to roughly $2288/month on a 100×60 indoor sports facility.
What warranty comes with the 100×60 indoor sports facility?
Steel and Stud backs every building with a 20-year rust-through warranty on the galvanized frame and a 10-year sheeting warranty on the 29-gauge panels (upgradeable to 26-gauge or 12-gauge). Workmanship on the install is warrantied for 1 year. Full warranty terms ship with your order packet.
Can I customize the 100×60 indoor sports facility in 3D before I order?
Yes, our free Sensei3D Designer lets you drag and drop doors, windows, and walk-ins; swap 16 roof + trim colors live; and rotate the building in 3D from every angle. No login required. The design saves directly to a quote so what you build is exactly what we price.
Can I insulate the 100×60 indoor sports facility for year-round use?
Yes, Steel and Stud offers R-13 wall + R-19 ceiling insulation packages, and the interior is drywall-ready. Most owners finish a indoor sports facility to a livable retreat in 2–3 weekends. Add a mini-split HVAC at checkout for full four-season comfort.
Ready to build?
Your Indoor Sports Facility quote takes one minute.
Tell us your zip and the options you want. We’ll send back a same-day, all-in price.
6,000 sq ft for commercial warehouse, hay barn, or fabrication shop
100′ x 60′14 GaugeLocal Certification Available
Pre-engineered 100×60 steel building delivers 6,000 sq ft of column-free space. Galvanized 14-gauge tubular frame, vertical roof, and certified wind and snow load ratings. Customize doors, windows, colors, eave height, and certifications in our free 3D builder.
Leg height adjustable up to 20'
$109,800.00
Free Delivery & Install RTO from /mo — No credit check
6,000 sq ft for commercial warehouse, hay barn, or fabrication shop
100′ x 60′14 GaugeLocal Certification Available
Pre-engineered 100×60 steel building delivers 6,000 sq ft of column-free space. Galvanized 14-gauge tubular frame, vertical roof, and certified wind and snow load ratings. Customize doors, windows, colors, eave height, and certifications in our free 3D builder.
100×60 Cold Storage Building | Steel and Stud, From $112,050
100×60 Cold Storage Building, rated for heavy-duty industrial loads.
100×60 delivers 6000 sq ft of heavy-duty cold storage building space. Produce packers, meat processors, and beverage distributors use the 100×60 as a refrigerated shell with insulated metal panels. 4,6000 sq ft holds.
Starting from your selected configuration$112,050$127,750Save $15,700
or as low as $2334/mo · 0% APR · No credit RTO
ℹ️This is an estimate. Final pricing is locked after our sales team reviews your complete requirements (site access, ground type, county-specific certifications, optional upgrades). You’ll receive a written all-in quote within one business day of your request, no surprises, no hidden fees.
Multi-dock loading bays at the front, high-bay racking aisles in the middle, office mezzanine + break + restrooms at the rear. Capacity: ~120 pallet positions, full forklift ops. Produce packers, meat processors, and beverage distributors use the 100×60 as a refrigerated shell with insulated metal panels.
💡 Pro tip:200 Pallet Capacity. Size affords: multiple dock doors, mezzanine office, in-rack sprinklers.
🎨 FREE 3D BUILDER
Build your 100×60 Cold Storage Building in 3D.
Design your building yourself in our free Sensei3D Designer, drag doors and windows where you want them, swap roof + trim colors, and see your spec from every angle. Save your design and email it to yourself for later.
Drag-and-drop doors, windows, walk-ins anywhere on the building
16 colors applied live to roof, walls, and trim, mix & match
Interior + exterior views of your spec, with measurements
Save your design and share it with your contractor or family
Auto-syncs to quote, what you build is what we price
All variants ship with free delivery, installation, drawings, 20-year warranty.
🏗️
6,000 sq ft enclosed
Fully-enclosed 100×60 vertical-roof structure.
🚪
Roll-up + walk-in doors
Standard configuration door package.
🔩
14-gauge steel frame
American-rolled galvanized tubing.
🎨
1 standard color
Pick from 16 factory-baked finishes.
TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS
Cold Storage Building spec sheet.
Width100′
Length60′ + 6" overhang
Side height9′ standard
Floor space6,000 sq ft
Doors1 × 9×8 roll-up
Walk-inOptional (+$345)
WindowsOptional
Windup to 180 mph
Snowup to 65 psf
RoofVertical 3:12
Frame14 ga (12 ga upgrade)
Sheeting29 ga (26 ga upgrade)
AnchoringConcrete · Asphalt · Ground
Lead time3 – 5 weeks
USE CASE EXAMPLES
How real buyers use Cold Storage Building.
DAILY USE
Everyday cold storage building
6,000 sq ft is the right size for daily use of a cold storage building.
STORAGE OVERFLOW
cold storage building + seasonal storage
Park or store equipment in the front half, leave the rear for seasonal storage and overflow.
FLEX ROOM
Expansion-ready
Stud-framed interior makes it easy to add a partition, electrical, or insulation later.
FULL PRODUCT DETAILS
100×60 Cold Storage Building, what makes it different.
6,000sq ft
Floor Space
180mph
Wind Rated
65psf
Snow Load
20yr
Rust Warranty
40yr
Paint Warranty
$2334/mo
From RTO
🏗️
Engineered for your county
Every 100×60 cold storage building is fabricated from American-rolled galvanized steel and engineered against the exact wind and snow loads your jurisdiction requires.
Standard: 140 mph wind / 35 psf snow
12-ga upgrade: 180 mph / 65 psf
Permit drawings stamped and emailed free
🔩
Construction details
The same materials commercial fabricators use, not residential-grade. Hot-dip galvanized fasteners, factory-baked siliconized polyester paint, Hilti-grade anchors.
Frame: 14-ga (12-ga upgrade) galvanized tubing
Panels: 29-ga G-90 (26-ga upgrade)
Fasteners: #14 self-drilling with EPDM washer
🚚
Free delivery & install, really free
Regional-route delivery plus 1–2 day on-site installation by a certified crew, bundled into your headline price. No hidden unloading fees, fuel surcharges, or site-prep charges.
$0 deposit · pay only after walkthrough sign-off
3–5 week lead time on regional routes
All 48 states · rush option available
🛡️
Warranty & lifespan
Engineered for a 50-year service life with industry-leading warranties on every wear surface.
20-yr rust-through warranty on frame & panels
40-yr paint warranty against fading + chalking
1-yr craftsmanship on installation
💳
$0-down financing
Three financing paths to fit any credit situation. The rent-to-own option requires no credit pull at all, fastest path to a closed deal.
RTO: $2334/mo, no credit check, 36–60 mo
Financing: 0% promo APR · 84 mo term
Cash discount: 4% on $10K+ orders
⚡
Why 100×60?
6,000 sq ft sits in the sweet spot for residential and light-commercial, fits standard quarter-acre setbacks, comfortably below the 1,000 sq ft municipal threshold that triggers extra inspections.
100′ × 60′ footprint with 6,000 sq ft interior
Permit-friendly in 96% of US counties
Resale ROI $48,000–$72,000 added home value
PEOPLE ALSO ASK
Common questions from Cold Storage Building shoppers.
The questions our team hears every week. Click any to expand the short answer.
How thick is the steel on a Steel and Stud 100×60 metal building?
Standard frame: 14-gauge (1.5 mm) galvanized tubing. Optional 12-gauge upgrade (2.5 mm) for high-wind/snow zones. Roof and wall sheeting ships 29-gauge standard, 26-gauge upgrade available on order.
Does Steel and Stud deliver and install in my state?
Yes, free delivery and free installation in all 48 continental states, performed by certified Steel and Stud crews. Hawaii and Alaska use custom freight quotes; call 1-877-275-7048 for either.
What’s the typical lead time for a 100×60 building?
Standard: 3–5 weeks from order confirmation to install completion. Fabrication runs the first 2–3 weeks at our US plant; regional delivery and 1-2 day install close it out. Rush builds available for $345.
Can I finance a Steel and Stud building without a credit check?
Yes, Steel and Stud’s rent-to-own partner does not pull credit. Approvals typically run 8 minutes with proof of income and first month’s payment. 36–60 month terms, no early-payoff penalty.
What’s covered under the 20-year warranty?
Steel and Stud’s 20-year rust-through warranty covers the galvanized frame against perforation, plus a 20-year paint-finish warranty against fade and chalk. Workmanship on the install is warrantied for 1 year. Warranty transfers to the next owner on resale.
CUSTOMER REVIEWS
What real 100×60 Cold Storage Building buyers say.
⭐
No reviews yet for the 100×60 Cold Storage Building
Be the first verified buyer to share your experience. Honest reviews help other steel-building shoppers make a confident decision.
How much does a 100×60 cold storage building cost?
A 100×60 cold storage building from Steel and Stud starts at $112,050 with free delivery and free installation across all 48 states. Most buyers pick the rent-to-own option at about $2334/month with $0 down and no credit check. Call 1-877-275-7048 for a same-day price lock.
Is delivery and installation included in the 100×60 cold storage building price?
Yes, every Steel and Stud cold storage building ships with free delivery + free installation by a certified crew, included in the listed price. Anchored to a concrete pad, asphalt, or compacted gravel, your building is fully erected in 1–2 days after the truck arrives.
Do I need a permit for a 100×60 cold storage building?
Almost always for 6,000+ sq ft enclosed buildings. Steel and Stud emails engineered drawings stamped for your wind zone (up to 180 mph) and snow zone (up to 65 psf) at no charge, so your local building department has everything it needs. Permit timing typically runs 2–6 weeks by jurisdiction.
How is a Steel and Stud cold storage building different from a wood-frame build?
Steel solves the problems wood creates, no rotting, no termites, no warping, no painting every 3 years. Our 14-gauge galvanized frame carries a 20-year rust warranty and ships with a 180 mph wind / 65 psf snow rating already engineered in. A comparable wood build typically costs 2–3× more and needs ongoing maintenance.
What foundation does a 100×60 cold storage building need?
A 4-inch concrete pad poured 1 foot wider and longer than the building is the standard. Steel and Stud also anchors to asphalt or compacted gravel for open or semi-enclosed configurations. A pad-pour bundle is offered at checkout if you don’t already have a slab.
How fast can I get a 100×60 cold storage building delivered?
Standard lead time is 3–5 weeks from order to install. Fabrication runs the first 2–3 weeks at our US plant; regional delivery + 1–2-day install by a certified Steel and Stud crew closes out the order. Rush builds are available, call 1-877-275-7048 for current capacity.
Can I finance a 100×60 cold storage building without a credit check?
Yes, Steel and Stud’s rent-to-own partner does not pull credit. Approvals close in about 8 minutes with proof of income and your first month’s payment. Terms run 36–60 months with no early-payoff penalty, and the monthly works out to roughly $2334/month on a 100×60 cold storage building.
What warranty comes with the 100×60 cold storage building?
Steel and Stud backs every building with a 20-year rust-through warranty on the galvanized frame and a 10-year sheeting warranty on the 29-gauge panels (upgradeable to 26-gauge or 12-gauge). Workmanship on the install is warrantied for 1 year. Full warranty terms ship with your order packet.
Can I customize the 100×60 cold storage building in 3D before I order?
Yes, our free Sensei3D Designer lets you drag and drop doors, windows, and walk-ins; swap 16 roof + trim colors live; and rotate the building in 3D from every angle. No login required. The design saves directly to a quote so what you build is exactly what we price.
Will the 100×60 cold storage building handle heavy equipment and forklifts?
Standard 100×60 cold storage building ships rated for 35 psf live load on the floor (over concrete pad), and the 12-gauge frame upgrade supports trolley- and jib-crane mounts up to 1-ton capacity. Steel and Stud engineers will spec heavier rigging on request, call 1-877-275-7048.
Ready to build?
Your Cold Storage Building quote takes one minute.
Tell us your zip and the options you want. We’ll send back a same-day, all-in price.
6,000 sq ft for commercial warehouse, hay barn, or fabrication shop
100′ x 60′14 GaugeLocal Certification Available
Pre-engineered 100×60 steel building delivers 6,000 sq ft of column-free space. Galvanized 14-gauge tubular frame, vertical roof, and certified wind and snow load ratings. Customize doors, windows, colors, eave height, and certifications in our free 3D builder.
Leg height adjustable up to 20'
$112,050.00
Free Delivery & Install RTO from /mo — No credit check
7,000 sq ft for commercial warehouse, hay barn, or fabrication shop
100′ x 70′14 GaugeLocal Certification Available
Pre-engineered 100×70 steel building delivers 7,000 sq ft of column-free space. Galvanized 14-gauge tubular frame, vertical roof, and certified wind and snow load ratings. Customize doors, windows, colors, eave height, and certifications in our free 3D builder.
100×70 Distribution Center | Steel and Stud, From $130,000
100×70 Distribution Center, engineered for code-compliant business use.
Fleet operators spec a 100×70 distribution center kit with two dock-high roll-ups and one drive-in door. The 7,000 sq ft floor holds 80+ pallet positions plus a 600 sq ft office mezzanine. ASCE 7-22 wind/snow.
Starting from your selected configuration$130,000$148,200Save $18,200
or as low as $2708/mo · 0% APR · No credit RTO
ℹ️This is an estimate. Final pricing is locked after our sales team reviews your complete requirements (site access, ground type, county-specific certifications, optional upgrades). You’ll receive a written all-in quote within one business day of your request, no surprises, no hidden fees.
FREE delivery & installation in all 48 states. Concrete, asphalt, or compacted gravel.
SKU:SS-100X70-DISTRIBUTION-CENBuilt:1,847+Since: 2002Made in: 🇺🇸 USA
🛡️
A+
BBB Accredited
★
4.8/5
customer rating
⏱
Since 2004
In Business
🏠
15,000+
Buildings
🇺🇸
48
States Served
We’ve provided builds for
SPATIAL LAYOUT
See how 800 sq ft fits your distribution facility.
100 feet wide × 70 feet long. Column-free clear span; 18-ft+ height for 5-tier racking. Fleet operators spec a 100×70 distribution center kit with two dock-high roll-ups and one drive-in door.
Multi-dock loading bays at the front, high-bay racking aisles in the middle, office mezzanine + break + restrooms at the rear. Capacity: ~140 pallet positions, full forklift ops. The 7,000 sq ft floor holds 80+ pallet positions plus a 600 sq ft office mezzanine.
💡 Pro tip:80+ Pallet Positions. Size affords: multiple dock doors, mezzanine office, in-rack sprinklers.
🎨 FREE 3D BUILDER
Build your 100×70 Distribution Center in 3D.
Design your building yourself in our free Sensei3D Designer, drag doors and windows where you want them, swap roof + trim colors, and see your spec from every angle. Save your design and email it to yourself for later.
Drag-and-drop doors, windows, walk-ins anywhere on the building
16 colors applied live to roof, walls, and trim, mix & match
Interior + exterior views of your spec, with measurements
Save your design and share it with your contractor or family
Auto-syncs to quote, what you build is what we price
All variants ship with free delivery, installation, drawings, 20-year warranty.
🏗️
7,000 sq ft enclosed
Fully-enclosed 100×70 vertical-roof structure.
🚪
Roll-up + walk-in doors
Standard configuration door package.
🔩
14-gauge steel frame
American-rolled galvanized tubing.
🎨
1 standard color
Pick from 16 factory-baked finishes.
TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS
Distribution Center spec sheet.
Width100′
Length70′ + 6" overhang
Side height9′ standard
Floor space7,000 sq ft
Doors1 × 9×8 roll-up
Walk-inOptional (+$345)
WindowsOptional
Windup to 180 mph
Snowup to 65 psf
RoofVertical 3:12
Frame14 ga (12 ga upgrade)
Sheeting29 ga (26 ga upgrade)
AnchoringConcrete · Asphalt · Ground
Lead time3 – 5 weeks
USE CASE EXAMPLES
How real buyers use Distribution Center.
DAILY USE
Everyday distribution center
7,000 sq ft is the right size for daily use of a distribution center.
STORAGE OVERFLOW
distribution center + seasonal storage
Park or store equipment in the front half, leave the rear for seasonal storage and overflow.
FLEX ROOM
Expansion-ready
Stud-framed interior makes it easy to add a partition, electrical, or insulation later.
FULL PRODUCT DETAILS
100×70 Distribution Center, what makes it different.
7,000sq ft
Floor Space
180mph
Wind Rated
65psf
Snow Load
20yr
Rust Warranty
40yr
Paint Warranty
$2708/mo
From RTO
🏗️
Engineered for your county
Every 100×70 distribution center is fabricated from American-rolled galvanized steel and engineered against the exact wind and snow loads your jurisdiction requires.
Standard: 140 mph wind / 35 psf snow
12-ga upgrade: 180 mph / 65 psf
Permit drawings stamped and emailed free
🔩
Construction details
The same materials commercial fabricators use, not residential-grade. Hot-dip galvanized fasteners, factory-baked siliconized polyester paint, Hilti-grade anchors.
Frame: 14-ga (12-ga upgrade) galvanized tubing
Panels: 29-ga G-90 (26-ga upgrade)
Fasteners: #14 self-drilling with EPDM washer
🚚
Free delivery & install, really free
Regional-route delivery plus 1–2 day on-site installation by a certified crew, bundled into your headline price. No hidden unloading fees, fuel surcharges, or site-prep charges.
$0 deposit · pay only after walkthrough sign-off
3–5 week lead time on regional routes
All 48 states · rush option available
🛡️
Warranty & lifespan
Engineered for a 50-year service life with industry-leading warranties on every wear surface.
20-yr rust-through warranty on frame & panels
40-yr paint warranty against fading + chalking
1-yr craftsmanship on installation
💳
$0-down financing
Three financing paths to fit any credit situation. The rent-to-own option requires no credit pull at all, fastest path to a closed deal.
RTO: $2708/mo, no credit check, 36–60 mo
Financing: 0% promo APR · 84 mo term
Cash discount: 4% on $10K+ orders
⚡
Why 100×70?
7,000 sq ft sits in the sweet spot for residential and light-commercial, fits standard quarter-acre setbacks, comfortably below the 1,000 sq ft municipal threshold that triggers extra inspections.
100′ × 70′ footprint with 7,000 sq ft interior
Permit-friendly in 96% of US counties
Resale ROI $56,000–$84,000 added home value
PEOPLE ALSO ASK
Common questions from Distribution Center shoppers.
The questions our team hears every week. Click any to expand the short answer.
How thick is the steel on a Steel and Stud 100×70 metal building?
Standard frame: 14-gauge (1.5 mm) galvanized tubing. Optional 12-gauge upgrade (2.5 mm) for high-wind/snow zones. Roof and wall sheeting ships 29-gauge standard, 26-gauge upgrade available on order.
Does Steel and Stud deliver and install in my state?
Yes, free delivery and free installation in all 48 continental states, performed by certified Steel and Stud crews. Hawaii and Alaska use custom freight quotes; call 1-877-275-7048 for either.
What’s the typical lead time for a 100×70 building?
Standard: 3–5 weeks from order confirmation to install completion. Fabrication runs the first 2–3 weeks at our US plant; regional delivery and 1-2 day install close it out. Rush builds available for $345.
Can I finance a Steel and Stud building without a credit check?
Yes, Steel and Stud’s rent-to-own partner does not pull credit. Approvals typically run 8 minutes with proof of income and first month’s payment. 36–60 month terms, no early-payoff penalty.
What’s covered under the 20-year warranty?
Steel and Stud’s 20-year rust-through warranty covers the galvanized frame against perforation, plus a 20-year paint-finish warranty against fade and chalk. Workmanship on the install is warrantied for 1 year. Warranty transfers to the next owner on resale.
CUSTOMER REVIEWS
What real 100×70 Distribution Center buyers say.
⭐
No reviews yet for the 100×70 Distribution Center
Be the first verified buyer to share your experience. Honest reviews help other steel-building shoppers make a confident decision.
A 100×70 distribution center from Steel and Stud starts at $130,000 with free delivery and free installation across all 48 states. Most buyers pick the rent-to-own option at about $2708/month with $0 down and no credit check. Call 1-877-275-7048 for a same-day price lock.
Is delivery and installation included in the 100×70 distribution center price?
Yes, every Steel and Stud distribution center ships with free delivery + free installation by a certified crew, included in the listed price. Anchored to a concrete pad, asphalt, or compacted gravel, your building is fully erected in 1–2 days after the truck arrives.
Do I need a permit for a 100×70 distribution center?
Almost always for 7,000+ sq ft enclosed buildings. Steel and Stud emails engineered drawings stamped for your wind zone (up to 180 mph) and snow zone (up to 65 psf) at no charge, so your local building department has everything it needs. Permit timing typically runs 2–6 weeks by jurisdiction.
How is a Steel and Stud distribution center different from a wood-frame build?
Steel solves the problems wood creates, no rotting, no termites, no warping, no painting every 3 years. Our 14-gauge galvanized frame carries a 20-year rust warranty and ships with a 180 mph wind / 65 psf snow rating already engineered in. A comparable wood build typically costs 2–3× more and needs ongoing maintenance.
What foundation does a 100×70 distribution center need?
A 4-inch concrete pad poured 1 foot wider and longer than the building is the standard. Steel and Stud also anchors to asphalt or compacted gravel for open or semi-enclosed configurations. A pad-pour bundle is offered at checkout if you don’t already have a slab.
How fast can I get a 100×70 distribution center delivered?
Standard lead time is 3–5 weeks from order to install. Fabrication runs the first 2–3 weeks at our US plant; regional delivery + 1–2-day install by a certified Steel and Stud crew closes out the order. Rush builds are available, call 1-877-275-7048 for current capacity.
Can I finance a 100×70 distribution center without a credit check?
Yes, Steel and Stud’s rent-to-own partner does not pull credit. Approvals close in about 8 minutes with proof of income and your first month’s payment. Terms run 36–60 months with no early-payoff penalty, and the monthly works out to roughly $2708/month on a 100×70 distribution center.
What warranty comes with the 100×70 distribution center?
Steel and Stud backs every building with a 20-year rust-through warranty on the galvanized frame and a 10-year sheeting warranty on the 29-gauge panels (upgradeable to 26-gauge or 12-gauge). Workmanship on the install is warrantied for 1 year. Full warranty terms ship with your order packet.
Can I customize the 100×70 distribution center in 3D before I order?
Yes, our free Sensei3D Designer lets you drag and drop doors, windows, and walk-ins; swap 16 roof + trim colors live; and rotate the building in 3D from every angle. No login required. The design saves directly to a quote so what you build is exactly what we price.
Does the 100×70 distribution center meet IBC commercial code?
Yes. Steel and Stud’s 12-gauge frame upgrade and 26-gauge sheeting both meet IBC commercial standards, and most counties accept our stamped drawings without revision. Engineered loads ship with the order, typical certified specs are 180 mph wind / 65 psf snow.
Ready to build?
Your Distribution Center quote takes one minute.
Tell us your zip and the options you want. We’ll send back a same-day, all-in price.
7,000 sq ft for commercial warehouse, hay barn, or fabrication shop
100′ x 70′14 GaugeLocal Certification Available
Pre-engineered 100×70 steel building delivers 7,000 sq ft of column-free space. Galvanized 14-gauge tubular frame, vertical roof, and certified wind and snow load ratings. Customize doors, windows, colors, eave height, and certifications in our free 3D builder.
Leg height adjustable up to 20'
$130,000.00
Free Delivery & Install RTO from /mo — No credit check
7,000 sq ft for commercial warehouse, hay barn, or fabrication shop
100′ x 70′14 GaugeLocal Certification Available
Pre-engineered 100×70 steel building delivers 7,000 sq ft of column-free space. Galvanized 14-gauge tubular frame, vertical roof, and certified wind and snow load ratings. Customize doors, windows, colors, eave height, and certifications in our free 3D builder.
100×70 Warehouse Steel Building | Steel and Stud, From $130,400
100×70 Warehouse Steel Building, rated for heavy-duty industrial loads.
Our 100×70 warehouse steel building fits 100-foot widths and 70-foot lengths to give you a heavy-gauge frame rated for forklifts and machinery. At 9,7000 sq ft you fit roughly 1,400 standard pallet positions on.
Starting from your selected configuration$130,400$148,650Save $18,250
or as low as $2717/mo · 0% APR · No credit RTO
ℹ️This is an estimate. Final pricing is locked after our sales team reviews your complete requirements (site access, ground type, county-specific certifications, optional upgrades). You’ll receive a written all-in quote within one business day of your request, no surprises, no hidden fees.
FREE delivery & installation in all 48 states. Concrete, asphalt, or compacted gravel.
SKU:SS-100X70-WAREHOUSE-STEEL-Built:1,847+Since: 2002Made in: 🇺🇸 USA
🛡️
A+
BBB Accredited
★
4.8/5
customer rating
⏱
Since 2004
In Business
🏠
15,000+
Buildings
🇺🇸
48
States Served
We’ve provided builds for
SPATIAL LAYOUT
See how 800 sq ft fits your distribution facility.
100 feet wide × 70 feet long. Column-free clear span; 18-ft+ height for 5-tier racking. Our 100×70 warehouse steel building fits 100-foot widths and 70-foot lengths to give you a heavy-gauge frame rated for forklifts and machinery.
Multi-dock loading bays at the front, high-bay racking aisles in the middle, office mezzanine + break + restrooms at the rear. Capacity: ~140 pallet positions, full forklift ops. At 9,7000 sq ft you fit roughly 1,400 standard pallet positions on selective racking with room for a small office build-out.
💡 Pro tip:1,400 Pallet Positions. Size affords: multiple dock doors, mezzanine office, in-rack sprinklers.
🎨 FREE 3D BUILDER
Build your 100×70 Warehouse Steel Building in 3D.
Design your building yourself in our free Sensei3D Designer, drag doors and windows where you want them, swap roof + trim colors, and see your spec from every angle. Save your design and email it to yourself for later.
Drag-and-drop doors, windows, walk-ins anywhere on the building
16 colors applied live to roof, walls, and trim, mix & match
Interior + exterior views of your spec, with measurements
Save your design and share it with your contractor or family
Auto-syncs to quote, what you build is what we price
All variants ship with free delivery, installation, drawings, 20-year warranty.
🏗️
7,000 sq ft enclosed
Fully-enclosed 100×70 vertical-roof structure.
🚪
Roll-up + walk-in doors
Standard configuration door package.
🔩
14-gauge steel frame
American-rolled galvanized tubing.
🎨
1 standard color
Pick from 16 factory-baked finishes.
TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS
Warehouse Steel Building spec sheet.
Width100′
Length70′ + 6" overhang
Side height9′ standard
Floor space7,000 sq ft
Doors1 × 9×8 roll-up
Walk-inOptional (+$345)
WindowsOptional
Windup to 180 mph
Snowup to 65 psf
RoofVertical 3:12
Frame14 ga (12 ga upgrade)
Sheeting29 ga (26 ga upgrade)
AnchoringConcrete · Asphalt · Ground
Lead time3 – 5 weeks
USE CASE EXAMPLES
How real buyers use Warehouse Steel Building.
DAILY USE
Everyday warehouse steel building
7,000 sq ft is the right size for daily use of a warehouse steel building.
STORAGE OVERFLOW
warehouse steel building + seasonal storage
Park or store equipment in the front half, leave the rear for seasonal storage and overflow.
FLEX ROOM
Expansion-ready
Stud-framed interior makes it easy to add a partition, electrical, or insulation later.
FULL PRODUCT DETAILS
100×70 Warehouse Steel Building, what makes it different.
7,000sq ft
Floor Space
180mph
Wind Rated
65psf
Snow Load
20yr
Rust Warranty
40yr
Paint Warranty
$2717/mo
From RTO
🏗️
Engineered for your county
Every 100×70 warehouse steel building is fabricated from American-rolled galvanized steel and engineered against the exact wind and snow loads your jurisdiction requires.
Standard: 140 mph wind / 35 psf snow
12-ga upgrade: 180 mph / 65 psf
Permit drawings stamped and emailed free
🔩
Construction details
The same materials commercial fabricators use, not residential-grade. Hot-dip galvanized fasteners, factory-baked siliconized polyester paint, Hilti-grade anchors.
Frame: 14-ga (12-ga upgrade) galvanized tubing
Panels: 29-ga G-90 (26-ga upgrade)
Fasteners: #14 self-drilling with EPDM washer
🚚
Free delivery & install, really free
Regional-route delivery plus 1–2 day on-site installation by a certified crew, bundled into your headline price. No hidden unloading fees, fuel surcharges, or site-prep charges.
$0 deposit · pay only after walkthrough sign-off
3–5 week lead time on regional routes
All 48 states · rush option available
🛡️
Warranty & lifespan
Engineered for a 50-year service life with industry-leading warranties on every wear surface.
20-yr rust-through warranty on frame & panels
40-yr paint warranty against fading + chalking
1-yr craftsmanship on installation
💳
$0-down financing
Three financing paths to fit any credit situation. The rent-to-own option requires no credit pull at all, fastest path to a closed deal.
RTO: $2717/mo, no credit check, 36–60 mo
Financing: 0% promo APR · 84 mo term
Cash discount: 4% on $10K+ orders
⚡
Why 100×70?
7,000 sq ft sits in the sweet spot for residential and light-commercial, fits standard quarter-acre setbacks, comfortably below the 1,000 sq ft municipal threshold that triggers extra inspections.
100′ × 70′ footprint with 7,000 sq ft interior
Permit-friendly in 96% of US counties
Resale ROI $56,000–$84,000 added home value
PEOPLE ALSO ASK
Common questions from Warehouse Steel Building shoppers.
The questions our team hears every week. Click any to expand the short answer.
How thick is the steel on a Steel and Stud 100×70 metal building?
Standard frame: 14-gauge (1.5 mm) galvanized tubing. Optional 12-gauge upgrade (2.5 mm) for high-wind/snow zones. Roof and wall sheeting ships 29-gauge standard, 26-gauge upgrade available on order.
Does Steel and Stud deliver and install in my state?
Yes, free delivery and free installation in all 48 continental states, performed by certified Steel and Stud crews. Hawaii and Alaska use custom freight quotes; call 1-877-275-7048 for either.
What’s the typical lead time for a 100×70 building?
Standard: 3–5 weeks from order confirmation to install completion. Fabrication runs the first 2–3 weeks at our US plant; regional delivery and 1-2 day install close it out. Rush builds available for $345.
Can I finance a Steel and Stud building without a credit check?
Yes, Steel and Stud’s rent-to-own partner does not pull credit. Approvals typically run 8 minutes with proof of income and first month’s payment. 36–60 month terms, no early-payoff penalty.
What’s covered under the 20-year warranty?
Steel and Stud’s 20-year rust-through warranty covers the galvanized frame against perforation, plus a 20-year paint-finish warranty against fade and chalk. Workmanship on the install is warrantied for 1 year. Warranty transfers to the next owner on resale.
CUSTOMER REVIEWS
What real 100×70 Warehouse Steel Building buyers say.
⭐
No reviews yet for the 100×70 Warehouse Steel Building
Be the first verified buyer to share your experience. Honest reviews help other steel-building shoppers make a confident decision.
How much does a 100×70 warehouse steel building cost?
A 100×70 warehouse steel building from Steel and Stud starts at $130,400 with free delivery and free installation across all 48 states. Most buyers pick the rent-to-own option at about $2717/month with $0 down and no credit check. Call 1-877-275-7048 for a same-day price lock.
Is delivery and installation included in the 100×70 warehouse steel building price?
Yes, every Steel and Stud warehouse steel building ships with free delivery + free installation by a certified crew, included in the listed price. Anchored to a concrete pad, asphalt, or compacted gravel, your building is fully erected in 1–2 days after the truck arrives.
Do I need a permit for a 100×70 warehouse steel building?
Almost always for 7,000+ sq ft enclosed buildings. Steel and Stud emails engineered drawings stamped for your wind zone (up to 180 mph) and snow zone (up to 65 psf) at no charge, so your local building department has everything it needs. Permit timing typically runs 2–6 weeks by jurisdiction.
How is a Steel and Stud warehouse steel building different from a wood-frame build?
Steel solves the problems wood creates, no rotting, no termites, no warping, no painting every 3 years. Our 14-gauge galvanized frame carries a 20-year rust warranty and ships with a 180 mph wind / 65 psf snow rating already engineered in. A comparable wood build typically costs 2–3× more and needs ongoing maintenance.
What foundation does a 100×70 warehouse steel building need?
A 4-inch concrete pad poured 1 foot wider and longer than the building is the standard. Steel and Stud also anchors to asphalt or compacted gravel for open or semi-enclosed configurations. A pad-pour bundle is offered at checkout if you don’t already have a slab.
How fast can I get a 100×70 warehouse steel building delivered?
Standard lead time is 3–5 weeks from order to install. Fabrication runs the first 2–3 weeks at our US plant; regional delivery + 1–2-day install by a certified Steel and Stud crew closes out the order. Rush builds are available, call 1-877-275-7048 for current capacity.
Can I finance a 100×70 warehouse steel building without a credit check?
Yes, Steel and Stud’s rent-to-own partner does not pull credit. Approvals close in about 8 minutes with proof of income and your first month’s payment. Terms run 36–60 months with no early-payoff penalty, and the monthly works out to roughly $2717/month on a 100×70 warehouse steel building.
What warranty comes with the 100×70 warehouse steel building?
Steel and Stud backs every building with a 20-year rust-through warranty on the galvanized frame and a 10-year sheeting warranty on the 29-gauge panels (upgradeable to 26-gauge or 12-gauge). Workmanship on the install is warrantied for 1 year. Full warranty terms ship with your order packet.
Can I customize the 100×70 warehouse steel building in 3D before I order?
Yes, our free Sensei3D Designer lets you drag and drop doors, windows, and walk-ins; swap 16 roof + trim colors live; and rotate the building in 3D from every angle. No login required. The design saves directly to a quote so what you build is exactly what we price.
Will the 100×70 warehouse steel building handle heavy equipment and forklifts?
Standard 100×70 warehouse steel building ships rated for 35 psf live load on the floor (over concrete pad), and the 12-gauge frame upgrade supports trolley- and jib-crane mounts up to 1-ton capacity. Steel and Stud engineers will spec heavier rigging on request, call 1-877-275-7048.
Ready to build?
Your Warehouse Steel Building quote takes one minute.
Tell us your zip and the options you want. We’ll send back a same-day, all-in price.
7,000 sq ft for commercial warehouse, hay barn, or fabrication shop
100′ x 70′14 GaugeLocal Certification Available
Pre-engineered 100×70 steel building delivers 7,000 sq ft of column-free space. Galvanized 14-gauge tubular frame, vertical roof, and certified wind and snow load ratings. Customize doors, windows, colors, eave height, and certifications in our free 3D builder.
Leg height adjustable up to 20'
$130,400.00
Free Delivery & Install RTO from /mo — No credit check
7,000 sq ft for commercial warehouse, hay barn, or fabrication shop
100′ x 70′14 GaugeLocal Certification Available
Pre-engineered 100×70 steel building delivers 7,000 sq ft of column-free space. Galvanized 14-gauge tubular frame, vertical roof, and certified wind and snow load ratings. Customize doors, windows, colors, eave height, and certifications in our free 3D builder.
100×70 Manufacturing Facility | Steel and Stud, From $130,400
100×70 Manufacturing Facility, rated for heavy-duty industrial loads.
Looking for a 100×70 manufacturing facility? At 7000 sq ft, this footprint suits fabrication, heavy machinery, or warehousing. Manufacturers configure the 100×70 PEMB for a full production line including CNC cells.
Starting from your selected configuration$130,400$148,650Save $18,250
or as low as $2717/mo · 0% APR · No credit RTO
ℹ️This is an estimate. Final pricing is locked after our sales team reviews your complete requirements (site access, ground type, county-specific certifications, optional upgrades). You’ll receive a written all-in quote within one business day of your request, no surprises, no hidden fees.
FREE delivery & installation in all 48 states. Concrete, asphalt, or compacted gravel.
SKU:SS-100X70-MANUFACTURING-FABuilt:1,847+Since: 2002Made in: 🇺🇸 USA
🛡️
A+
BBB Accredited
★
4.8/5
customer rating
⏱
Since 2004
In Business
🏠
15,000+
Buildings
🇺🇸
48
States Served
We’ve provided builds for
SPATIAL LAYOUT
See how 800 sq ft fits your fabrication-shop layout.
100 feet wide × 70 feet long. Looking for a 100×70 manufacturing facility? At 7000 sq ft, this footprint suits fabrication, heavy machinery, or warehousing.
Weld / fab bay · Material storage · Office / break
Weld / fab bay at the front, material storage in the middle, office / break at the rear. Manufacturers configure the 100×70 PEMB for a full production line including CNC cells, finishing bays, and QC stations, with no interior column to re-route conveyors around.
💡 Pro tip:Stamped Drawings.
🎨 FREE 3D BUILDER
Build your 100×70 Manufacturing Facility in 3D.
Design your building yourself in our free Sensei3D Designer, drag doors and windows where you want them, swap roof + trim colors, and see your spec from every angle. Save your design and email it to yourself for later.
Drag-and-drop doors, windows, walk-ins anywhere on the building
16 colors applied live to roof, walls, and trim, mix & match
Interior + exterior views of your spec, with measurements
Save your design and share it with your contractor or family
Auto-syncs to quote, what you build is what we price
All variants ship with free delivery, installation, drawings, 20-year warranty.
🏗️
7,000 sq ft enclosed
Fully-enclosed 100×70 vertical-roof structure.
🚪
Roll-up + walk-in doors
Standard configuration door package.
🔩
14-gauge steel frame
American-rolled galvanized tubing.
🎨
1 standard color
Pick from 16 factory-baked finishes.
TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS
Manufacturing Facility spec sheet.
Width100′
Length70′ + 6" overhang
Side height9′ standard
Floor space7,000 sq ft
Doors1 × 9×8 roll-up
Walk-inOptional (+$345)
WindowsOptional
Windup to 180 mph
Snowup to 65 psf
RoofVertical 3:12
Frame14 ga (12 ga upgrade)
Sheeting29 ga (26 ga upgrade)
AnchoringConcrete · Asphalt · Ground
Lead time3 – 5 weeks
USE CASE EXAMPLES
How real buyers use Manufacturing Facility.
DAILY USE
Everyday manufacturing facility
7,000 sq ft is the right size for daily use of a manufacturing facility.
STORAGE OVERFLOW
manufacturing facility + seasonal storage
Park or store equipment in the front half, leave the rear for seasonal storage and overflow.
FLEX ROOM
Expansion-ready
Stud-framed interior makes it easy to add a partition, electrical, or insulation later.
FULL PRODUCT DETAILS
100×70 Manufacturing Facility, what makes it different.
7,000sq ft
Floor Space
180mph
Wind Rated
65psf
Snow Load
20yr
Rust Warranty
40yr
Paint Warranty
$2717/mo
From RTO
🏗️
Engineered for your county
Every 100×70 manufacturing facility is fabricated from American-rolled galvanized steel and engineered against the exact wind and snow loads your jurisdiction requires.
Standard: 140 mph wind / 35 psf snow
12-ga upgrade: 180 mph / 65 psf
Permit drawings stamped and emailed free
🔩
Construction details
The same materials commercial fabricators use, not residential-grade. Hot-dip galvanized fasteners, factory-baked siliconized polyester paint, Hilti-grade anchors.
Frame: 14-ga (12-ga upgrade) galvanized tubing
Panels: 29-ga G-90 (26-ga upgrade)
Fasteners: #14 self-drilling with EPDM washer
🚚
Free delivery & install, really free
Regional-route delivery plus 1–2 day on-site installation by a certified crew, bundled into your headline price. No hidden unloading fees, fuel surcharges, or site-prep charges.
$0 deposit · pay only after walkthrough sign-off
3–5 week lead time on regional routes
All 48 states · rush option available
🛡️
Warranty & lifespan
Engineered for a 50-year service life with industry-leading warranties on every wear surface.
20-yr rust-through warranty on frame & panels
40-yr paint warranty against fading + chalking
1-yr craftsmanship on installation
💳
$0-down financing
Three financing paths to fit any credit situation. The rent-to-own option requires no credit pull at all, fastest path to a closed deal.
RTO: $2717/mo, no credit check, 36–60 mo
Financing: 0% promo APR · 84 mo term
Cash discount: 4% on $10K+ orders
⚡
Why 100×70?
7,000 sq ft sits in the sweet spot for residential and light-commercial, fits standard quarter-acre setbacks, comfortably below the 1,000 sq ft municipal threshold that triggers extra inspections.
100′ × 70′ footprint with 7,000 sq ft interior
Permit-friendly in 96% of US counties
Resale ROI $56,000–$84,000 added home value
PEOPLE ALSO ASK
Common questions from Manufacturing Facility shoppers.
The questions our team hears every week. Click any to expand the short answer.
How thick is the steel on a Steel and Stud 100×70 metal building?
Standard frame: 14-gauge (1.5 mm) galvanized tubing. Optional 12-gauge upgrade (2.5 mm) for high-wind/snow zones. Roof and wall sheeting ships 29-gauge standard, 26-gauge upgrade available on order.
Does Steel and Stud deliver and install in my state?
Yes, free delivery and free installation in all 48 continental states, performed by certified Steel and Stud crews. Hawaii and Alaska use custom freight quotes; call 1-877-275-7048 for either.
What’s the typical lead time for a 100×70 building?
Standard: 3–5 weeks from order confirmation to install completion. Fabrication runs the first 2–3 weeks at our US plant; regional delivery and 1-2 day install close it out. Rush builds available for $345.
Can I finance a Steel and Stud building without a credit check?
Yes, Steel and Stud’s rent-to-own partner does not pull credit. Approvals typically run 8 minutes with proof of income and first month’s payment. 36–60 month terms, no early-payoff penalty.
What’s covered under the 20-year warranty?
Steel and Stud’s 20-year rust-through warranty covers the galvanized frame against perforation, plus a 20-year paint-finish warranty against fade and chalk. Workmanship on the install is warrantied for 1 year. Warranty transfers to the next owner on resale.
CUSTOMER REVIEWS
What real 100×70 Manufacturing Facility buyers say.
⭐
No reviews yet for the 100×70 Manufacturing Facility
Be the first verified buyer to share your experience. Honest reviews help other steel-building shoppers make a confident decision.
How much does a 100×70 manufacturing facility cost?
A 100×70 manufacturing facility from Steel and Stud starts at $130,400 with free delivery and free installation across all 48 states. Most buyers pick the rent-to-own option at about $2717/month with $0 down and no credit check. Call 1-877-275-7048 for a same-day price lock.
Is delivery and installation included in the 100×70 manufacturing facility price?
Yes, every Steel and Stud manufacturing facility ships with free delivery + free installation by a certified crew, included in the listed price. Anchored to a concrete pad, asphalt, or compacted gravel, your building is fully erected in 1–2 days after the truck arrives.
Do I need a permit for a 100×70 manufacturing facility?
Almost always for 7,000+ sq ft enclosed buildings. Steel and Stud emails engineered drawings stamped for your wind zone (up to 180 mph) and snow zone (up to 65 psf) at no charge, so your local building department has everything it needs. Permit timing typically runs 2–6 weeks by jurisdiction.
How is a Steel and Stud manufacturing facility different from a wood-frame build?
Steel solves the problems wood creates, no rotting, no termites, no warping, no painting every 3 years. Our 14-gauge galvanized frame carries a 20-year rust warranty and ships with a 180 mph wind / 65 psf snow rating already engineered in. A comparable wood build typically costs 2–3× more and needs ongoing maintenance.
What foundation does a 100×70 manufacturing facility need?
A 4-inch concrete pad poured 1 foot wider and longer than the building is the standard. Steel and Stud also anchors to asphalt or compacted gravel for open or semi-enclosed configurations. A pad-pour bundle is offered at checkout if you don’t already have a slab.
How fast can I get a 100×70 manufacturing facility delivered?
Standard lead time is 3–5 weeks from order to install. Fabrication runs the first 2–3 weeks at our US plant; regional delivery + 1–2-day install by a certified Steel and Stud crew closes out the order. Rush builds are available, call 1-877-275-7048 for current capacity.
Can I finance a 100×70 manufacturing facility without a credit check?
Yes, Steel and Stud’s rent-to-own partner does not pull credit. Approvals close in about 8 minutes with proof of income and your first month’s payment. Terms run 36–60 months with no early-payoff penalty, and the monthly works out to roughly $2717/month on a 100×70 manufacturing facility.
What warranty comes with the 100×70 manufacturing facility?
Steel and Stud backs every building with a 20-year rust-through warranty on the galvanized frame and a 10-year sheeting warranty on the 29-gauge panels (upgradeable to 26-gauge or 12-gauge). Workmanship on the install is warrantied for 1 year. Full warranty terms ship with your order packet.
Can I customize the 100×70 manufacturing facility in 3D before I order?
Yes, our free Sensei3D Designer lets you drag and drop doors, windows, and walk-ins; swap 16 roof + trim colors live; and rotate the building in 3D from every angle. No login required. The design saves directly to a quote so what you build is exactly what we price.
Will the 100×70 manufacturing facility handle heavy equipment and forklifts?
Standard 100×70 manufacturing facility ships rated for 35 psf live load on the floor (over concrete pad), and the 12-gauge frame upgrade supports trolley- and jib-crane mounts up to 1-ton capacity. Steel and Stud engineers will spec heavier rigging on request, call 1-877-275-7048.
Ready to build?
Your Manufacturing Facility quote takes one minute.
Tell us your zip and the options you want. We’ll send back a same-day, all-in price.
7,000 sq ft for commercial warehouse, hay barn, or fabrication shop
100′ x 70′14 GaugeLocal Certification Available
Pre-engineered 100×70 steel building delivers 7,000 sq ft of column-free space. Galvanized 14-gauge tubular frame, vertical roof, and certified wind and snow load ratings. Customize doors, windows, colors, eave height, and certifications in our free 3D builder.
Leg height adjustable up to 20'
$130,400.00
Free Delivery & Install RTO from /mo — No credit check
7,000 sq ft for commercial warehouse, hay barn, or fabrication shop
100′ x 70′14 GaugeLocal Certification Available
Pre-engineered 100×70 steel building delivers 7,000 sq ft of column-free space. Galvanized 14-gauge tubular frame, vertical roof, and certified wind and snow load ratings. Customize doors, windows, colors, eave height, and certifications in our free 3D builder.
100×70 Commercial Workshop | Steel and Stud, From $130,000
100×70 Commercial Workshop, engineered for code-compliant business use.
Looking for a 100×70 commercial workshop? At 7000 sq ft, this footprint suits small businesses, retail, or service shops. Fabricators and auto-body shops spec the 100×70 commercial workshop to house six 100×70 bays.
Starting from your selected configuration$130,000$148,200Save $18,200
or as low as $2708/mo · 0% APR · No credit RTO
ℹ️This is an estimate. Final pricing is locked after our sales team reviews your complete requirements (site access, ground type, county-specific certifications, optional upgrades). You’ll receive a written all-in quote within one business day of your request, no surprises, no hidden fees.
FREE delivery & installation in all 48 states. Concrete, asphalt, or compacted gravel.
SKU:SS-100X70-COMMERCIAL-WORKSBuilt:1,847+Since: 2002Made in: 🇺🇸 USA
🛡️
A+
BBB Accredited
★
4.8/5
customer rating
⏱
Since 2004
In Business
🏠
15,000+
Buildings
🇺🇸
48
States Served
We’ve provided builds for
SPATIAL LAYOUT
See how 800 sq ft fits your multi-station shop.
100 feet wide × 70 feet long. Separates dusty + clean operations. Looking for a 100×70 commercial workshop? At 7000 sq ft, this footprint suits small businesses, retail, or service shops.
Wood + metal benches · CNC / table-saw center · Finishing room + Material storage
Wood + metal benches at the front, cnc / table-saw center in the middle, finishing room + material storage at the rear. Capacity: multi-craft shop / small business. Fabricators and auto-body shops spec the 100×70 commercial workshop to house six 100×70 bays along one wall with a shared 40-ft paint booth on the other.
Design your building yourself in our free Sensei3D Designer, drag doors and windows where you want them, swap roof + trim colors, and see your spec from every angle. Save your design and email it to yourself for later.
Drag-and-drop doors, windows, walk-ins anywhere on the building
16 colors applied live to roof, walls, and trim, mix & match
Interior + exterior views of your spec, with measurements
Save your design and share it with your contractor or family
Auto-syncs to quote, what you build is what we price
All variants ship with free delivery, installation, drawings, 20-year warranty.
🏗️
7,000 sq ft enclosed
Fully-enclosed 100×70 vertical-roof structure.
🚪
Roll-up + walk-in doors
Standard configuration door package.
🔩
14-gauge steel frame
American-rolled galvanized tubing.
🎨
1 standard color
Pick from 16 factory-baked finishes.
TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS
Commercial Workshop spec sheet.
Width100′
Length70′ + 6" overhang
Side height9′ standard
Floor space7,000 sq ft
Doors1 × 9×8 roll-up
Walk-inOptional (+$345)
WindowsOptional
Windup to 180 mph
Snowup to 65 psf
RoofVertical 3:12
Frame14 ga (12 ga upgrade)
Sheeting29 ga (26 ga upgrade)
AnchoringConcrete · Asphalt · Ground
Lead time3 – 5 weeks
USE CASE EXAMPLES
How real buyers use Commercial Workshop.
DAILY USE
Everyday commercial workshop
7,000 sq ft is the right size for daily use of a commercial workshop.
STORAGE OVERFLOW
commercial workshop + seasonal storage
Park or store equipment in the front half, leave the rear for seasonal storage and overflow.
FLEX ROOM
Expansion-ready
Stud-framed interior makes it easy to add a partition, electrical, or insulation later.
FULL PRODUCT DETAILS
100×70 Commercial Workshop, what makes it different.
7,000sq ft
Floor Space
180mph
Wind Rated
65psf
Snow Load
20yr
Rust Warranty
40yr
Paint Warranty
$2708/mo
From RTO
🏗️
Engineered for your county
Every 100×70 commercial workshop is fabricated from American-rolled galvanized steel and engineered against the exact wind and snow loads your jurisdiction requires.
Standard: 140 mph wind / 35 psf snow
12-ga upgrade: 180 mph / 65 psf
Permit drawings stamped and emailed free
🔩
Construction details
The same materials commercial fabricators use, not residential-grade. Hot-dip galvanized fasteners, factory-baked siliconized polyester paint, Hilti-grade anchors.
Frame: 14-ga (12-ga upgrade) galvanized tubing
Panels: 29-ga G-90 (26-ga upgrade)
Fasteners: #14 self-drilling with EPDM washer
🚚
Free delivery & install, really free
Regional-route delivery plus 1–2 day on-site installation by a certified crew, bundled into your headline price. No hidden unloading fees, fuel surcharges, or site-prep charges.
$0 deposit · pay only after walkthrough sign-off
3–5 week lead time on regional routes
All 48 states · rush option available
🛡️
Warranty & lifespan
Engineered for a 50-year service life with industry-leading warranties on every wear surface.
20-yr rust-through warranty on frame & panels
40-yr paint warranty against fading + chalking
1-yr craftsmanship on installation
💳
$0-down financing
Three financing paths to fit any credit situation. The rent-to-own option requires no credit pull at all, fastest path to a closed deal.
RTO: $2708/mo, no credit check, 36–60 mo
Financing: 0% promo APR · 84 mo term
Cash discount: 4% on $10K+ orders
⚡
Why 100×70?
7,000 sq ft sits in the sweet spot for residential and light-commercial, fits standard quarter-acre setbacks, comfortably below the 1,000 sq ft municipal threshold that triggers extra inspections.
100′ × 70′ footprint with 7,000 sq ft interior
Permit-friendly in 96% of US counties
Resale ROI $56,000–$84,000 added home value
PEOPLE ALSO ASK
Common questions from Commercial Workshop shoppers.
The questions our team hears every week. Click any to expand the short answer.
How thick is the steel on a Steel and Stud 100×70 metal building?
Standard frame: 14-gauge (1.5 mm) galvanized tubing. Optional 12-gauge upgrade (2.5 mm) for high-wind/snow zones. Roof and wall sheeting ships 29-gauge standard, 26-gauge upgrade available on order.
Does Steel and Stud deliver and install in my state?
Yes, free delivery and free installation in all 48 continental states, performed by certified Steel and Stud crews. Hawaii and Alaska use custom freight quotes; call 1-877-275-7048 for either.
What’s the typical lead time for a 100×70 building?
Standard: 3–5 weeks from order confirmation to install completion. Fabrication runs the first 2–3 weeks at our US plant; regional delivery and 1-2 day install close it out. Rush builds available for $345.
Can I finance a Steel and Stud building without a credit check?
Yes, Steel and Stud’s rent-to-own partner does not pull credit. Approvals typically run 8 minutes with proof of income and first month’s payment. 36–60 month terms, no early-payoff penalty.
What’s covered under the 20-year warranty?
Steel and Stud’s 20-year rust-through warranty covers the galvanized frame against perforation, plus a 20-year paint-finish warranty against fade and chalk. Workmanship on the install is warrantied for 1 year. Warranty transfers to the next owner on resale.
CUSTOMER REVIEWS
What real 100×70 Commercial Workshop buyers say.
⭐
No reviews yet for the 100×70 Commercial Workshop
Be the first verified buyer to share your experience. Honest reviews help other steel-building shoppers make a confident decision.
A 100×70 commercial workshop from Steel and Stud starts at $130,000 with free delivery and free installation across all 48 states. Most buyers pick the rent-to-own option at about $2708/month with $0 down and no credit check. Call 1-877-275-7048 for a same-day price lock.
Is delivery and installation included in the 100×70 commercial workshop price?
Yes, every Steel and Stud commercial workshop ships with free delivery + free installation by a certified crew, included in the listed price. Anchored to a concrete pad, asphalt, or compacted gravel, your building is fully erected in 1–2 days after the truck arrives.
Do I need a permit for a 100×70 commercial workshop?
Almost always for 7,000+ sq ft enclosed buildings. Steel and Stud emails engineered drawings stamped for your wind zone (up to 180 mph) and snow zone (up to 65 psf) at no charge, so your local building department has everything it needs. Permit timing typically runs 2–6 weeks by jurisdiction.
How is a Steel and Stud commercial workshop different from a wood-frame build?
Steel solves the problems wood creates, no rotting, no termites, no warping, no painting every 3 years. Our 14-gauge galvanized frame carries a 20-year rust warranty and ships with a 180 mph wind / 65 psf snow rating already engineered in. A comparable wood build typically costs 2–3× more and needs ongoing maintenance.
What foundation does a 100×70 commercial workshop need?
A 4-inch concrete pad poured 1 foot wider and longer than the building is the standard. Steel and Stud also anchors to asphalt or compacted gravel for open or semi-enclosed configurations. A pad-pour bundle is offered at checkout if you don’t already have a slab.
How fast can I get a 100×70 commercial workshop delivered?
Standard lead time is 3–5 weeks from order to install. Fabrication runs the first 2–3 weeks at our US plant; regional delivery + 1–2-day install by a certified Steel and Stud crew closes out the order. Rush builds are available, call 1-877-275-7048 for current capacity.
Can I finance a 100×70 commercial workshop without a credit check?
Yes, Steel and Stud’s rent-to-own partner does not pull credit. Approvals close in about 8 minutes with proof of income and your first month’s payment. Terms run 36–60 months with no early-payoff penalty, and the monthly works out to roughly $2708/month on a 100×70 commercial workshop.
What warranty comes with the 100×70 commercial workshop?
Steel and Stud backs every building with a 20-year rust-through warranty on the galvanized frame and a 10-year sheeting warranty on the 29-gauge panels (upgradeable to 26-gauge or 12-gauge). Workmanship on the install is warrantied for 1 year. Full warranty terms ship with your order packet.
Can I customize the 100×70 commercial workshop in 3D before I order?
Yes, our free Sensei3D Designer lets you drag and drop doors, windows, and walk-ins; swap 16 roof + trim colors live; and rotate the building in 3D from every angle. No login required. The design saves directly to a quote so what you build is exactly what we price.
Does the 100×70 commercial workshop meet IBC commercial code?
Yes. Steel and Stud’s 12-gauge frame upgrade and 26-gauge sheeting both meet IBC commercial standards, and most counties accept our stamped drawings without revision. Engineered loads ship with the order, typical certified specs are 180 mph wind / 65 psf snow.
Ready to build?
Your Commercial Workshop quote takes one minute.
Tell us your zip and the options you want. We’ll send back a same-day, all-in price.
7,000 sq ft for commercial warehouse, hay barn, or fabrication shop
100′ x 70′14 GaugeLocal Certification Available
Pre-engineered 100×70 steel building delivers 7,000 sq ft of column-free space. Galvanized 14-gauge tubular frame, vertical roof, and certified wind and snow load ratings. Customize doors, windows, colors, eave height, and certifications in our free 3D builder.
Leg height adjustable up to 20'
$130,000.00
Free Delivery & Install RTO from /mo — No credit check
7,000 sq ft for commercial warehouse, hay barn, or fabrication shop
100′ x 70′14 GaugeLocal Certification Available
Pre-engineered 100×70 steel building delivers 7,000 sq ft of column-free space. Galvanized 14-gauge tubular frame, vertical roof, and certified wind and snow load ratings. Customize doors, windows, colors, eave height, and certifications in our free 3D builder.
100×70 Aircraft Hangar | Steel and Stud, From $130,400
100×70 Aircraft Hangar, rated for heavy-duty industrial loads.
Owners of single-engine and light-twin aircraft order the 100×70 metal building hangar with a 60′ hydraulic bifold door across the gable. The 70-ft depth holds a Cessna 414 plus workbench and parts storage. Stamped.
Starting from your selected configuration$130,400$148,650Save $18,250
or as low as $2717/mo · 0% APR · No credit RTO
ℹ️This is an estimate. Final pricing is locked after our sales team reviews your complete requirements (site access, ground type, county-specific certifications, optional upgrades). You’ll receive a written all-in quote within one business day of your request, no surprises, no hidden fees.
FREE delivery & installation in all 48 states. Concrete, asphalt, or compacted gravel.
SKU:SS-100X70-AIRCRAFT-HANGARBuilt:1,847+Since: 2002Made in: 🇺🇸 USA
🛡️
A+
BBB Accredited
★
4.8/5
customer rating
⏱
Since 2004
In Business
🏠
15,000+
Buildings
🇺🇸
48
States Served
We’ve provided builds for
SPATIAL LAYOUT
See how 800 sq ft fits your multi-aircraft hangar.
100 feet wide × 70 feet long. Engineered for column-free clear span at 100ft width. Owners of single-engine and light-twin aircraft order the 100×70 metal building hangar with a 60′ hydraulic bifold door across the gable.
Multi-aircraft floor · Maintenance / engine zone · Office + parts + pilot lounge
Multi-aircraft floor at the front, maintenance / engine zone in the middle, office + parts + pilot lounge at the rear. Capacity: 2-4 aircraft, full FBO operations. The 70-ft depth holds a Cessna 414 plus workbench and parts storage.
💡 Pro tip:60′ Door Span. Size affords: overhead crane, office mezzanine, parts storage cage.
🎨 FREE 3D BUILDER
Build your 100×70 Aircraft Hangar in 3D.
Design your building yourself in our free Sensei3D Designer, drag doors and windows where you want them, swap roof + trim colors, and see your spec from every angle. Save your design and email it to yourself for later.
Drag-and-drop doors, windows, walk-ins anywhere on the building
16 colors applied live to roof, walls, and trim, mix & match
Interior + exterior views of your spec, with measurements
Save your design and share it with your contractor or family
Auto-syncs to quote, what you build is what we price
All variants ship with free delivery, installation, drawings, 20-year warranty.
🏗️
7,000 sq ft enclosed
Fully-enclosed 100×70 vertical-roof structure.
🚪
Roll-up + walk-in doors
Standard configuration door package.
🔩
14-gauge steel frame
American-rolled galvanized tubing.
🎨
1 standard color
Pick from 16 factory-baked finishes.
TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS
Aircraft Hangar spec sheet.
Width100′
Length70′ + 6" overhang
Side height9′ standard
Floor space7,000 sq ft
Doors1 × 9×8 roll-up
Walk-inOptional (+$345)
WindowsOptional
Windup to 180 mph
Snowup to 65 psf
RoofVertical 3:12
Frame14 ga (12 ga upgrade)
Sheeting29 ga (26 ga upgrade)
AnchoringConcrete · Asphalt · Ground
Lead time3 – 5 weeks
USE CASE EXAMPLES
How real buyers use Aircraft Hangar.
DAILY USE
Everyday aircraft hangar
7,000 sq ft is the right size for daily use of a aircraft hangar.
STORAGE OVERFLOW
aircraft hangar + seasonal storage
Park or store equipment in the front half, leave the rear for seasonal storage and overflow.
FLEX ROOM
Expansion-ready
Stud-framed interior makes it easy to add a partition, electrical, or insulation later.
FULL PRODUCT DETAILS
100×70 Aircraft Hangar, what makes it different.
7,000sq ft
Floor Space
180mph
Wind Rated
65psf
Snow Load
20yr
Rust Warranty
40yr
Paint Warranty
$2717/mo
From RTO
🏗️
Engineered for your county
Every 100×70 aircraft hangar is fabricated from American-rolled galvanized steel and engineered against the exact wind and snow loads your jurisdiction requires.
Standard: 140 mph wind / 35 psf snow
12-ga upgrade: 180 mph / 65 psf
Permit drawings stamped and emailed free
🔩
Construction details
The same materials commercial fabricators use, not residential-grade. Hot-dip galvanized fasteners, factory-baked siliconized polyester paint, Hilti-grade anchors.
Frame: 14-ga (12-ga upgrade) galvanized tubing
Panels: 29-ga G-90 (26-ga upgrade)
Fasteners: #14 self-drilling with EPDM washer
🚚
Free delivery & install, really free
Regional-route delivery plus 1–2 day on-site installation by a certified crew, bundled into your headline price. No hidden unloading fees, fuel surcharges, or site-prep charges.
$0 deposit · pay only after walkthrough sign-off
3–5 week lead time on regional routes
All 48 states · rush option available
🛡️
Warranty & lifespan
Engineered for a 50-year service life with industry-leading warranties on every wear surface.
20-yr rust-through warranty on frame & panels
40-yr paint warranty against fading + chalking
1-yr craftsmanship on installation
💳
$0-down financing
Three financing paths to fit any credit situation. The rent-to-own option requires no credit pull at all, fastest path to a closed deal.
RTO: $2717/mo, no credit check, 36–60 mo
Financing: 0% promo APR · 84 mo term
Cash discount: 4% on $10K+ orders
⚡
Why 100×70?
7,000 sq ft sits in the sweet spot for residential and light-commercial, fits standard quarter-acre setbacks, comfortably below the 1,000 sq ft municipal threshold that triggers extra inspections.
100′ × 70′ footprint with 7,000 sq ft interior
Permit-friendly in 96% of US counties
Resale ROI $56,000–$84,000 added home value
PEOPLE ALSO ASK
Common questions from Aircraft Hangar shoppers.
The questions our team hears every week. Click any to expand the short answer.
How thick is the steel on a Steel and Stud 100×70 metal building?
Standard frame: 14-gauge (1.5 mm) galvanized tubing. Optional 12-gauge upgrade (2.5 mm) for high-wind/snow zones. Roof and wall sheeting ships 29-gauge standard, 26-gauge upgrade available on order.
Does Steel and Stud deliver and install in my state?
Yes, free delivery and free installation in all 48 continental states, performed by certified Steel and Stud crews. Hawaii and Alaska use custom freight quotes; call 1-877-275-7048 for either.
What’s the typical lead time for a 100×70 building?
Standard: 3–5 weeks from order confirmation to install completion. Fabrication runs the first 2–3 weeks at our US plant; regional delivery and 1-2 day install close it out. Rush builds available for $345.
Can I finance a Steel and Stud building without a credit check?
Yes, Steel and Stud’s rent-to-own partner does not pull credit. Approvals typically run 8 minutes with proof of income and first month’s payment. 36–60 month terms, no early-payoff penalty.
What’s covered under the 20-year warranty?
Steel and Stud’s 20-year rust-through warranty covers the galvanized frame against perforation, plus a 20-year paint-finish warranty against fade and chalk. Workmanship on the install is warrantied for 1 year. Warranty transfers to the next owner on resale.
CUSTOMER REVIEWS
What real 100×70 Aircraft Hangar buyers say.
⭐
No reviews yet for the 100×70 Aircraft Hangar
Be the first verified buyer to share your experience. Honest reviews help other steel-building shoppers make a confident decision.
A 100×70 aircraft hangar from Steel and Stud starts at $130,400 with free delivery and free installation across all 48 states. Most buyers pick the rent-to-own option at about $2717/month with $0 down and no credit check. Call 1-877-275-7048 for a same-day price lock.
Is delivery and installation included in the 100×70 aircraft hangar price?
Yes, every Steel and Stud aircraft hangar ships with free delivery + free installation by a certified crew, included in the listed price. Anchored to a concrete pad, asphalt, or compacted gravel, your building is fully erected in 1–2 days after the truck arrives.
Do I need a permit for a 100×70 aircraft hangar?
Almost always for 7,000+ sq ft enclosed buildings. Steel and Stud emails engineered drawings stamped for your wind zone (up to 180 mph) and snow zone (up to 65 psf) at no charge, so your local building department has everything it needs. Permit timing typically runs 2–6 weeks by jurisdiction.
How is a Steel and Stud aircraft hangar different from a wood-frame build?
Steel solves the problems wood creates, no rotting, no termites, no warping, no painting every 3 years. Our 14-gauge galvanized frame carries a 20-year rust warranty and ships with a 180 mph wind / 65 psf snow rating already engineered in. A comparable wood build typically costs 2–3× more and needs ongoing maintenance.
What foundation does a 100×70 aircraft hangar need?
A 4-inch concrete pad poured 1 foot wider and longer than the building is the standard. Steel and Stud also anchors to asphalt or compacted gravel for open or semi-enclosed configurations. A pad-pour bundle is offered at checkout if you don’t already have a slab.
How fast can I get a 100×70 aircraft hangar delivered?
Standard lead time is 3–5 weeks from order to install. Fabrication runs the first 2–3 weeks at our US plant; regional delivery + 1–2-day install by a certified Steel and Stud crew closes out the order. Rush builds are available, call 1-877-275-7048 for current capacity.
Can I finance a 100×70 aircraft hangar without a credit check?
Yes, Steel and Stud’s rent-to-own partner does not pull credit. Approvals close in about 8 minutes with proof of income and your first month’s payment. Terms run 36–60 months with no early-payoff penalty, and the monthly works out to roughly $2717/month on a 100×70 aircraft hangar.
What warranty comes with the 100×70 aircraft hangar?
Steel and Stud backs every building with a 20-year rust-through warranty on the galvanized frame and a 10-year sheeting warranty on the 29-gauge panels (upgradeable to 26-gauge or 12-gauge). Workmanship on the install is warrantied for 1 year. Full warranty terms ship with your order packet.
Can I customize the 100×70 aircraft hangar in 3D before I order?
Yes, our free Sensei3D Designer lets you drag and drop doors, windows, and walk-ins; swap 16 roof + trim colors live; and rotate the building in 3D from every angle. No login required. The design saves directly to a quote so what you build is exactly what we price.
Will the 100×70 aircraft hangar handle heavy equipment and forklifts?
Standard 100×70 aircraft hangar ships rated for 35 psf live load on the floor (over concrete pad), and the 12-gauge frame upgrade supports trolley- and jib-crane mounts up to 1-ton capacity. Steel and Stud engineers will spec heavier rigging on request, call 1-877-275-7048.
Ready to build?
Your Aircraft Hangar quote takes one minute.
Tell us your zip and the options you want. We’ll send back a same-day, all-in price.
7,000 sq ft for commercial warehouse, hay barn, or fabrication shop
100′ x 70′14 GaugeLocal Certification Available
Pre-engineered 100×70 steel building delivers 7,000 sq ft of column-free space. Galvanized 14-gauge tubular frame, vertical roof, and certified wind and snow load ratings. Customize doors, windows, colors, eave height, and certifications in our free 3D builder.
Leg height adjustable up to 20'
$130,400.00
Free Delivery & Install RTO from /mo — No credit check
7,000 sq ft for commercial warehouse, hay barn, or fabrication shop
100′ x 70′14 GaugeLocal Certification Available
Pre-engineered 100×70 steel building delivers 7,000 sq ft of column-free space. Galvanized 14-gauge tubular frame, vertical roof, and certified wind and snow load ratings. Customize doors, windows, colors, eave height, and certifications in our free 3D builder.
100×70 Agricultural Metal Building | Steel and Stud, From $128,800
100×70 Agricultural Metal Building, built for farm and ranch demands.
100×70 delivers 7000 sq ft of rugged agricultural metal building space. Agricultural-industrial operators run a 100×70 as a hay barn, equipment shed, or cattle handling facility. At 9,7000 sq ft you store roughly 800.
You’re viewing:Agricultural Metal Building·Size100×70·Slate Gray
Starting from your selected configuration$128,800$146,850Save $18,050
or as low as $2683/mo · 0% APR · No credit RTO
ℹ️This is an estimate. Final pricing is locked after our sales team reviews your complete requirements (site access, ground type, county-specific certifications, optional upgrades). You’ll receive a written all-in quote within one business day of your request, no surprises, no hidden fees.
FREE delivery & installation in all 48 states. Concrete, asphalt, or compacted gravel.
SKU:SS-100X70-AGRICULTURAL-METBuilt:1,847+Since: 2002Made in: 🇺🇸 USA
🛡️
A+
BBB Accredited
★
4.8/5
customer rating
⏱
Since 2004
In Business
🏠
15,000+
Buildings
🇺🇸
48
States Served
We’ve provided builds for
SPATIAL LAYOUT
See how 800 sq ft fits your agricultural metal building layout.
100 feet wide × 70 feet long. 100×70 delivers 7000 sq ft of rugged agricultural metal building space.
Agricultural Metal Building layout.
100×70 delivers 7000 sq ft of rugged agricultural metal building space. Agricultural-industrial operators run a 100×70 as a hay barn, equipment shed, or cattle handling facility. At 9,7000 sq ft you store roughly 800 large round bales stacked three high or park a combine, two tractors, and a sprayer with maintenance access. Open-side or partially enclosed configurations dominate this use.
💡 Pro tip:800 Bale Capacity.
🎨 FREE 3D BUILDER
Build your 100×70 Agricultural Metal Building in 3D.
Design your building yourself in our free Sensei3D Designer, drag doors and windows where you want them, swap roof + trim colors, and see your spec from every angle. Save your design and email it to yourself for later.
Drag-and-drop doors, windows, walk-ins anywhere on the building
16 colors applied live to roof, walls, and trim, mix & match
Interior + exterior views of your spec, with measurements
Save your design and share it with your contractor or family
Auto-syncs to quote, what you build is what we price
All variants ship with free delivery, installation, drawings, 20-year warranty.
🏗️
7,000 sq ft enclosed
Fully-enclosed 100×70 vertical-roof structure.
🚪
Roll-up + walk-in doors
Standard configuration door package.
🔩
14-gauge steel frame
American-rolled galvanized tubing.
🎨
1 standard color
Pick from 16 factory-baked finishes.
TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS
Agricultural Metal Building spec sheet.
Width100′
Length70′ + 6" overhang
Side height9′ standard
Floor space7,000 sq ft
Doors1 × 9×8 roll-up
Walk-inOptional (+$345)
WindowsOptional
Windup to 180 mph
Snowup to 65 psf
RoofVertical 3:12
Frame14 ga (12 ga upgrade)
Sheeting29 ga (26 ga upgrade)
AnchoringConcrete · Asphalt · Ground
Lead time3 – 5 weeks
USE CASE EXAMPLES
How real buyers use Agricultural Metal Building.
DAILY USE
Everyday agricultural metal building
7,000 sq ft is the right size for daily use of a agricultural metal building.
STORAGE OVERFLOW
agricultural metal building + seasonal storage
Park or store equipment in the front half, leave the rear for seasonal storage and overflow.
FLEX ROOM
Expansion-ready
Stud-framed interior makes it easy to add a partition, electrical, or insulation later.
FULL PRODUCT DETAILS
100×70 Agricultural Metal Building, what makes it different.
7,000sq ft
Floor Space
180mph
Wind Rated
65psf
Snow Load
20yr
Rust Warranty
40yr
Paint Warranty
$2683/mo
From RTO
🏗️
Engineered for your county
Every 100×70 agricultural metal building is fabricated from American-rolled galvanized steel and engineered against the exact wind and snow loads your jurisdiction requires.
Standard: 140 mph wind / 35 psf snow
12-ga upgrade: 180 mph / 65 psf
Permit drawings stamped and emailed free
🔩
Construction details
The same materials commercial fabricators use, not residential-grade. Hot-dip galvanized fasteners, factory-baked siliconized polyester paint, Hilti-grade anchors.
Frame: 14-ga (12-ga upgrade) galvanized tubing
Panels: 29-ga G-90 (26-ga upgrade)
Fasteners: #14 self-drilling with EPDM washer
🚚
Free delivery & install, really free
Regional-route delivery plus 1–2 day on-site installation by a certified crew, bundled into your headline price. No hidden unloading fees, fuel surcharges, or site-prep charges.
$0 deposit · pay only after walkthrough sign-off
3–5 week lead time on regional routes
All 48 states · rush option available
🛡️
Warranty & lifespan
Engineered for a 50-year service life with industry-leading warranties on every wear surface.
20-yr rust-through warranty on frame & panels
40-yr paint warranty against fading + chalking
1-yr craftsmanship on installation
💳
$0-down financing
Three financing paths to fit any credit situation. The rent-to-own option requires no credit pull at all, fastest path to a closed deal.
RTO: $2683/mo, no credit check, 36–60 mo
Financing: 0% promo APR · 84 mo term
Cash discount: 4% on $10K+ orders
⚡
Why 100×70?
7,000 sq ft sits in the sweet spot for residential and light-commercial, fits standard quarter-acre setbacks, comfortably below the 1,000 sq ft municipal threshold that triggers extra inspections.
100′ × 70′ footprint with 7,000 sq ft interior
Permit-friendly in 96% of US counties
Resale ROI $56,000–$84,000 added home value
PEOPLE ALSO ASK
Common questions from Agricultural Metal Building shoppers.
The questions our team hears every week. Click any to expand the short answer.
How thick is the steel on a Steel and Stud 100×70 metal building?
Standard frame: 14-gauge (1.5 mm) galvanized tubing. Optional 12-gauge upgrade (2.5 mm) for high-wind/snow zones. Roof and wall sheeting ships 29-gauge standard, 26-gauge upgrade available on order.
Does Steel and Stud deliver and install in my state?
Yes, free delivery and free installation in all 48 continental states, performed by certified Steel and Stud crews. Hawaii and Alaska use custom freight quotes; call 1-877-275-7048 for either.
What’s the typical lead time for a 100×70 building?
Standard: 3–5 weeks from order confirmation to install completion. Fabrication runs the first 2–3 weeks at our US plant; regional delivery and 1-2 day install close it out. Rush builds available for $345.
Can I finance a Steel and Stud building without a credit check?
Yes, Steel and Stud’s rent-to-own partner does not pull credit. Approvals typically run 8 minutes with proof of income and first month’s payment. 36–60 month terms, no early-payoff penalty.
What’s covered under the 20-year warranty?
Steel and Stud’s 20-year rust-through warranty covers the galvanized frame against perforation, plus a 20-year paint-finish warranty against fade and chalk. Workmanship on the install is warrantied for 1 year. Warranty transfers to the next owner on resale.
CUSTOMER REVIEWS
What real 100×70 Agricultural Metal Building buyers say.
⭐
No reviews yet for the 100×70 Agricultural Metal Building
Be the first verified buyer to share your experience. Honest reviews help other steel-building shoppers make a confident decision.
How much does a 100×70 agricultural metal building cost?
A 100×70 agricultural metal building from Steel and Stud starts at $128,800 with free delivery and free installation across all 48 states. Most buyers pick the rent-to-own option at about $2683/month with $0 down and no credit check. Call 1-877-275-7048 for a same-day price lock.
Is delivery and installation included in the 100×70 agricultural metal building price?
Yes, every Steel and Stud agricultural metal building ships with free delivery + free installation by a certified crew, included in the listed price. Anchored to a concrete pad, asphalt, or compacted gravel, your building is fully erected in 1–2 days after the truck arrives.
Do I need a permit for a 100×70 agricultural metal building?
Almost always for 7,000+ sq ft enclosed buildings. Steel and Stud emails engineered drawings stamped for your wind zone (up to 180 mph) and snow zone (up to 65 psf) at no charge, so your local building department has everything it needs. Permit timing typically runs 2–6 weeks by jurisdiction.
How is a Steel and Stud agricultural metal building different from a wood-frame build?
Steel solves the problems wood creates, no rotting, no termites, no warping, no painting every 3 years. Our 14-gauge galvanized frame carries a 20-year rust warranty and ships with a 180 mph wind / 65 psf snow rating already engineered in. A comparable wood build typically costs 2–3× more and needs ongoing maintenance.
What foundation does a 100×70 agricultural metal building need?
A 4-inch concrete pad poured 1 foot wider and longer than the building is the standard. Steel and Stud also anchors to asphalt or compacted gravel for open or semi-enclosed configurations. A pad-pour bundle is offered at checkout if you don’t already have a slab.
How fast can I get a 100×70 agricultural metal building delivered?
Standard lead time is 3–5 weeks from order to install. Fabrication runs the first 2–3 weeks at our US plant; regional delivery + 1–2-day install by a certified Steel and Stud crew closes out the order. Rush builds are available, call 1-877-275-7048 for current capacity.
Can I finance a 100×70 agricultural metal building without a credit check?
Yes, Steel and Stud’s rent-to-own partner does not pull credit. Approvals close in about 8 minutes with proof of income and your first month’s payment. Terms run 36–60 months with no early-payoff penalty, and the monthly works out to roughly $2683/month on a 100×70 agricultural metal building.
What warranty comes with the 100×70 agricultural metal building?
Steel and Stud backs every building with a 20-year rust-through warranty on the galvanized frame and a 10-year sheeting warranty on the 29-gauge panels (upgradeable to 26-gauge or 12-gauge). Workmanship on the install is warrantied for 1 year. Full warranty terms ship with your order packet.
Can I customize the 100×70 agricultural metal building in 3D before I order?
Yes, our free Sensei3D Designer lets you drag and drop doors, windows, and walk-ins; swap 16 roof + trim colors live; and rotate the building in 3D from every angle. No login required. The design saves directly to a quote so what you build is exactly what we price.
Will the 100×70 agricultural metal building stand up to livestock and Midwest weather?
The 14-gauge galvanized frame is the same spec Steel and Stud uses for commercial barns, rated to 65 psf snow and 180 mph wind. Ventilation packages (ridge vent + soffit) ship standard on agricultural orders to prevent moisture buildup that would warp a wood barn.
Ready to build?
Your Agricultural Metal Building quote takes one minute.
Tell us your zip and the options you want. We’ll send back a same-day, all-in price.
7,000 sq ft for commercial warehouse, hay barn, or fabrication shop
100′ x 70′14 GaugeLocal Certification Available
Pre-engineered 100×70 steel building delivers 7,000 sq ft of column-free space. Galvanized 14-gauge tubular frame, vertical roof, and certified wind and snow load ratings. Customize doors, windows, colors, eave height, and certifications in our free 3D builder.
Leg height adjustable up to 20'
$128,800.00
Free Delivery & Install RTO from /mo — No credit check
7,000 sq ft for commercial warehouse, hay barn, or fabrication shop
100′ x 70′14 GaugeLocal Certification Available
Pre-engineered 100×70 steel building delivers 7,000 sq ft of column-free space. Galvanized 14-gauge tubular frame, vertical roof, and certified wind and snow load ratings. Customize doors, windows, colors, eave height, and certifications in our free 3D builder.
100×70 Cold Storage Building | Steel and Stud, From $130,000
100×70 Cold Storage Building, engineered for code-compliant business use.
Commercial buyers run cold storage out of a 100×70 insulated steel kit using 4-inch insulated metal panels and an R-19 ceiling system. The 7,000 sq ft footprint holds two refrigerated zones plus a loading vestibule.
Starting from your selected configuration$130,000$148,200Save $18,200
or as low as $2708/mo · 0% APR · No credit RTO
ℹ️This is an estimate. Final pricing is locked after our sales team reviews your complete requirements (site access, ground type, county-specific certifications, optional upgrades). You’ll receive a written all-in quote within one business day of your request, no surprises, no hidden fees.
FREE delivery & installation in all 48 states. Concrete, asphalt, or compacted gravel.
SKU:SS-100X70-COLD-STORAGE-BUIBuilt:1,847+Since: 2002Made in: 🇺🇸 USA
🛡️
A+
BBB Accredited
★
4.8/5
customer rating
⏱
Since 2004
In Business
🏠
15,000+
Buildings
🇺🇸
48
States Served
We’ve provided builds for
SPATIAL LAYOUT
See how 800 sq ft fits your distribution facility.
100 feet wide × 70 feet long. Column-free clear span; 18-ft+ height for 5-tier racking. Commercial buyers run cold storage out of a 100×70 insulated steel kit using 4-inch insulated metal panels and an R-19 ceiling system.
Multi-dock loading bays at the front, high-bay racking aisles in the middle, office mezzanine + break + restrooms at the rear. Capacity: ~140 pallet positions, full forklift ops. The 7,000 sq ft footprint holds two refrigerated zones plus a loading vestibule.
💡 Pro tip:Dual-Zone Capable. Size affords: multiple dock doors, mezzanine office, in-rack sprinklers.
🎨 FREE 3D BUILDER
Build your 100×70 Cold Storage Building in 3D.
Design your building yourself in our free Sensei3D Designer, drag doors and windows where you want them, swap roof + trim colors, and see your spec from every angle. Save your design and email it to yourself for later.
Drag-and-drop doors, windows, walk-ins anywhere on the building
16 colors applied live to roof, walls, and trim, mix & match
Interior + exterior views of your spec, with measurements
Save your design and share it with your contractor or family
Auto-syncs to quote, what you build is what we price
All variants ship with free delivery, installation, drawings, 20-year warranty.
🏗️
7,000 sq ft enclosed
Fully-enclosed 100×70 vertical-roof structure.
🚪
Roll-up + walk-in doors
Standard configuration door package.
🔩
14-gauge steel frame
American-rolled galvanized tubing.
🎨
1 standard color
Pick from 16 factory-baked finishes.
TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS
Cold Storage Building spec sheet.
Width100′
Length70′ + 6" overhang
Side height9′ standard
Floor space7,000 sq ft
Doors1 × 9×8 roll-up
Walk-inOptional (+$345)
WindowsOptional
Windup to 180 mph
Snowup to 65 psf
RoofVertical 3:12
Frame14 ga (12 ga upgrade)
Sheeting29 ga (26 ga upgrade)
AnchoringConcrete · Asphalt · Ground
Lead time3 – 5 weeks
USE CASE EXAMPLES
How real buyers use Cold Storage Building.
DAILY USE
Everyday cold storage building
7,000 sq ft is the right size for daily use of a cold storage building.
STORAGE OVERFLOW
cold storage building + seasonal storage
Park or store equipment in the front half, leave the rear for seasonal storage and overflow.
FLEX ROOM
Expansion-ready
Stud-framed interior makes it easy to add a partition, electrical, or insulation later.
FULL PRODUCT DETAILS
100×70 Cold Storage Building, what makes it different.
7,000sq ft
Floor Space
180mph
Wind Rated
65psf
Snow Load
20yr
Rust Warranty
40yr
Paint Warranty
$2708/mo
From RTO
🏗️
Engineered for your county
Every 100×70 cold storage building is fabricated from American-rolled galvanized steel and engineered against the exact wind and snow loads your jurisdiction requires.
Standard: 140 mph wind / 35 psf snow
12-ga upgrade: 180 mph / 65 psf
Permit drawings stamped and emailed free
🔩
Construction details
The same materials commercial fabricators use, not residential-grade. Hot-dip galvanized fasteners, factory-baked siliconized polyester paint, Hilti-grade anchors.
Frame: 14-ga (12-ga upgrade) galvanized tubing
Panels: 29-ga G-90 (26-ga upgrade)
Fasteners: #14 self-drilling with EPDM washer
🚚
Free delivery & install, really free
Regional-route delivery plus 1–2 day on-site installation by a certified crew, bundled into your headline price. No hidden unloading fees, fuel surcharges, or site-prep charges.
$0 deposit · pay only after walkthrough sign-off
3–5 week lead time on regional routes
All 48 states · rush option available
🛡️
Warranty & lifespan
Engineered for a 50-year service life with industry-leading warranties on every wear surface.
20-yr rust-through warranty on frame & panels
40-yr paint warranty against fading + chalking
1-yr craftsmanship on installation
💳
$0-down financing
Three financing paths to fit any credit situation. The rent-to-own option requires no credit pull at all, fastest path to a closed deal.
RTO: $2708/mo, no credit check, 36–60 mo
Financing: 0% promo APR · 84 mo term
Cash discount: 4% on $10K+ orders
⚡
Why 100×70?
7,000 sq ft sits in the sweet spot for residential and light-commercial, fits standard quarter-acre setbacks, comfortably below the 1,000 sq ft municipal threshold that triggers extra inspections.
100′ × 70′ footprint with 7,000 sq ft interior
Permit-friendly in 96% of US counties
Resale ROI $56,000–$84,000 added home value
PEOPLE ALSO ASK
Common questions from Cold Storage Building shoppers.
The questions our team hears every week. Click any to expand the short answer.
How thick is the steel on a Steel and Stud 100×70 metal building?
Standard frame: 14-gauge (1.5 mm) galvanized tubing. Optional 12-gauge upgrade (2.5 mm) for high-wind/snow zones. Roof and wall sheeting ships 29-gauge standard, 26-gauge upgrade available on order.
Does Steel and Stud deliver and install in my state?
Yes, free delivery and free installation in all 48 continental states, performed by certified Steel and Stud crews. Hawaii and Alaska use custom freight quotes; call 1-877-275-7048 for either.
What’s the typical lead time for a 100×70 building?
Standard: 3–5 weeks from order confirmation to install completion. Fabrication runs the first 2–3 weeks at our US plant; regional delivery and 1-2 day install close it out. Rush builds available for $345.
Can I finance a Steel and Stud building without a credit check?
Yes, Steel and Stud’s rent-to-own partner does not pull credit. Approvals typically run 8 minutes with proof of income and first month’s payment. 36–60 month terms, no early-payoff penalty.
What’s covered under the 20-year warranty?
Steel and Stud’s 20-year rust-through warranty covers the galvanized frame against perforation, plus a 20-year paint-finish warranty against fade and chalk. Workmanship on the install is warrantied for 1 year. Warranty transfers to the next owner on resale.
CUSTOMER REVIEWS
What real 100×70 Cold Storage Building buyers say.
⭐
No reviews yet for the 100×70 Cold Storage Building
Be the first verified buyer to share your experience. Honest reviews help other steel-building shoppers make a confident decision.
How much does a 100×70 cold storage building cost?
A 100×70 cold storage building from Steel and Stud starts at $130,000 with free delivery and free installation across all 48 states. Most buyers pick the rent-to-own option at about $2708/month with $0 down and no credit check. Call 1-877-275-7048 for a same-day price lock.
Is delivery and installation included in the 100×70 cold storage building price?
Yes, every Steel and Stud cold storage building ships with free delivery + free installation by a certified crew, included in the listed price. Anchored to a concrete pad, asphalt, or compacted gravel, your building is fully erected in 1–2 days after the truck arrives.
Do I need a permit for a 100×70 cold storage building?
Almost always for 7,000+ sq ft enclosed buildings. Steel and Stud emails engineered drawings stamped for your wind zone (up to 180 mph) and snow zone (up to 65 psf) at no charge, so your local building department has everything it needs. Permit timing typically runs 2–6 weeks by jurisdiction.
How is a Steel and Stud cold storage building different from a wood-frame build?
Steel solves the problems wood creates, no rotting, no termites, no warping, no painting every 3 years. Our 14-gauge galvanized frame carries a 20-year rust warranty and ships with a 180 mph wind / 65 psf snow rating already engineered in. A comparable wood build typically costs 2–3× more and needs ongoing maintenance.
What foundation does a 100×70 cold storage building need?
A 4-inch concrete pad poured 1 foot wider and longer than the building is the standard. Steel and Stud also anchors to asphalt or compacted gravel for open or semi-enclosed configurations. A pad-pour bundle is offered at checkout if you don’t already have a slab.
How fast can I get a 100×70 cold storage building delivered?
Standard lead time is 3–5 weeks from order to install. Fabrication runs the first 2–3 weeks at our US plant; regional delivery + 1–2-day install by a certified Steel and Stud crew closes out the order. Rush builds are available, call 1-877-275-7048 for current capacity.
Can I finance a 100×70 cold storage building without a credit check?
Yes, Steel and Stud’s rent-to-own partner does not pull credit. Approvals close in about 8 minutes with proof of income and your first month’s payment. Terms run 36–60 months with no early-payoff penalty, and the monthly works out to roughly $2708/month on a 100×70 cold storage building.
What warranty comes with the 100×70 cold storage building?
Steel and Stud backs every building with a 20-year rust-through warranty on the galvanized frame and a 10-year sheeting warranty on the 29-gauge panels (upgradeable to 26-gauge or 12-gauge). Workmanship on the install is warrantied for 1 year. Full warranty terms ship with your order packet.
Can I customize the 100×70 cold storage building in 3D before I order?
Yes, our free Sensei3D Designer lets you drag and drop doors, windows, and walk-ins; swap 16 roof + trim colors live; and rotate the building in 3D from every angle. No login required. The design saves directly to a quote so what you build is exactly what we price.
Does the 100×70 cold storage building meet IBC commercial code?
Yes. Steel and Stud’s 12-gauge frame upgrade and 26-gauge sheeting both meet IBC commercial standards, and most counties accept our stamped drawings without revision. Engineered loads ship with the order, typical certified specs are 180 mph wind / 65 psf snow.
Ready to build?
Your Cold Storage Building quote takes one minute.
Tell us your zip and the options you want. We’ll send back a same-day, all-in price.
7,000 sq ft for commercial warehouse, hay barn, or fabrication shop
100′ x 70′14 GaugeLocal Certification Available
Pre-engineered 100×70 steel building delivers 7,000 sq ft of column-free space. Galvanized 14-gauge tubular frame, vertical roof, and certified wind and snow load ratings. Customize doors, windows, colors, eave height, and certifications in our free 3D builder.
Leg height adjustable up to 20'
$130,000.00
Free Delivery & Install RTO from /mo — No credit check
7,000 sq ft for commercial warehouse, hay barn, or fabrication shop
100′ x 70′14 GaugeLocal Certification Available
Pre-engineered 100×70 steel building delivers 7,000 sq ft of column-free space. Galvanized 14-gauge tubular frame, vertical roof, and certified wind and snow load ratings. Customize doors, windows, colors, eave height, and certifications in our free 3D builder.
100×70 Riding Arena | Steel and Stud, From $128,800
100×70 Riding Arena, built for farm and ranch demands.
100×70 delivers 7000 sq ft of rugged riding arena space. Sliding barn doors at both gable ends let trainers run a full figure-eight, and 16-ft eaves keep dust-down sprinklers out of a rider’s hat.
You’re viewing:Riding Arena·Size100×70·Slate Gray
Starting from your selected configuration$128,800$146,850Save $18,050
or as low as $2683/mo · 0% APR · No credit RTO
ℹ️This is an estimate. Final pricing is locked after our sales team reviews your complete requirements (site access, ground type, county-specific certifications, optional upgrades). You’ll receive a written all-in quote within one business day of your request, no surprises, no hidden fees.
FREE delivery & installation in all 48 states. Concrete, asphalt, or compacted gravel.
SKU:SS-100X70-RIDING-ARENABuilt:1,847+Since: 2002Made in: 🇺🇸 USA
🛡️
A+
BBB Accredited
★
4.8/5
customer rating
⏱
Since 2004
In Business
🏠
15,000+
Buildings
🇺🇸
48
States Served
We’ve provided builds for
SPATIAL LAYOUT
See how 800 sq ft fits your riding arena layout.
100 feet wide × 70 feet long. 100×70 delivers 7000 sq ft of rugged riding arena space.
Riding Arena layout.
100×70 delivers 7000 sq ft of rugged riding arena space. Sliding barn doors at both gable ends let trainers run a full figure-eight, and 16-ft eaves keep dust-down sprinklers out of a rider’s hat.
💡 Pro tip:Wind 115 MPH.
🎨 FREE 3D BUILDER
Build your 100×70 Riding Arena in 3D.
Design your building yourself in our free Sensei3D Designer, drag doors and windows where you want them, swap roof + trim colors, and see your spec from every angle. Save your design and email it to yourself for later.
Drag-and-drop doors, windows, walk-ins anywhere on the building
16 colors applied live to roof, walls, and trim, mix & match
Interior + exterior views of your spec, with measurements
Save your design and share it with your contractor or family
Auto-syncs to quote, what you build is what we price
All variants ship with free delivery, installation, drawings, 20-year warranty.
🏗️
7,000 sq ft enclosed
Fully-enclosed 100×70 vertical-roof structure.
🚪
Roll-up + walk-in doors
Standard configuration door package.
🔩
14-gauge steel frame
American-rolled galvanized tubing.
🎨
1 standard color
Pick from 16 factory-baked finishes.
TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS
Riding Arena spec sheet.
Width100′
Length70′ + 6" overhang
Side height9′ standard
Floor space7,000 sq ft
Doors1 × 9×8 roll-up
Walk-inOptional (+$345)
WindowsOptional
Windup to 180 mph
Snowup to 65 psf
RoofVertical 3:12
Frame14 ga (12 ga upgrade)
Sheeting29 ga (26 ga upgrade)
AnchoringConcrete · Asphalt · Ground
Lead time3 – 5 weeks
USE CASE EXAMPLES
How real buyers use Riding Arena.
DAILY USE
Everyday riding arena
7,000 sq ft is the right size for daily use of a riding arena.
STORAGE OVERFLOW
riding arena + seasonal storage
Park or store equipment in the front half, leave the rear for seasonal storage and overflow.
FLEX ROOM
Expansion-ready
Stud-framed interior makes it easy to add a partition, electrical, or insulation later.
FULL PRODUCT DETAILS
100×70 Riding Arena, what makes it different.
7,000sq ft
Floor Space
180mph
Wind Rated
65psf
Snow Load
20yr
Rust Warranty
40yr
Paint Warranty
$2683/mo
From RTO
🏗️
Engineered for your county
Every 100×70 riding arena is fabricated from American-rolled galvanized steel and engineered against the exact wind and snow loads your jurisdiction requires.
Standard: 140 mph wind / 35 psf snow
12-ga upgrade: 180 mph / 65 psf
Permit drawings stamped and emailed free
🔩
Construction details
The same materials commercial fabricators use, not residential-grade. Hot-dip galvanized fasteners, factory-baked siliconized polyester paint, Hilti-grade anchors.
Frame: 14-ga (12-ga upgrade) galvanized tubing
Panels: 29-ga G-90 (26-ga upgrade)
Fasteners: #14 self-drilling with EPDM washer
🚚
Free delivery & install, really free
Regional-route delivery plus 1–2 day on-site installation by a certified crew, bundled into your headline price. No hidden unloading fees, fuel surcharges, or site-prep charges.
$0 deposit · pay only after walkthrough sign-off
3–5 week lead time on regional routes
All 48 states · rush option available
🛡️
Warranty & lifespan
Engineered for a 50-year service life with industry-leading warranties on every wear surface.
20-yr rust-through warranty on frame & panels
40-yr paint warranty against fading + chalking
1-yr craftsmanship on installation
💳
$0-down financing
Three financing paths to fit any credit situation. The rent-to-own option requires no credit pull at all, fastest path to a closed deal.
RTO: $2683/mo, no credit check, 36–60 mo
Financing: 0% promo APR · 84 mo term
Cash discount: 4% on $10K+ orders
⚡
Why 100×70?
7,000 sq ft sits in the sweet spot for residential and light-commercial, fits standard quarter-acre setbacks, comfortably below the 1,000 sq ft municipal threshold that triggers extra inspections.
100′ × 70′ footprint with 7,000 sq ft interior
Permit-friendly in 96% of US counties
Resale ROI $56,000–$84,000 added home value
PEOPLE ALSO ASK
Common questions from Riding Arena shoppers.
The questions our team hears every week. Click any to expand the short answer.
How thick is the steel on a Steel and Stud 100×70 metal building?
Standard frame: 14-gauge (1.5 mm) galvanized tubing. Optional 12-gauge upgrade (2.5 mm) for high-wind/snow zones. Roof and wall sheeting ships 29-gauge standard, 26-gauge upgrade available on order.
Does Steel and Stud deliver and install in my state?
Yes, free delivery and free installation in all 48 continental states, performed by certified Steel and Stud crews. Hawaii and Alaska use custom freight quotes; call 1-877-275-7048 for either.
What’s the typical lead time for a 100×70 building?
Standard: 3–5 weeks from order confirmation to install completion. Fabrication runs the first 2–3 weeks at our US plant; regional delivery and 1-2 day install close it out. Rush builds available for $345.
Can I finance a Steel and Stud building without a credit check?
Yes, Steel and Stud’s rent-to-own partner does not pull credit. Approvals typically run 8 minutes with proof of income and first month’s payment. 36–60 month terms, no early-payoff penalty.
What’s covered under the 20-year warranty?
Steel and Stud’s 20-year rust-through warranty covers the galvanized frame against perforation, plus a 20-year paint-finish warranty against fade and chalk. Workmanship on the install is warrantied for 1 year. Warranty transfers to the next owner on resale.
CUSTOMER REVIEWS
What real 100×70 Riding Arena buyers say.
⭐
No reviews yet for the 100×70 Riding Arena
Be the first verified buyer to share your experience. Honest reviews help other steel-building shoppers make a confident decision.
A 100×70 riding arena from Steel and Stud starts at $128,800 with free delivery and free installation across all 48 states. Most buyers pick the rent-to-own option at about $2683/month with $0 down and no credit check. Call 1-877-275-7048 for a same-day price lock.
Is delivery and installation included in the 100×70 riding arena price?
Yes, every Steel and Stud riding arena ships with free delivery + free installation by a certified crew, included in the listed price. Anchored to a concrete pad, asphalt, or compacted gravel, your building is fully erected in 1–2 days after the truck arrives.
Do I need a permit for a 100×70 riding arena?
Almost always for 7,000+ sq ft enclosed buildings. Steel and Stud emails engineered drawings stamped for your wind zone (up to 180 mph) and snow zone (up to 65 psf) at no charge, so your local building department has everything it needs. Permit timing typically runs 2–6 weeks by jurisdiction.
How is a Steel and Stud riding arena different from a wood-frame build?
Steel solves the problems wood creates, no rotting, no termites, no warping, no painting every 3 years. Our 14-gauge galvanized frame carries a 20-year rust warranty and ships with a 180 mph wind / 65 psf snow rating already engineered in. A comparable wood build typically costs 2–3× more and needs ongoing maintenance.
What foundation does a 100×70 riding arena need?
A 4-inch concrete pad poured 1 foot wider and longer than the building is the standard. Steel and Stud also anchors to asphalt or compacted gravel for open or semi-enclosed configurations. A pad-pour bundle is offered at checkout if you don’t already have a slab.
How fast can I get a 100×70 riding arena delivered?
Standard lead time is 3–5 weeks from order to install. Fabrication runs the first 2–3 weeks at our US plant; regional delivery + 1–2-day install by a certified Steel and Stud crew closes out the order. Rush builds are available, call 1-877-275-7048 for current capacity.
Can I finance a 100×70 riding arena without a credit check?
Yes, Steel and Stud’s rent-to-own partner does not pull credit. Approvals close in about 8 minutes with proof of income and your first month’s payment. Terms run 36–60 months with no early-payoff penalty, and the monthly works out to roughly $2683/month on a 100×70 riding arena.
What warranty comes with the 100×70 riding arena?
Steel and Stud backs every building with a 20-year rust-through warranty on the galvanized frame and a 10-year sheeting warranty on the 29-gauge panels (upgradeable to 26-gauge or 12-gauge). Workmanship on the install is warrantied for 1 year. Full warranty terms ship with your order packet.
Can I customize the 100×70 riding arena in 3D before I order?
Yes, our free Sensei3D Designer lets you drag and drop doors, windows, and walk-ins; swap 16 roof + trim colors live; and rotate the building in 3D from every angle. No login required. The design saves directly to a quote so what you build is exactly what we price.
Will the 100×70 riding arena stand up to livestock and Midwest weather?
The 14-gauge galvanized frame is the same spec Steel and Stud uses for commercial barns, rated to 65 psf snow and 180 mph wind. Ventilation packages (ridge vent + soffit) ship standard on agricultural orders to prevent moisture buildup that would warp a wood barn.
Ready to build?
Your Riding Arena quote takes one minute.
Tell us your zip and the options you want. We’ll send back a same-day, all-in price.
7,000 sq ft for commercial warehouse, hay barn, or fabrication shop
100′ x 70′14 GaugeLocal Certification Available
Pre-engineered 100×70 steel building delivers 7,000 sq ft of column-free space. Galvanized 14-gauge tubular frame, vertical roof, and certified wind and snow load ratings. Customize doors, windows, colors, eave height, and certifications in our free 3D builder.
Leg height adjustable up to 20'
$128,800.00
Free Delivery & Install RTO from /mo — No credit check
7,000 sq ft for commercial warehouse, hay barn, or fabrication shop
100′ x 70′14 GaugeLocal Certification Available
Pre-engineered 100×70 steel building delivers 7,000 sq ft of column-free space. Galvanized 14-gauge tubular frame, vertical roof, and certified wind and snow load ratings. Customize doors, windows, colors, eave height, and certifications in our free 3D builder.
100×70 Fabrication Shop | Steel and Stud, From $130,400
100×70 Fabrication Shop, rated for heavy-duty industrial loads.
Fabricators order the 100×70 metal workshop with 18-20′ eaves to clear overhead crane rails. The clear-span 100-ft width runs a single 5-ton bridge crane the full length. Reinforced framing carries the rail load, and.
Starting from your selected configuration$130,400$148,650Save $18,250
or as low as $2717/mo · 0% APR · No credit RTO
ℹ️This is an estimate. Final pricing is locked after our sales team reviews your complete requirements (site access, ground type, county-specific certifications, optional upgrades). You’ll receive a written all-in quote within one business day of your request, no surprises, no hidden fees.
FREE delivery & installation in all 48 states. Concrete, asphalt, or compacted gravel.
SKU:SS-100X70-FABRICATION-SHOPBuilt:1,847+Since: 2002Made in: 🇺🇸 USA
🛡️
A+
BBB Accredited
★
4.8/5
customer rating
⏱
Since 2004
In Business
🏠
15,000+
Buildings
🇺🇸
48
States Served
We’ve provided builds for
SPATIAL LAYOUT
See how 800 sq ft fits your multi-station shop.
100 feet wide × 70 feet long. Separates dusty + clean operations. Fabricators order the 100×70 metal workshop with 18-20′ eaves to clear overhead crane rails.
Wood + metal benches · CNC / table-saw center · Finishing room + Material storage
Wood + metal benches at the front, cnc / table-saw center in the middle, finishing room + material storage at the rear. Capacity: multi-craft shop / small business. The clear-span 100-ft width runs a single 5-ton bridge crane the full length.
Design your building yourself in our free Sensei3D Designer, drag doors and windows where you want them, swap roof + trim colors, and see your spec from every angle. Save your design and email it to yourself for later.
Drag-and-drop doors, windows, walk-ins anywhere on the building
16 colors applied live to roof, walls, and trim, mix & match
Interior + exterior views of your spec, with measurements
Save your design and share it with your contractor or family
Auto-syncs to quote, what you build is what we price
All variants ship with free delivery, installation, drawings, 20-year warranty.
🏗️
7,000 sq ft enclosed
Fully-enclosed 100×70 vertical-roof structure.
🚪
Roll-up + walk-in doors
Standard configuration door package.
🔩
14-gauge steel frame
American-rolled galvanized tubing.
🎨
1 standard color
Pick from 16 factory-baked finishes.
TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS
Fabrication Shop spec sheet.
Width100′
Length70′ + 6" overhang
Side height9′ standard
Floor space7,000 sq ft
Doors1 × 9×8 roll-up
Walk-inOptional (+$345)
WindowsOptional
Windup to 180 mph
Snowup to 65 psf
RoofVertical 3:12
Frame14 ga (12 ga upgrade)
Sheeting29 ga (26 ga upgrade)
AnchoringConcrete · Asphalt · Ground
Lead time3 – 5 weeks
USE CASE EXAMPLES
How real buyers use Fabrication Shop.
DAILY USE
Everyday fabrication shop
7,000 sq ft is the right size for daily use of a fabrication shop.
STORAGE OVERFLOW
fabrication shop + seasonal storage
Park or store equipment in the front half, leave the rear for seasonal storage and overflow.
FLEX ROOM
Expansion-ready
Stud-framed interior makes it easy to add a partition, electrical, or insulation later.
FULL PRODUCT DETAILS
100×70 Fabrication Shop, what makes it different.
7,000sq ft
Floor Space
180mph
Wind Rated
65psf
Snow Load
20yr
Rust Warranty
40yr
Paint Warranty
$2717/mo
From RTO
🏗️
Engineered for your county
Every 100×70 fabrication shop is fabricated from American-rolled galvanized steel and engineered against the exact wind and snow loads your jurisdiction requires.
Standard: 140 mph wind / 35 psf snow
12-ga upgrade: 180 mph / 65 psf
Permit drawings stamped and emailed free
🔩
Construction details
The same materials commercial fabricators use, not residential-grade. Hot-dip galvanized fasteners, factory-baked siliconized polyester paint, Hilti-grade anchors.
Frame: 14-ga (12-ga upgrade) galvanized tubing
Panels: 29-ga G-90 (26-ga upgrade)
Fasteners: #14 self-drilling with EPDM washer
🚚
Free delivery & install, really free
Regional-route delivery plus 1–2 day on-site installation by a certified crew, bundled into your headline price. No hidden unloading fees, fuel surcharges, or site-prep charges.
$0 deposit · pay only after walkthrough sign-off
3–5 week lead time on regional routes
All 48 states · rush option available
🛡️
Warranty & lifespan
Engineered for a 50-year service life with industry-leading warranties on every wear surface.
20-yr rust-through warranty on frame & panels
40-yr paint warranty against fading + chalking
1-yr craftsmanship on installation
💳
$0-down financing
Three financing paths to fit any credit situation. The rent-to-own option requires no credit pull at all, fastest path to a closed deal.
RTO: $2717/mo, no credit check, 36–60 mo
Financing: 0% promo APR · 84 mo term
Cash discount: 4% on $10K+ orders
⚡
Why 100×70?
7,000 sq ft sits in the sweet spot for residential and light-commercial, fits standard quarter-acre setbacks, comfortably below the 1,000 sq ft municipal threshold that triggers extra inspections.
100′ × 70′ footprint with 7,000 sq ft interior
Permit-friendly in 96% of US counties
Resale ROI $56,000–$84,000 added home value
PEOPLE ALSO ASK
Common questions from Fabrication Shop shoppers.
The questions our team hears every week. Click any to expand the short answer.
How thick is the steel on a Steel and Stud 100×70 metal building?
Standard frame: 14-gauge (1.5 mm) galvanized tubing. Optional 12-gauge upgrade (2.5 mm) for high-wind/snow zones. Roof and wall sheeting ships 29-gauge standard, 26-gauge upgrade available on order.
Does Steel and Stud deliver and install in my state?
Yes, free delivery and free installation in all 48 continental states, performed by certified Steel and Stud crews. Hawaii and Alaska use custom freight quotes; call 1-877-275-7048 for either.
What’s the typical lead time for a 100×70 building?
Standard: 3–5 weeks from order confirmation to install completion. Fabrication runs the first 2–3 weeks at our US plant; regional delivery and 1-2 day install close it out. Rush builds available for $345.
Can I finance a Steel and Stud building without a credit check?
Yes, Steel and Stud’s rent-to-own partner does not pull credit. Approvals typically run 8 minutes with proof of income and first month’s payment. 36–60 month terms, no early-payoff penalty.
What’s covered under the 20-year warranty?
Steel and Stud’s 20-year rust-through warranty covers the galvanized frame against perforation, plus a 20-year paint-finish warranty against fade and chalk. Workmanship on the install is warrantied for 1 year. Warranty transfers to the next owner on resale.
CUSTOMER REVIEWS
What real 100×70 Fabrication Shop buyers say.
⭐
No reviews yet for the 100×70 Fabrication Shop
Be the first verified buyer to share your experience. Honest reviews help other steel-building shoppers make a confident decision.
A 100×70 fabrication shop from Steel and Stud starts at $130,400 with free delivery and free installation across all 48 states. Most buyers pick the rent-to-own option at about $2717/month with $0 down and no credit check. Call 1-877-275-7048 for a same-day price lock.
Is delivery and installation included in the 100×70 fabrication shop price?
Yes, every Steel and Stud fabrication shop ships with free delivery + free installation by a certified crew, included in the listed price. Anchored to a concrete pad, asphalt, or compacted gravel, your building is fully erected in 1–2 days after the truck arrives.
Do I need a permit for a 100×70 fabrication shop?
Almost always for 7,000+ sq ft enclosed buildings. Steel and Stud emails engineered drawings stamped for your wind zone (up to 180 mph) and snow zone (up to 65 psf) at no charge, so your local building department has everything it needs. Permit timing typically runs 2–6 weeks by jurisdiction.
How is a Steel and Stud fabrication shop different from a wood-frame build?
Steel solves the problems wood creates, no rotting, no termites, no warping, no painting every 3 years. Our 14-gauge galvanized frame carries a 20-year rust warranty and ships with a 180 mph wind / 65 psf snow rating already engineered in. A comparable wood build typically costs 2–3× more and needs ongoing maintenance.
What foundation does a 100×70 fabrication shop need?
A 4-inch concrete pad poured 1 foot wider and longer than the building is the standard. Steel and Stud also anchors to asphalt or compacted gravel for open or semi-enclosed configurations. A pad-pour bundle is offered at checkout if you don’t already have a slab.
How fast can I get a 100×70 fabrication shop delivered?
Standard lead time is 3–5 weeks from order to install. Fabrication runs the first 2–3 weeks at our US plant; regional delivery + 1–2-day install by a certified Steel and Stud crew closes out the order. Rush builds are available, call 1-877-275-7048 for current capacity.
Can I finance a 100×70 fabrication shop without a credit check?
Yes, Steel and Stud’s rent-to-own partner does not pull credit. Approvals close in about 8 minutes with proof of income and your first month’s payment. Terms run 36–60 months with no early-payoff penalty, and the monthly works out to roughly $2717/month on a 100×70 fabrication shop.
What warranty comes with the 100×70 fabrication shop?
Steel and Stud backs every building with a 20-year rust-through warranty on the galvanized frame and a 10-year sheeting warranty on the 29-gauge panels (upgradeable to 26-gauge or 12-gauge). Workmanship on the install is warrantied for 1 year. Full warranty terms ship with your order packet.
Can I customize the 100×70 fabrication shop in 3D before I order?
Yes, our free Sensei3D Designer lets you drag and drop doors, windows, and walk-ins; swap 16 roof + trim colors live; and rotate the building in 3D from every angle. No login required. The design saves directly to a quote so what you build is exactly what we price.
Will the 100×70 fabrication shop handle heavy equipment and forklifts?
Standard 100×70 fabrication shop ships rated for 35 psf live load on the floor (over concrete pad), and the 12-gauge frame upgrade supports trolley- and jib-crane mounts up to 1-ton capacity. Steel and Stud engineers will spec heavier rigging on request, call 1-877-275-7048.
Ready to build?
Your Fabrication Shop quote takes one minute.
Tell us your zip and the options you want. We’ll send back a same-day, all-in price.
7,000 sq ft for commercial warehouse, hay barn, or fabrication shop
100′ x 70′14 GaugeLocal Certification Available
Pre-engineered 100×70 steel building delivers 7,000 sq ft of column-free space. Galvanized 14-gauge tubular frame, vertical roof, and certified wind and snow load ratings. Customize doors, windows, colors, eave height, and certifications in our free 3D builder.
Leg height adjustable up to 20'
$130,400.00
Free Delivery & Install RTO from /mo — No credit check
No need to pay full price today. Choose from standard deposit, easy monthly financing, or rent-to-own with zero credit check. Every option includes free delivery & professional installation.
A prefabricated steel carport is the most cost-effective way to protect your vehicles, boats and equipment. Here is why 15,000+ property owners chose Steel and Stud.
🧮
Free Installation Included
Every tubular steel carport order includes free professional installation by a certified crew across all 48 contiguous states. No hidden assembly fees. Just confirm your site is level and we handle the rest.
🌟
20-Year Warranty on 12-Gauge
Our 12-gauge galvanized steel frames carry a 20-year limited rust-through warranty backed by the manufacturer. 14-gauge frames include a full workmanship warranty. Steel structures genuinely last decades.
💰
Factory-Direct Pricing
We work directly with multiple manufacturers, cutting out distributor markups. In most cases our prices beat the manufacturer's own direct pricing. 40-60% less than comparable wood or concrete construction.
🌞
12 Color Options Included
Choose from 12 standard powder-coat colors at no additional cost. Galvanized and primer finishes also available. Your color choice will not affect your price or lead time.
✅
Engineered for Your Climate
All structures are designed to meet local wind speed and snow load requirements. 12-gauge certified frames are available for high-wind coastal zones, heavy-snow mountain regions and tornado-prone states.
🔭
Multiple Manufacturers, One Source
We partner with multiple vetted manufacturers nationwide so you always get the closest installer, the fastest lead time, and competitive pricing for your specific location and climate zone.
Choose the Right Roof
Regular vs A-Frame vs Vertical Roof Carport
Selecting the right roof style affects weather performance, aesthetics, price and longevity. Here is how each option compares across key factors.
Regular / Horizontal
Most affordable, simple design
Lowest starting price
Fastest lead time
Moderate rain and snow shedding
Horizontal roof panels
Not ideal for heavy snow areas
Best for mild climates
Boxed Eave / A-Frame
Mid-range looks and performance
Moderate price premium (+8%)
A-frame ridge appearance
Better rain shedding than regular
Horizontal panels on A-frame
Moderate for snow areas
Great curb appeal
Vertical Roof
Best performance, highest durability
Superior snow and rain shedding
Panels run vertically top-to-bottom
No standing water or debris ponding
Ideal for heavy snow regions
Price premium (+15%)
Recommended for all climates
Verified Reviews
What Our customers Say
Real customers, real installs. See why 15,000+ property owners chose Steel and Stud for their RV Covers.
★★★★★
4.8 out of 5 based on 2,847 verified customer reviews
★★★★★
"Excellent to deal with — I feel fortunate Bill answered the phone when I called. He kept me informed of the order status from purchase through installation. Pleased with the quality and I would not hesitate buying again."
RB
Returning Buyer
Verified Customer
Steel Carport
★★★★★
"Bill is a hard charger when it comes to customer service. I was amazed how quickly he returned my emails and phone calls, and followed up with the installation from start to finish. Highly recommend."
VB
Verified Buyer
Verified Customer
Custom Metal Building
★★★★★
"Bill was very helpful with the sales portion of my order — communication promptly answered, straightforward about delivery. The installation team were professional and met every challenge head on. A well-prepared site is key; I'm thankful for his advice on that."
VB
Verified Buyer
Verified Customer
Steel Carport
Common Questions
RV Covers FAQ
Everything you need to know before ordering your steel carport: pricing, installation, permits, warranties, anchoring and dimensions.
Although this can be done with one person, we recommend having at least two people on hand to ensure safety. You can enlist the help of as many people as you like. All tubular steel orders from Steel and Stud include professional installation by a certified crew, so you do not need to self-install unless you specifically choose a DIY kit.
Carports and More Inc. has manufacturers that install in 48 contiguous states. Parts of some states are not covered by the manufacturer used for online pricing. If an order is placed and your location is not in a covered area, we will call you with the correct pricing for your area before proceeding.
Absolutely. You can install the building yourself. In most states, there is a 5% discount for self-installed buildings. The materials can be delivered to your location or picked up at the nearest factory. Contact us for current availability and self-install options in your state.
Manufacturers aim to install units within a 4-week period from the time an approved order is received. In some cases it is done sooner; however, it can take longer depending on the time of year, your location, and seasonal demand. Areas with extreme winter weather may close temporarily. Buildings over 24 feet wide require special construction and can take longer to manufacture.
Most standard RV Covers units are constructed in just a few hours. It may take up to two days depending on the size and complexity of the building. Large triple-wide or commercial-span RV Covers may require a second day for proper installation and inspection.
The key to a successful installation is a flat, level surface. Site preparation and building permits are the responsibility of the customer. You have approximately 2 to 3 inches of adjustment available during installation to account for minor grade differences. If your lot is significantly out of level, materials to level the site must be on hand when the crew arrives.
Re-bar and pin anchors (1/2-inch diameter, 36-inch long) are included for ground and asphalt installations. Concrete anchor bolts are used on concrete slabs at no extra charge. Mobile home auger anchors are available for ground installation at an additional cost. In several states, units enclosed on three sides require a minimum of four mobile home augers for ground installations.
Yes. You have 12 standard colors to choose from at no additional charge. Color selection does not affect your price. Galvanized and primer finishes are also available. Your color selection is made at the time of order and cannot be changed after fabrication begins.
Permit requirements vary by city, county and state. You should contact your local building department before ordering. All permit requirements such as set-backs must be resolved before ordering because once engineering plans are sent, your deposit becomes non-refundable. Generic engineered plans are available in most states. States requiring building-specific plans and calculations include CO, ID, MT, ND, NE, NJ, OR, SD, UT, WA and WY. Contact us if you have questions about your area.
The vertical roof allows water, snow and debris to run off quickly without ponding. The vertical panel orientation prevents accumulation and is especially recommended in high snow-load areas. If you are in a state with significant annual snowfall or heavy seasonal rain, the vertical roof upgrade is strongly recommended even though it carries a modest price premium.
Sizes are shown as width x length x leg height. Width is measured from outside to outside of each base rail. Length is measured by the roof metal, which includes a 6-inch overhang on each end, so the base rail is 1 foot shorter than the roof length. Height is measured by the actual leg on the outer wall. Standard-style roof units will be 1 foot taller at the sidewall than the selected leg height.
The frames are available in either 14-gauge or 12-gauge galvanized steel tubing. The roof, side and end panels are 29-gauge steel with a painted finish. Galvanized frames provide corrosion resistance. 12-gauge is 2.5mm thick; 14-gauge is 1.9mm thick. Lower gauge equals thicker, stronger steel.
14-gauge frame units carry a 30-day workmanship warranty. 12-gauge frames include both the 30-day workmanship warranty and a 20-year limited rust-through warranty on the framing, assuming normal user care and maintenance. Warranty coverage begins on the date of installation.
Yes; however, your deposit may not be fully refundable. You have 3 days from the date of order confirmation to cancel and receive a full refund. Cancellations must be in writing. After 3 days, deposits may be applied as credit toward any future purchase within 3 years. Deposits on custom-size units are non-refundable. Installation timing delays alone are not a valid reason for cancellation.
No. In most cases our prices are the same as or lower than ordering direct from the manufacturer. We work with multiple manufacturers and can often source your structure from the most competitive option for your location, size and timing, something a single manufacturer cannot do for you.
Yes. Extensions, lean-tos, sidewalls and doors can be added after installation, though there may be an additional service charge. If you plan to eventually enclose a RV Covers with walk-in or roll-up doors, your original leg height must be 6 feet or taller to allow for standard door frames.
Slab requirements vary by manufacturer. Please contact us before pouring your concrete slab to confirm exact dimensions and anchor bolt placement for your specific RV Covers model. Pouring the wrong size slab can delay installation.
12-foot legs are standard and available on all units. Longer legs may be available for special applications such as RV clearance or commercial-height requirements. Contact us if you need legs taller than 12 feet and we will confirm availability for your chosen structure type.
The balance due is paid directly to the manufacturer after your RV Covers is fully installed and you are satisfied. The manufacturer accepts cash, check and credit card. They will confirm accepted payment methods when they contact you to schedule installation. PayPal is not accepted directly by the manufacturer but can be arranged through Steel and Stud with applicable processing fees. If you prefer not to pay the full balance at once, ask about our monthly financing or rent-to-own (RTO) options — both are available and let you own your RV Covers with as little as the first month's payment down.
Yes — Steel and Stud offers three flexible payment paths: (1) Standard Payment — pay a deposit now, balance after install, zero interest; (2) Monthly Financing — competitive rates from $89/mo over 12–72 months with a soft credit pull; and (3) Rent-to-Own (RTO) — as low as $49/mo with no credit check required, first month's payment as the only down payment, and an early buyout option available at any time. RTO is available on most residential RV Covers sizes. View all financing options →
Gauge refers to the thickness of the steel tubing: lower gauge means thicker steel. 12-gauge is 2.5mm thick and is the stronger, more durable option backed by a 20-year rust-through warranty. 14-gauge is 1.9mm thick, lighter and more affordable, carrying a 30-day workmanship warranty. For heavy snow loads, high winds or long-term investment, 12-gauge is always recommended.
Standard single-car RV Covers (12x21, 15x21) start at $1,195 with free delivery and installation on tubular steel orders. Two-car RV Covers (18x21, 20x21) range from $1,595 to $2,595 depending on roof style and gauge. Triple-wide RV Covers (24x29 and larger) start around $3,895. Large commercial spans (20x38+, 24x45+) start at $5,195 and up. Contact us for a precise quote including your location, size and options.
Get Your Free Quote
Request a Free Carport Quote
Tell us about your project and a building specialist will contact you within 2 hours with a personalized, no-obligation price quote.
Why Request a Quote?
Fast ResponseAverage response time under 2 hours. Most quotes same day.
No Hidden FeesYour quote includes all standard features. Tubular orders include delivery and installation.
Low Deposit to StartDeposit varies by project scope. Balance due only after installation.
Zero ObligationGet your quote, compare options, decide when you are ready.
RV Covers dimensions follow a standard width x length x leg height format. Width runs from 10 feet to 40 feet for standard tubular steel units. Length is effectively unlimited in increments. Leg height starts at 6 feet for standard single-car RV Covers and goes up to 12 feet as a standard option, with taller legs available on request.
Single-car RV Covers (12 to 15 feet wide, 21 feet long) are the most affordable option starting at $1,195. Two-car RV Covers (18 to 22 feet wide) are the most popular category, covering two standard vehicles with room to open doors. Triple-wide RV Covers (24+ feet wide) accommodate three vehicles, trucks, boats or large equipment.
When planning your site, remember that the base rail is 1 foot shorter than the roof length due to 6-inch overhangs on each end. If you need exactly 40 feet of enclosed coverage, order a 41-foot length RV Covers. Contact our team to confirm the right dimensions before ordering.
How Much Does a RV Covers Cost in 2026?
RV Covers prices in 2026 range from $1,195 for a basic 12x21 single-car RV Covers up to $9,000 or more for a large 30x50 commercial-span structure. All tubular steel RV Covers prices from Steel and Stud include free delivery and professional installation.
Key pricing factors include: Width (wider RV Covers cost more per linear foot), Length (additional bays add proportional cost), Leg Height (taller legs cost more), Roof Style (vertical adds ~15% over regular), and Frame Gauge (12-gauge adds ~12% over 14-gauge but adds a 20-year warranty).
DIY RV Covers kits cost less because installation labor is excluded, but most property owners find the free professional installation included in tubular steel orders to be a significant value. A crew that installs 50 RV Covers per week consistently outperforms a first-time DIY attempt.
RV Covers Installation: What to Expect
After your order is confirmed and your deposit placed, the manufacturer assigns an installation crew for your region. Current lead times run 4 to 8 weeks depending on your location, structure size and seasonal demand. You will be contacted within 60 days of ordering to schedule your installation date.
Site requirements before the crew arrives: a flat, level surface (within 2-3 inches), clear access for a delivery truck, and any permit posted or available. Concrete pads are preferred but not required for ground or gravel installations. The installation crew typically completes a standard single or two-car RV Covers in 3 to 6 hours. Larger triple-wide or tall-clearance units may require a full day.
Balance payment is made directly to the manufacturer after your RV Covers is installed and you are satisfied with the result. Financing and rent-to-own options are available through Steel and Stud for customers who prefer monthly payments. View financing options or request your free quote to get started today.
Related Metal Building Categories
Looking for something larger or more enclosed? Explore our full range: enclosed steel garages from $3,195, metal barns for agricultural use, tall clearance RV and boat covers, barndominium shells for combined living and working space, and all commercial steel building types. Every product category includes the same factory-direct pricing and professional service.
Ready to Protect Your Vehicles with a Steel Carport?
Join 15,000+ property owners who chose Steel and Stud. Factory-direct pricing with free delivery and installation on all tubular steel orders.